Sony Camcorder PMW 500 User Manual

SOLID-STATE MEMORY CAMCORDER  
PMW-500  
The supplied CD-ROM includes operation manuals for the PMW-500 Solid-State  
Memory Camcorder (English, Japanese, French, German, Italian, Spanish and Chinese  
versions) in PDF format.  
For more details, see “Using the CD-ROM” on page 14.  
Sony Corporation  
PMW-500  
(SYM)  
4-260-128-03 (1)  
Printed in Japan  
2011.03 32  
© 2010  
OPERATION MANUAL [English]  
1st Edition (Revised 2)  
Printed on recycled paper.  
4260128030  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
moisture, does not operate normally, or  
has been dropped.  
WARNING  
WARNING  
To reduce the risk of fire or  
electric shock, do not  
expose this apparatus to  
rain or moisture.  
Excessive sound pressure from earphones  
and headphones can cause hearing loss.  
In order to use this product safely, avoid  
prolonged listening at excessive sound  
pressure levels.  
For the customers in the U.S.A.  
To avoid electrical shock,  
do not open the cabinet.  
Refer servicing to qualified  
personnel only.  
This equipment has been tested and found  
to comply with the limits for a Class B digital  
device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC  
Rules. These limits are designed to provide  
reasonable protection against harmful  
interference in a residential installation. This  
equipment generates, uses, and can radiate  
radio frequency energy and, if not installed  
and used in accordance with the  
Important Safety Instructions  
• Read these instructions.  
• Keep these instructions.  
instructions, may cause harmful interference  
to radio communications. However, there is  
no guarantee that interference will not occur  
in a particular installation. If this equipment  
does cause harmful interference to radio or  
television reception, which can be  
• Heed all warnings.  
• Follow all instructions.  
• Do not use this apparatus near water.  
• Clean only with dry cloth.  
• Do not block any ventilation openings.  
Install in accordance with the  
determined by turning the equipment off and  
on, the user is encouraged to try to correct  
the interference by one or more of the  
following measures:  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
• Do not install near any heat sources such  
as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or  
other apparatus (including amplifiers) that  
produce heat.  
- Reorient or relocate the receiving  
antenna.  
- Increase the separation between the  
equipment and receiver.  
- Connect the equipment into an outlet on a  
circuit different from that to which the  
receiver is connected.  
- Consult the dealer or an experienced  
radio/TV technician for help.  
• Do not defeat the safety purpose of the  
polarized or grounding-type plug. A  
polarized plug has two blades with one  
wider than the other. A grounding-type  
plug has two blades and a third grounding  
prong. The wide blade or the third prong  
are provided for your safety. If the  
provided plug does not fit into your outlet,  
consult an electrician for replacement of  
the obsolete outlet.  
• Protect the power cord from being walked  
on or pinched particularly at plugs,  
convenience receptacles, and the point  
where they exit from the apparatus.  
• Only use attachments/accessories  
specified by the manufacturer.  
• Refer all servicing to qualified service  
personnel. Servicing is required when the  
apparatus has been damaged in any way,  
such as power-supply cord or plug is  
damaged, liquid has been spilled or  
objects have fallen into the apparatus, the  
apparatus has been exposed to rain or  
You are cautioned that any changes or  
modifications not expressly approved in this  
manual could void your authority to operate  
this equipment.  
All interface cables used to connect  
peripherals must be shielded in order to  
comply with the limits for a digital device  
pursuant to Subpart B of Part 15 of FCC  
Rules.  
If you have any questions about this product,  
you may call;  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sony Customer Information Service Center  
1-800-222-7669 or http://www.sony.com/  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/  
perchlorate  
Perchlorate Material : Lithium battery  
contains perchlorate.  
Declaration of Conformity  
Trade Name  
Model  
: SONY  
: PMW-500  
For the customers in Taiwan only  
Responsible party : Sony Electronics Inc.  
Address  
: 16530 Via Esprillo,  
San Diego, CA  
92127 U.S.A.  
Telephone Number: 858-942-2230  
This device complies with part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and  
(2) this device must accept any  
interference received, including  
interference that may cause undesired  
operation.  
AVERTISSEMENT  
Afin de réduire les risques  
d’incendie ou  
d’électrocution, ne pas  
exposer cet appareil à la  
pluie ou à l’humidité.  
For the customers in Canada  
This Class B digital apparatus complies with  
Canadian ICES-003.  
For the customers in Europe  
This product with the CE marking complies  
with the EMC Directive issued by the  
Commission of the European Community.  
Compliance with this directive implies  
conformity to the following European  
standards:  
Afin d’écarter tout risque  
d’électrocution, garder le  
coffret fermé. Ne confier  
l’entretien de l’appareil  
qu’à un personnel qualifié.  
• EN55103-1: Electromagnetic  
Interference(Emission)  
• EN55103-2: Electromagnetic  
Susceptibility(Immunity)  
This product is intended for use in the  
following Electromagnetic Environments: E1  
(residential), E2 (commercial and light  
industrial), E3 (urban outdoors), E4  
(controlled EMC environment, ex. TV  
studio).  
AVERTISSEMENT  
Une pression acoustique excessive en  
provenance des écouteurs ou du casque  
peut provoquer une baisse de l’acuité  
auditive.  
Pour utiliser ce produit en toute sécurité,  
évitez l’écoute prolongée à des pressions  
sonores excessi  
Pour les clients au Canada  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est  
conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
The manufacturer of this product is Sony  
Corporation, 1-7-1 Konan, Minato-ku,  
Tokyo, Japan.  
The Authorized Representative for EMC and  
product safety is Sony Deutschland GmbH,  
Hedelfinger Strasse 61, 70327 Stuttgart,  
Germany.  
Pour les clients en Europe  
Ce produit portant la marque CE est  
conforme à la Directive sur la compatibilité  
électromagnétique (EMC) émise par la  
Commission de la Communauté  
européenne.  
For the State of California, USA only  
Perchlorate Material - special handling may  
apply, See  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
La conformité à cette directive implique la  
conformité aux normes européennes  
suivantes :  
Um dieses Produkt sicher zu verwenden,  
vermeiden Sie längeres Hören bei sehr  
hohen Schalldruckpegeln.  
• EN55103-1 : Interférences  
électromagnétiques (émission)  
• EN55103-2 : Sensibilité  
Für Kunden in Europa  
Dieses Produkt besitzt die CE-  
Kennzeichnung und erfüllt die EMV-  
Richtlinie der EG-Kommission.  
Angewandte Normen:  
électromagnétique (immunité)  
Ce produit est prévu pour être utilisé dans  
les environnements électromagnétiques  
suivants : E1 (résidentiel), E2 (commercial et  
industrie légère), E3 (urbain extérieur) et E4  
(environnement EMC contrôlé, ex. studio de  
télévision).  
• EN55103-1: Elektromagnetische  
Verträglichkeit (Störaussendung)  
• EN55103-2: Elektromagnetische  
Verträglichkeit (Störfestigkeit)  
Für die folgenden elektromagnetischen  
Umgebungen: E1 (Wohnbereich), E2  
(kommerzieller und in beschränktem Maße  
industrieller Bereich), E3 (Stadtbereich im  
Freien) und E4 (kontrollierter EMV-Bereich,  
z.B. Fernsehstudio).  
Le fabricant de ce produit est Sony  
Corporation, 1-7-1 Konan, Minato-ku,  
Tokyo, Japon.  
Le représentant autorisé pour EMC et la  
sécurité des produits est Sony Deutschland  
GmbH, Hedelfinger Strasse 61, 70327  
Stuttgart, Allemagne.  
Der Hersteller dieses Produkts ist Sony  
Corporation, 1-7-1 Konan, Minato-ku,  
Tokyo, Japan.  
Der autorisierte Repräsentant für EMV und  
Produktsicherheit ist Sony Deutschland  
GmbH, Hedelfinger Strasse 61, 70327  
Stuttgart, Deutschland.  
WARNUNG  
Um die Gefahr von Bränden  
oder elektrischen Schlägen  
zu verringern, darf dieses  
Gerät nicht Regen oder  
Feuchtigkeit ausgesetzt  
werden.  
Um einen elektrischen  
Schlag zu vermeiden, darf  
das Gehäuse nicht geöffnet  
werden. Überlassen Sie  
Wartungsarbeiten stets nur  
qualifiziertem  
Fachpersonal.  
WARNUNG  
Zu hoher Schalldruck von Ohrhörern und  
Kopfhörern kann Gehörschäden  
verursachen.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Table of Contents  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attaching a UHF Portable Tuner (for a UHF Wireless Microphone  
System) ..................................................................................... 45  
Manually Adjusting the Audio Levels of the Audio Inputs from the  
AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 Connectors ......................................... 60  
Checking Camcorder Settings and Status Information  
(Status Screens).................................................................................... 66  
Table of Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
If You Load a Memory Card Formatted in the Different Recording  
Mode from the Mode Selected on the Camcorder.................... 71  
Starting to Record from Pre-stored Video  
(Picture Cache Function) .......................................................... 78  
Loading a Planning Metadata File into Camcorder’s Internal  
Memory..................................................................................... 87  
Table of Contents  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Functions That Can Be Assigned to the ASSIGN. 1 and 3 Switches,  
Button...................................................................................... 156  
Table of Contents  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8
Table of Contents  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Foreword  
Mode Indications in This  
Manual  
Some functions and information are available  
only when this camcorder is in a specific  
operating mode. This manual indicates those  
modes by using the following marks. When these  
marks appear, the associated function or  
information is available only in that mode.  
Before Use  
After purchasing the PMW-500 Solid-State  
Memory Camcorder, before operating, it is  
necessary to set the area of use.  
(Unless this setting is made, the camcorder will  
not operate.)  
HD  
HD mode: When OPERATION >Format >HD/  
SD in the setup menu is set to [HD].  
For details of these settings, see “Setting the Area of  
UDF  
Note  
UDF mode: When OPERATION >Format >File  
System in the setup menu is set to [UDF].  
Before attaching/removing optional components or  
accessories to/from the PMW-500 (referred to as “the  
camcorder”), be sure to turn the power of the camcorder  
off.  
FAT  
FAT mode: When OPERATION >Format >File  
System in the setup menu is set to [FAT].  
FAT-HD  
FAT-HD mode: When OPERATION >Format  
>File System in the setup menu is set to [FAT]  
and OPERATION >Format >HD/SD in the setup  
menu is set to [HD].  
FAT-SD  
FAT-SD mode: When OPERATION >Format  
>File System in the setup menu is set to [FAT]  
and OPERATION >Format >HD/SD in the setup  
menu is set to [SD].  
Foreword / Mode Indications in This Manual  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter1 Overview  
For recording in FAT mode, it offers a choice of  
bit rates: either 35 Mbps (HQ mode) or 25 Mbps  
(SP mode).  
Features  
For recording in UDF mode, it offers a choice of  
bit rates: either 35 Mbps (HQ mode) or 50 Mbps  
(HD422 mode).  
By utilizing an efficient compression format, the  
camcorder records high-quality HD images for  
long recording time of approx. 60 minutes at 50  
Mbps (HD422 mode) or approx. 90 minutes at 35  
Mbps (HQ mode) on a single 32-GB SxS memory  
card (when the recording mode is UDF).  
It can also record and play two SD formats:  
2/3-inch full-HD “PowerHAD FX” CCDs  
2
• IT (Interline Transfer) / -inch progressive  
3
image sensors with 207 million pixels, for full  
HD resolution (1920 × 1080)  
• “PowerHAD FX” CCDs, featuring a signal  
processing ASIC with 14-bit A/D converters  
These new image sensor technologies enable  
the capture of very high-quality images, with  
F11 (59.94i) and F12 (50i) sensitivity and an  
1)  
MPEG IMX 50 Mbps and DVCAM 25 Mbps.  
1) CBK-MD01 SD Record and Playback Key required.  
For details, contact a Sony service representative  
1)  
Multi-format support  
SN ratio of 59 dB.  
1) With noise suppression on (off value is 54 dB) Noise  
suppression uses proprietary Sony signal processing  
technology to suppress noise in highfrequency  
regions.  
The camcorder supports interlace format  
recording (1080/59.94i or 1080/50i), progressive  
format recording (1080/29.97P, 1080/23.98P,  
720/59.94P, 720/29.97P, 720/23.98P, or 1080/  
25P, 720/50P, 720/25P), thus offering the  
flexibility needed for worldwide HD recording.  
It also supports recording and playback of SD  
signals (both NTSC and PAL). The camcorder  
has an optional capability to record and play back  
SD signals in IMX/DVCAM format, and can  
output HD signals down-converted to SD.  
SxS memory cards as recording media  
Using SxS memory cards, the camcorder offers  
nonlinear capabilities such as instant random  
access and file-based operation.  
You can choose FAT or UDF as the file system  
for recording media.  
Light weight, low power consumption  
A variety of functions for improved  
performance under various shooting  
conditions  
• Picture Cache function  
• Optical ND filters and electrical CC filters  
• Hyper gamma  
Design features custom video signal processing  
ICs, and SxS memory card recording enable  
fanless operation and power consumption of 27  
W or less. The camcorder’s light weight (3.4 kg  
(7 lb 7.9 oz)) and low center of gravity make it  
easy to carry on the shoulder while ensuring  
superior stability.  
• Slow shutter function  
• Clip Continuous Rec function  
• Frame Recording function  
• Time lapse function (interval recording)  
• Slow & quick motion function  
• Freeze mix function  
HD recording using the “MPEG-2 Long  
GOP” codec and SD recording in MPEG  
IMX50/DVCAM format  
The camcorder records 1920 × 1080, 1440 ×  
1080, and 1280 × 720 HD images using “MPEG-  
2 Long GOP” codec compression.  
• Live & Play function  
• Digital extender function  
1)  
• Focus magnification function  
• Assignable switches  
Features  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
• 3.5-inch high-resolution color LCD monitor  
• Remote control  
1) When the optional CBK-HD02 SDI/Composite Input  
and 50-pin Interface is installed  
When the CBK-HD02 is installed, you can also  
connect the HDCA-702 MPEG TS Adaptor  
instead of the camera adaptor. This allows you to  
convert this camcorder’s HDSDI output to a  
MPEG HD transport stream.  
Recording data to USB flash drives and  
reading data from USB flash drives (UDF  
mode)  
You can connect USB flash drives to the external  
device connector to record proxy data or read  
planning metadata. You can also save setup menu  
settings to USB flash drives and load menu  
settings from USB flash drives into the  
camcorder.  
Wireless LAN support  
You can connect this camcorder to a computer  
over a wireless LAN (Wi-Fi connection) by  
installing the optional CBK-UPG01 Hardware  
Upgrade Key and connecting the optional CBK-  
WA01 Wi-Fi Adapter to the external device  
connector.  
A Wi-Fi connection allows you to transfer  
planning metadata from a computer to this  
camcorder, and to transfer clips and other files  
from this camcorder to a computer. You can also  
use the Live Logging function to transfer proxy  
AV data to a computer as you shoot, for logging  
of the video currently being shot.  
Inherits unique features of XDCAM series  
The camcorder inherits the workflow features of  
the XDCAM series, including thumbnail display  
and metadata management, and improves them  
by introducing an improved man-machine  
interface.  
Supports two viewfinder types  
Depending on the application, you can use either  
the optional HDVF series viewfinder or the CBK-  
VF01 color viewfinder.  
Camcorder system configuration  
When you install the optional CBK-HD02 SDI/  
Composite Input and 50-pin Interface, you can  
mount the XDCA-55 HD Camera Adaptor and  
connect the XDCU-50 HD Camera Extension  
Unit to configure a system for shooting and  
recording.  
Features  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the CD-ROM  
Reading the CD-ROM  
Manuals  
Two CD-ROMs are supplied with the camcorder.  
Preparations  
The following program must be installed on your  
computer in order to read the documents  
contained on the CD-ROM.  
The CD-ROM labeled “Manuals for Solid-State  
Memory Camcorder” contains the PDF files of  
OPERATION MANUAL and SUPPLEMENT  
for the camcorder (English, Japanese, French,  
German, Italian, Spanish and Chinese).  
Adobe Reader Version 6.0 or higher  
Memo  
If Adobe Reader is not installed, you can download it  
from the following URL:  
http://www.adobe.com/  
The CD-ROM labeled “Utility Software for  
XDCAM” contains application and device driver  
software required to access to SxS memory cards  
from a computer and to manage material shot  
with the camcorder.  
Adobe and Adobe Reader are trademarks of Adobe  
Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or other  
countries.  
Information about how to install the software is  
provided in PDF format.  
To read the documents  
Do the following:  
Note  
You must install the SxS device driver and SxS UDF  
driver software on your computer if it is equipped with  
an ExpressCard slot and you want to use it to access SxS  
memory cards, if you want to connect the camcorder to  
your computer, and if you want to connect an optional  
SBAC-US10 SxS Memory Card USB Reader/Writer to  
the computer.  
1
Insert the CD-ROM in your CD-ROM  
drive.  
A cover page appears automatically in your  
browser.  
If it does not appear automatically in the  
browser, double-click on the index.htm file  
on the CD-ROM.  
2
Select and click on the manual that you  
wish to read.  
This opens the PDF file.  
Memo  
The files may not be displayed properly, depending on  
the version of Adobe Reader. In such a case, install the  
latest version you can download from the URL  
mentioned in “Preparations” above.  
Note  
If you have lost or damaged the CD-ROM, you can  
purchase a new one to replace it. Contact a Sony service  
representative.  
Using the CD-ROM / Reading the CD-ROM Manuals  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
c DC IN (DC power input) connector  
(XLR type, 4-pin, male)  
Locations and Functions  
of Parts and Controls  
To operate the camcorder from an AC power  
supply, connect an optional DC power cord to this  
terminal and then connect the cord to the DC  
output terminal of the BC-L70, BC-L160, or  
another battery charger.  
Power Supply  
d DC OUT 12V (DC power output)  
connector (4-pin, female)  
Adaptor connector (see page 15)  
Supplies power for an optional WRR-860C/861/  
862 UHF Synthesized Diversity Tuner  
(maximum 0.5 A).  
Note  
Do not connect any equipment other than the UHF  
synthesized diversity tuner.  
e Battery attachment shoe  
Attach a BP-GL95/GL65/L80S/L60S Battery  
Pack. Alternatively, you can attach an AC-  
DN2B/DN10 AC Adaptor to operate the  
camcorder on AC power supply.  
a LIGHT switch  
Determines how a video light connected to the  
LIGHT connector (see page 16) is turned on and  
off.  
AUTO: When the POWER switch of the video  
light is in the on position, the video light is  
turned on automatically while the camcorder  
is recording.  
Note  
For your safety, and to ensure proper operation of the  
camcorder, Sony recommends the use of the following  
battery packs: BP-GL95, BP-GL65, BP-L60S, and  
BP-L80S.  
Adaptor connector  
Enables connection of an XDCA-55 HD Camera  
Adaptor or an HDCA-702 MPEG TS Adaptor. To  
connect an adaptor, remove the cover from the  
connector and install the optional CBK-HD02  
SDI/COMPOSITE Input and 50 Pin Interface.  
MANUAL: You can turn the video light on or off  
manually, using its own switch.  
Note  
When the camcorder is set for recording in Picture Cache  
mode, it is not possible to turn on the light before  
operation to start recording is carried out (or while data  
is being stored in memory).  
b POWER switch  
Turns the main power supply on and off.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Note  
Accessory Attachments  
Do not connect viewfinders to both connectors at the  
same time.  
g Lens mount securing rubber  
After locking the lens in position using the lens  
locking lever, fit this rubber over the lower of the  
two projections. This fixes the lens mount,  
preventing it from coming loose.  
h Viewfinder front-to-back positioning  
knob (LOCK knob)  
Loosen this knob to adjust the front-to-back  
position of the viewfinder (see page 37).  
i Fitting for optional microphone holder  
Fit an optional CAC-12 Microphone Holder (see  
j Shoulder pad  
Raise the shoulder pad fixing lever to adjust the  
position in the front-to-rear direction. Adjust the  
position for maximum convenience when  
operating the camcorder on your shoulder (see  
a Shoulder strap fitting  
Attach the supplied shoulder strap (see page 49).  
b Accessory fitting shoe  
Attach an optional accessory such as a video light  
k LIGHT (video light) connector (2-pin,  
female)  
c Viewfinder front-to-back positioning  
A video light with a maximum power  
consumption of 50 W, such as the Anton Bauer  
Ultralight 2 or equivalent can be connected (see  
lever  
To adjust the viewfinder position in the front-to-  
back direction, loosen this lever and the LOCK  
knob. After adjustment, retighten this lever and  
the LOCK knob.  
l Lens cable clamp  
Clamp a lens cable.  
d Viewfinder left-to-right positioning ring  
Loosen this ring to adjust the left-to-right position  
m MIC IN (microphone input) (+48 V)  
of the viewfinder (see page 37).  
connector (XLR type, 5-pin, female)  
Connect a stereo microphone to this connector.  
The power (+48 V) is supplied via this connector.  
e Viewfinder fitting shoe  
Attach the viewfinder.  
n LENS connector (12-pin)  
Connect a lens cable to this connector.  
f VF (viewfinder) connectors (26-pin,  
rectangular and 20-pin, round)  
Note  
The analog interface connector (20-pin) is for  
connection of an HDVF series viewfinder, and  
the digital interface connector (26-pin) is for  
connection of an HD viewfinder CBK-VF01.  
Use a connection cable to connect your  
When connecting or disconnecting the lens cable to this  
connector, power off the camcorder first.  
o Tripod mount  
When using the camcorder on a tripod, attach the  
tripod adaptor (optional).  
viewfinder to the corresponding connector.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                 
p Lens mount (special bayonet mount)  
Attach the lens.  
Consult a Sony service representative for  
information about available lenses.  
c FILTER selector  
Switches between four ND filters built into this  
camcorder.  
When this selector is used, the new setting  
appears on the viewfinder screen for about three  
seconds.  
q Lens locking lever  
After inserting the lens in the lens mount, rotate  
the lens mount ring with this lever to lock the lens  
in position.  
After locking the lens, be sure to use the lens  
mount securing rubber to prevent the lens from  
becoming detached.  
FILTERselector ND filter  
setting  
1
2
CLEAR  
1
/
ND (attenuates light to  
4
r Lens mount cap  
1
approximately / )  
4
Remove by pushing up the lens locking lever.  
When no lens is mounted, keep this cap fitted for  
protection from dust.  
1
3
4
/
ND (attenuates light to  
16  
1
approximately  
1
/
)
16  
/
ND (attenuates light to  
64  
1
approximately  
/
)
64  
Operating and Connectors Section  
Front  
You can change a MAINTENANCE menu  
setting so that different white balance settings can  
be stored for different FILTER selector positions.  
This allows you to automatically obtain optimum  
white balance for the current shooting conditions  
in linkage with the filter selection.  
d MENU knob  
Changes the item selection or a setting within the  
e AUTO W/B BAL (automatic white/  
black balance adjustment) switch  
Activates the automatic white/black balance  
adjustment functions.  
WHITE: Adjust the white balance automatically.  
If the WHITE BAL switch (see page 19) is  
set to A or B, the white balance setting is  
stored in the corresponding memory. If the  
WHITE BAL switch is set to PRST, the  
automatic white balance adjustment function  
does not operate.  
BLACK: Adjust the black set and black balance  
automatically.  
You can use the AUTO W/B BAL switch even  
when the ATW (Auto Tracing White Balance)  
function is operating.  
a REC START (recording start) button  
Press to start recording. Press it again to stop  
recording. The effect is the same as that of the  
REC button on the lens.  
b SHUTTER selector  
Set to ON to use the electronic shutter. Push to  
SELECT to switch the shutter speed or shutter  
mode setting. When this switch is operated, the  
new setting appears on the viewfinder screen for  
about three seconds.  
If you push the switch to the WHITE side once  
more during the automatic white balance  
adjustment, the adjustment is cancelled and the  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
white balance setting returns to the original  
setting.  
b COLOR TEMP. (color temperature)  
button  
If you push the switch to the BLACK side once  
more during the automatic black balance  
adjustment, the adjustment is cancelled and the  
black balance setting returns to the original  
setting.  
Press to light the button and change the color  
temperature for shooting (factory default setting).  
You can use this as an assignable switch (see  
c ALARM (alarm tone volume  
f MIC (microphone) LEVEL control  
Adjusts the input level of audio channels 1, 2, 3  
and 4 (see page 60).  
adjustment) knob  
Controls the volume of the warning tone that is  
output via the built-in speaker or optional  
earphones. When the knob is turned to the  
minimum position, no sound can be heard.  
However, if MAINTENANCE >Audio >Min  
Alarm Volume in the setup menu is set to [Set],  
the alarm tone is audible even when this volume  
control is at the minimum position.  
Right side (near the front)  
ALARM  
Minimum  
Maximum  
d MONITOR (monitor volume  
adjustment) knob  
Controls the volume of the sound other than the  
warning tone that is output via the built-in speaker  
or earphones. When the knob is turned to the  
minimum position, no sound can be heard.  
e MONITOR (audio monitor selection)  
switches  
By means of combinations of the two switches,  
you can select audio that you want to hear through  
the built-in speaker or earphones.  
Position of down-side switch: CH-1/2  
Position of up-side Audio output  
switch  
CH-1/CH-3  
MIX  
Channel 1 audio  
Channels 1 and 2 mixed  
a ASSIGN. (assignable) 1/2/3 switches  
a)  
audio (stereo)  
You can assign the desired functions to these  
switches on OPERATION >Assignable SW in  
the setup menu (see page 155).  
CH-2/CH-4  
Channel 2 audio  
Position of down-side switch: CH-3/4  
Off is assigned to the ASSIGN 1/2/3 switches as  
the factory default setting.  
The ASSIGN.1/3 switches are provided with an  
indicator to show whether a function is assigned  
to the switch (ON) or not (OFF).  
Position of up-side Audio output  
switch  
CH-1/CH-3  
MIX  
Channel 3 audio  
Channels 3 and 4 mixed  
a)  
audio (stereo)  
CH-2/CH-4  
Channel 4 audio  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
a) By connecting stereo headphones to the EARPHONE  
jack, you can hear the audio in stereo. (Under  
MAINTENANCE >Audio in the setup menu,  
Headphone Out must be set to STEREO.)  
AUTO W/B BAL switch (see page 17) on  
the WHITE side, to automatically adjust the  
white balance, and save the adjustment  
settings in memory A or memory B.  
1)  
B (ATW ): When this switch is set to B and  
f ASSIGN. (assignable) 0 switch  
OPERATION >White Setting >White  
Switch<B> is set to [ATW] in the setup  
menu, ATW is activated.  
You can use the AUTO W/B BAL switch  
even when ATW is in use.  
You can assign the desired function to this switch  
on OPERATION >Assignable SW in the setup  
Off is assigned to this switch when the camcorder  
is shipped from the factory.  
This is a momentary type switch. Each press of  
the switch turns the function assigned to this  
switch on or off.  
When this switch is adjusted, the new setting  
appears on the viewfinder screen for about three  
seconds.  
1) ATW (Auto Tracing White Balance): The white  
balance of the picture being shot is adjusted  
automatically for varying lighting conditions.  
g GAIN selector  
Switches the gain of the video amplifier to match  
the lighting conditions during shooting. The gains  
corresponding to the L, M, and H settings can be  
selected on OPERATION >Gain Switch in the  
setup menu (see page 119). (The factory settings  
are L=0 dB, M=6 dB, and H=12 dB.)  
When this switch is adjusted, the new setting  
appears on the viewfinder screen for about three  
seconds.  
j MENU ON/OFF switch  
To use this switch, open the cover.  
This switch is used to display the menu on the  
viewfinder screen or the test signal screen. Each  
time the switch is pushed down, the menu screen  
is turned on and off.  
The function of this switch is the same as that of  
the MENU button in the thumbnail screen  
operations section.  
h OUTPUT/DCC (output signal/dynamic  
Note  
contrast control) switch  
This switch has different functions depending on  
whether or not a menu is displayed.  
Switches the video signal output from the camera  
module, between the following two.  
BARS: Output the color bar signal.  
CAM: Output the video signal being shot. When  
k MENU CANCEL/PRST (preset) /  
1)  
ESCAPE switch  
this is selected, you can switch DCC on and  
off.  
To use the MENU CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE  
switch, open the cover.  
1) DCC (Dynamic Contrast Control): Against a very  
bright background with the iris opening adjusted to the  
subject, objects in the background will be lost in the  
glare. The DCC function will suppress the high  
intensity and restore much of the lost detail and is  
particularly effective in the following cases.  
• Shooting people in the shade on a sunny day  
• Shooting a subject indoors, against a background  
through a window  
Note  
It is not possible to turn off the menu screen by closing  
the cover.  
Use the switch in the following way when the  
menu is not displayed.  
CANCEL/PRST: Each time this switch is  
pushed upward, a window to confirm the  
menu settings and status of the camcorder  
appears on the viewfinder screen (see  
page 66). The window consists of five pages,  
which are switched each time the switch is  
pushed upward. Each page is displayed for  
about 10 seconds.  
• Any high contrast scene  
i WHITE BAL (white balance memory)  
switch  
Controls adjustment of the white balance.  
PRST: Adjust the color temperature to the preset  
value (the factory default setting: 3200K).  
Use this setting when you have no time to  
adjust the white balance.  
ESCAPE: To clear the page immediately after  
display, push this switch down to the OFF  
position.  
A or B: Recall the white balance adjustment  
settings already stored in A or B. Push the  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Use the switch in the following way when the  
menu is displayed.  
Right side (near the rear)  
CANCEL/PRST: Pushing this switch up to this  
position after a setting is changed in the setup  
menu displays the message to confirm  
whether the previous settings are cancelled.  
Pushing this switch up to this position again  
cancels the previous settings.  
Pushing this switch up to this position before  
a setting is changed in the setup menu or after  
a setting change is cancelled in the setup  
menu displays the message to confirm  
whether the setting is reset to the initial  
value.  
Pushing this switch up to this position again  
resets the settings to the initial value.  
ESCAPE: Use this switch when the menu page,  
which has a hierarchical structure, is opened.  
Each time the switch is pushed to this  
position, the page returns to one stage higher  
in the hierarchy.  
l Cover  
Open this cover to use the MENU ON/OFF  
switch or the MENU CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE  
switch.  
a Built-in speaker  
1)  
The speaker can be used to monitor E-E sound  
during recording, and playback sound during  
playback. The speaker also sounds alarms to  
reinforce visual warnings (see page 176).  
If you connect earphones to the EARPHONE  
jack, the speaker output is suppressed  
automatically.  
1) E-E: Abbreviation of “Electric-to-Electric”. In E-E  
mode, video and audio signals input to the camcorder  
are output after passing through internal electric  
circuits only. This can be used to check input signals.  
b LCD monitor  
Displays remaining battery capacity, remaining  
media capacity, audio levels, time data, and so on  
Also allows you to check camera and playback  
pictures.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
You can adjust the position and angle of the LCD  
monitor.  
i F FWD (fast forward) button and  
indicator  
This plays back at high speed in the forward  
direction. The playback speed changes in the  
order ×4 t ×15 t ×24 with each press of the  
button. The indicator lights during high-speed  
playback in the forward direction.  
j PREV button  
This jumps to the first frame of the current clip.  
If you press this together with the F REV button,  
the jump is to the first frame of the first recorded  
clip on the recording media.  
c WARNING indicator  
Lights up or flashes when an abnormality occurs  
If you press this button twice in rapid succession,  
the jump is to the first frame of the last preceding  
clip (or the first frame of the current clip when no  
preceding clips exist).  
d ACCESS lamp  
Lights up in blue when data is written to or read  
from the recording media.  
k STOP button  
Press this button to stop playback.  
l NEXT button  
e Protection cover of the audio control  
section  
This jumps to the first frame of the next clip.  
If you press this together with the F FWD button,  
the jump is to the first frame of the last recorded  
clip on the recording media.  
Open to access the audio control section (see  
f Protection cover of the thumbnail  
screen operations section  
Open to access the thumbnail screen operations  
m DISP SEL (display selection)/EXPAND  
(expand function) button  
With each press of this button, the display in the  
LCD monitor changes as follows.  
section (see page 22).  
g F REV (fast reverse) button and  
Display indication Meaning  
indicator  
Video with  
superimposed  
The LCD monitor displays  
the same text information as  
This plays back at high speed in the reverse  
direction. The playback speed changes in the  
order ×4 t ×15 t ×24 with each press of the  
button. The indicator lights during high-speed  
playback in the reverse direction.  
information (CHAR) the viewfinder.  
Video without  
superimposed  
information (MONI)  
Status display  
(STATUS)  
The video only appears.  
Counter indications,  
h PLAY/PAUSE button and indicator  
warnings, audio levels, and  
similar information appear.  
No video image appears.  
Press this button to view play back video images  
using the viewfinder screen or the LCD monitor.  
The indicator lights during playback.  
If you press this button when the thumbnail  
screen is displayed, the duration of the selected  
clip is divided into fractions, and the first frame of  
each of the divisions is shown in a further  
thumbnail display (expand function). For an HD  
recorded MP4 clip, its duration is divided into 12.  
If an SD recorded AVI clip comprises multiple  
files, the divisions are displayed for the individual  
files.  
Press this button again during playback to pause,  
outputting a still image. At this time the indicator  
flashes at a rate of once per second.  
Pressing the F REV or F FWD button during  
playback or pause starts high speed playback in  
the forward or reverse direction.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
For MP4 clips, each time you press this button the  
division is repeated. Hold down the SHIFT button  
and press this button to step back through the  
division process.  
q BRIGHT (brightness) button  
Switches the brightness of the LCD monitor  
backlight.  
Each press of the button selects the next setting in  
the order shown in the following table.  
If you press the button with the LCD monitor off,  
the LCD backlight comes on in the H state.  
n HOLD (display hold) button  
Pressing this button instantly freezes the time data  
displayed in the LCD monitor. (The timecode  
generator continues running.) Pressing this button  
again releases the hold.  
Setting LCD monitor backlight  
H
High (select this to view the LCD  
monitor outdoors in the daytime)  
Brightness between H and L  
For details of the counter display, see page 27.  
M
L
Low (select this to view the LCD monitor  
indoors or outdoors at night)  
o RESET/RETURN button  
Resets the value shown in the time counter  
display in the LCD monitor. According to the  
settings of the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK switch  
(see page 23) and the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN  
switch (see page 23), this button resets the  
display as follows.  
OFF  
Off (the display is also off)  
Thumbnail screen operations section and audio  
control section  
Settings of switches  
To reset  
DISPLAY switch: COUNTER Counter to  
0:00:00:00  
DISPLAY switch: TC  
PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK  
switch: PRESET  
Timecode to  
00:00:00:00  
F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch:  
SET  
a)  
DISPLAY switch: U-BIT  
PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK  
switch: PRESET  
User bits data to  
00 00 00 00  
F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch:  
SET  
a THUMBNAIL indicator  
This lights when thumbnail screen is displayed.  
a) Of the timecode bits for every frame recorded on the  
media, those bits which can be used to record useful  
information for the user such as scene number,  
shooting place, etc.  
b THUMBNAIL button  
Press this button to display the thumbnail screen  
(see page 91) and to carry out a thumbnail  
operation.  
Press once more to return to the original display.  
This button returns to the previous screen when  
pressed during thumbnail screen display, expand  
thumbnail screen display, or essence mark  
thumbnail screen display.  
c SET (set) button and arrow buttons  
Use these buttons to make timecode and user bit  
settings, and for thumbnail screen operations (see  
When the menu is displayed, press this button to  
select an item or to confirm the setting change.  
p DISPLAY switch  
This cycles the data displayed in the time counter  
display in the LCD monitor through the sequence  
COUNTER, TC, and U-BIT (see page 27).  
COUNTER: Display the elapsed recording/  
playback time (hours, minutes, seconds,  
frames).  
d MENU button  
Each press of this button turns the setup menu  
display on and off.  
The function of this button is the same as that of  
the MENU ON/OFF switch.  
TC: Display timecode.  
U-BIT: Display user bits data.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
If you have recorded clips by using planning  
metadata that defined names for Shot Mark 0 to  
Shot Mark 9, the defined names are displayed  
instead of the above item names in the list.  
e F-RUN/SET/R-RUN (free run/set/  
recording run) switch  
Selects the operating mode of the internal  
timecode generator. The operating mode is set as  
explained below, depending on the position of the  
switch.  
F-RUN: Timecode keeps advancing, regardless  
of whether the camcorder is recording. Use  
this setting when synchronizing the timecode  
with external timecode.  
i SHIFT button  
Use this in combination with other buttons.  
j PRESET/REGEN (regeneration)/  
CLOCK switch  
Selects the type of timecode to record.  
PRESET: Record new timecode on the media.  
REGEN: Record timecode continuous with the  
existing timecode recorded on the media.  
Regardless of the setting of the F-RUN/SET/  
R-RUN switch, the camcorder operates in R-  
RUN mode.  
CLOCK: Record timecode synchronized to the  
internal clock. Regardless of the setting of  
the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch, the  
SET: Sets the timecode or user bits.  
R-RUN: Timecode advances only during  
recording. Use this setting to have a  
consecutive timecode on the recording  
media.  
f LEVEL CH1/CH2/CH3/CH4 (audio  
channel 1/2/3/4 recording level) knobs  
camcorder operates in F-RUN mode.  
Adjust the audio levels to be recorded on channels  
1, 2, 3, and 4 when the AUDIO SELECT CH1/  
CH2 and AUDIO SELECT CH 3-4 switches are  
set to MANUAL.  
k AUDIO SELECT CH1/CH2 (audio  
channel 1/2 adjustment method  
selection) switches  
Select the audio level adjustment method for each  
of audio channels 1 and 2.  
AUTO: Automatic adjustment  
g AUDIO SELECT CH 3-4 (audio  
channel 3/4 adjustment method  
selection) switch  
Select the audio level adjustment method for each  
of audio channels 3 and 4.  
MANUAL: Manual adjustment  
l AUDIO IN CH1/CH2/CH3/CH4 (audio  
AUTO: Automatic adjustment  
MANUAL: Manual adjustment  
channel 1/2/3/4 input selection) switches  
Select the audio input signals to be recorded on  
audio channels 1, 2, 3 and 4.  
FRONT: Audio input signals from the  
microphone connected to the MIC IN  
connector  
REAR: Audio input signals from an audio device  
connected to the AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2  
connectors  
h ESSENCE MARK button  
By pressing this button when a thumbnail display  
is on the screen, you can view the following  
thumbnail displays of the essence-marked frames  
of the selected clip, depending on the item  
selected in a list displayed on the screen.  
All: Thumbnail display of all frames marked with  
essence marks.  
Rec Start (in UDF mode): Thumbnail display of  
frames marked with Rec Start marks and of  
the first frames of clips (when the first frames  
are not marked with Rec Start marks).  
Shot Mark1: Thumbnail display of the frames  
marked with Shot Mark 1  
WIRELESS: Audio input signals from the UHF  
portable tuner if it is installed  
Shot Mark2: Thumbnail display of the frames  
marked with Shot Mark 2  
You can also select Shot Mark 0 and Shot Mark 3  
to Shot Mark 9.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
b PC connector  
Left side and upper section  
Used to put this camcorder into USB connection  
mode and use it as an external storage device for  
a computer. When a computer without  
ExpressCard slot is connected to this connector,  
every memory card inserted in the camcorder is  
recognized as a drive for that computer.  
c External device connector  
Connect an optional CBK-WA01 Wi-Fi Adapter  
or a USB flash drive.  
When a CBK-WA01 is connected: Wireless  
LAN connection is available.  
When a USB flash drive is connected:  
Recording, saving and loading the following  
data are available.  
• Recording of proxy data (see page 85)  
• Loading of planning metadata (see  
• Save and load setting data (see page 160)  
Notes  
• When you connect a CBK-WA01, install the optional  
CBK-UPG01 Hardware Upgrade Key.  
• Use this connector only for connecting a CBK-WA01  
or a USB flash drive. Do not connect and use a USB  
hub or similar products.  
For details on how to use the CBK-WA01, refer to the  
Supplement supplied in the CD-ROM (labeled  
“Manuals for Solid-State Memory Camcorder”).  
d SxS memory card slots  
These two slots (A and B) can receive SxS  
memory cards or other recording media (see  
e ACCESS lamps  
Indicate the state of slots A and B (see page 69).  
You can check whether the lamps are lit even  
when the slot cover is closed.  
a ASSIGNABLE 4/5 switches  
f EJECT buttons  
You can assign the desired functions to these  
switches on OPERATION >Assignable SW in  
the setup menu (see page 156).  
Off is assigned to these switches when the  
camcorder is shipped from the factory.  
To remove the recording media from the slot,  
press the EJECT button to release the lock, then  
press the button once more. This makes the media  
come out of the slot partially (see page 70).  
g Slot cover  
Slide to the left and right to open and close.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
h SLOT SELECT (SxS memory card  
k TC IN (timecode input) connector  
(BNC type)  
select) button  
When SxS memory cards are loaded in both card  
slots A and B, press this button to select the card  
you want to use (see page 70).  
To apply an external lock to the timecode of the  
camcorder, input the reference timecode.  
i SDI IN (OPTION) (SDI input  
(optional)) connector (BNC type)  
When the optional CBK-HD02 SDI/  
COMPOSITE Input and 50 Pin Interface is  
installed, the camcorder can record HDSDI or  
SDSDI signals input to this connector.  
l VIDEO OUT connector (BNC type)  
Outputs video signals for monitoring. The output  
signals can be selected either composite video or  
HD-Y depending on the setting of OPERATION  
>Input/Output >Output&i.LINK in the setup  
menu.  
j GENLOCK IN (genlock signal input)  
m TC OUT (timecode output) connector  
connector (BNC type)  
(BNC type)  
This connector inputs a reference signal when the  
camcorder is to be genlocked or when timecode is  
to be synchronized with external equipment.  
Available reference signals vary depending on the  
current system frequency as shown in the  
following table.  
To lock the timecode of an external VTR to the  
timecode of this camcorder, connect this  
connector to the external VTR’s timecode input  
connector.  
Rear  
System frequency Available reference signals  
1080/59.94i  
1080/29.97P  
1080/23.98P (PsF  
output)  
1080/59.94i, 480/59.94i  
1080/59.94i, 480/59.94i  
1080/23.98PsF, 480/59.94i  
1080/23.98P  
(Pulldown output)  
720/59.94P  
1080/59.94i, 480/59.94i  
1080/59.94i, 720/59.94P,  
480/59.94i  
720/29.97P  
720/23.98P  
1080/59.94i, 720/59.94P,  
480/59.94i  
1080/59.94i, 720/59.94P,  
480/59.94i  
480/59.94i  
480/29.97P  
1080/50i  
1080/25P  
720/50P  
1080/59.94i, 480/59.94i  
1080/59.94i, 480/59.94i  
1080/50i, 576/50i  
1080/50i, 576/50i  
1080/50i, 720/50P, 576/50i  
1080/50i, 720/50P, 576/50i  
1080/50i, 576/50i  
720/25P  
576/50i  
576/25P  
1080/50i, 576/50i  
(Genlock for the camera module supports  
horizontal sync signals only.) Use  
MAINTENANCE >GENLOCK in the setup  
menu to adjust the genlock H-phase (phase of  
horizontal sync signal).  
When the optional CBK-HD02 SDI/  
COMPOSITE Input and 50 Pin Interface is  
installed, the camcorder can record analog  
composite video signals input to this connector.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
By loosening the screws which retain the cover to  
the bottom of the camcorder, you can adjust the  
position of the cover depending on the size and  
shape of the microphone or audio cable plugs.  
After adjusting the position, tighten the screws to  
secure the cover.  
a TALLY (back tally) indicators (red)  
Light up during recording. They will not light if  
the TALLY switch is set to OFF. These indicators  
also flash to indicate warnings (see page 21). The  
tally indicator on the front of the viewfinder and  
the REC indication on the viewfinder screen light  
or flash in the same manner.  
h AUDIO OUT connector (XLR type, 5-  
pin, male)  
Outputs the audio signals recorded on audio  
channels 1 and 2 or audio channels 3 and 4. The  
audio signals are selected by the MONITOR  
switch.  
b TALLY switch  
Set to ON to activate the TALLY indicator  
function.  
c EARPHONE jack (stereo, minijack)  
i REMOTE connector (8-pin)  
Connect a remote control unit, which makes it  
possible to control the camcorder remotely.  
You can monitor the E-E sound during recording  
and playback sound during playback. When an  
alarm is indicated, you can hear the alarm sound  
through the earphone. Plugging an earphone into  
the jack automatically cuts off the built-in  
speaker.  
Note  
Before connecting/disconnecting the Remote Control  
Unit to/from the camcorder, be sure to turn off the  
camcorder POWER switch.  
You can select monaural or stereo on  
MAINTENANCE >Audio in the setup menu.  
j i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector (6-pin,  
d AUDIO IN selectors  
IEEE1394 compliant, S400)  
Select the audio source you connect to the  
AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 connectors.  
LINE: When connecting a stereo amplifier or  
other external audio signal source  
FAT  
When the recording mode is FAT, to input and  
output HDV/DV streams, connect to an HDV/DV  
device.  
MIC: When connecting a microphone that does  
not require 48 V power supply  
+48V: When connecting a microphone that  
requires 48 V power supply  
LCD Monitor  
e HD/SD SDI OUT connector (BNC type)  
Outputs an HDSDI or SDSDI signal (with  
embedded audio). The output from this connector  
can be turned on or off by OPERATION >Input/  
Output >SDI Output in the setup menu.  
f AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 (audio channel  
1 and channel 2 input) connectors (XLR  
type, 3-pin, female)  
These are audio input connectors for channels 1  
and 2 to which you can connect audio equipment  
or a microphone.  
g Bottom cover  
This is provided for protecting the cables  
connected to the connectors on the rear panel.  
a Resolution  
Indicates the resolution of HD output video.  
Indication Resolution (horizontal × vertical)  
1080  
720  
1080 lines (1920 × 1080)  
720 lines (1280 × 720)  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
b Recording format  
Indicates the current recording format or the  
recording format of clip being currently played.  
• UDF mode  
HD422 50  
HD420 HQ  
IMX50  
Indication Status  
Recording Recording format  
mode  
16bit  
FAT  
Any format  
UDF  
• HD420 HQ  
• DVCAM  
• IMX (Audio Length is  
set to16 bit)  
DVCAM  
24bit  
UDF  
• HD422 50  
• IMX (Audio Length is  
set to24 bit)  
• FAT mode  
HQ1920  
HQ1440  
HQ1280  
SP1440  
h Audio level indicators  
Indicate the audio recording or play levels of  
channels 1 to 4.  
DVCAM  
c Recording mode  
i Time counter display  
UDF: UDF mode  
FAT: FAT mode  
Switches displays of time counter values,  
timecode, and user bits data, depending on the  
position of the DISPLAY switch.  
Displays the type of data currently shown in the  
time counter, as follows.  
TCG: Recorded timecode  
TCR: Playback timecode  
UBG: Recorded user bits  
UBR: Playback user bits  
d File format  
MXF: When the recording mode is UDF  
MP4: When the recording mode is FAT-HD  
mode  
DV-AVI: When the recording mode is FAT-SD  
mode  
CNT: Counter  
CLK: Time display (when the PRESET/REGEN/  
CLOCK switch is set to CLOCK)  
e System frequency  
Indicates the system frequency of video being  
currently played or recorded.  
59.94i  
29.97P  
23.98P  
50i  
25P  
59.94P  
50P  
When the HOLD button is pressed to hold the  
timecode value, the timecode is displayed in the  
format shown below. When the HOLD button is  
pressed again to release the hold, the timecode is  
displayed in the normal format.  
f Status display  
PB: Appears during play.  
The three dots indicates that timecode is  
displayed in the hold mode.  
NDF: Appears when non-drop-frame timecode is  
selected.  
j Warning indicator area  
Displays warnings when trouble with recording  
or moisture condensation occurs.  
EXT-LK: Appears when the internal timecode  
generator is locked to an external signal input  
to the TC IN (timecode input) connector.  
HOLD: Appears when the operation mode of the  
internal timecode generator is set to R-RUN  
and stopped.  
You can also display the name of the next clip to  
be recorded (see page 127).  
k Remaining media capacity indicator  
Shows bar segments indicating the remaining  
capacity of recording media in the slots.  
g Audio format  
Indicates the audio recording format or the audio  
format of clip being currently played.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
l Remaining battery capacity indicator  
g Tally indicator  
Shows bar segments indicating the remaining  
battery capacity.  
Lights up while camcorder is recording. Set the  
TALLY switch to OFF when not in use. The  
brightness can also be adjusted with the TALLY  
switch.  
This indicator also flashes to indicate warnings, in  
the same manner as the camera operator tally  
indicator and the recording/red tally indicators in  
the viewfinder.  
HDVF-20A Viewfinder (Optional)  
h PEAKING control  
Turning this control clockwise adjusts the picture  
sharpness, and makes focusing easier. This  
control has no effect on the output signals of the  
camcorder.  
i CONTRAST control  
Adjusts the contrast of the screen. This control  
has no effect on the output signals of the  
camcorder.  
j BRIGHT control  
Adjusts the brightness of the screen. This control  
has no effect on the output signals of the  
camcorder.  
k TALLY switch  
Controls the tally indicator located on the front of  
the viewfinder.  
HIGH: The tally indicator brightness is set to  
high.  
OFF: The tally indicator is disabled.  
LOW: The tally indicator brightness is set to low.  
a Plug  
Connect to the VF connector (20-pin) on the  
camcorder.  
b Stopper  
Prevents the viewfinder from coming off the  
camcorder when it is slid from side to side.  
l ZEBRA (zebra pattern) switch  
Controls the zebra pattern display on the  
viewfinder screen as follows.  
ON: A zebra pattern appears and stays.  
OFF: The zebra pattern disappears.  
MOMENT: A zebra pattern appears and stays for  
about five seconds.  
c Camera operator tally indicator  
Lights up while camcorder is recording. This  
indicator can be covered when not in use.  
This indicator also flashes to indicate warnings, in  
the same manner as the tally indicator and the  
recording/red tally indicators in the viewfinder.  
d Eyecup  
m DISPLAY/ASPECT switch  
Turns the marker indication on and off, and  
switches between 4:3 and 16:9 aspect ratios for  
viewfinder screen display.  
DISPLAY: When the marker indication is  
enabled with the camcorder, the marker  
indication on the viewfinder screen turns on  
and off every time you push the switch up to  
this position.  
e Indicators and status display  
f Diopter adjustment ring  
Allows for optimal focus adjustment.  
ASPECT: Each push of the switch down to this  
position toggles the mask display on and off.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
(Make mask display settings using  
OPERATION >Marker >Aspect Mask in the  
setup menu (see page 119).)  
f Viewfinder barrel  
You can raise this up or rotate when required by  
the situation.  
n Viewfinder cable  
g Tally indicator  
Lights up when recording is started by a press of  
the REC START button on this camcorder, the  
VTR button on the lens, or the VTR button on the  
remote control unit.  
When an abnormality occurs, the tally indicator  
flashes to indicate a warning.  
o Microphone holder  
CBK-VF01 Viewfinder (Optional)  
h PEAKING control  
Turning this control clockwise adjusts the picture  
sharpness, and makes focusing easier. This  
control has no effect on the output signals of the  
camcorder.  
i CONTRAST control  
Adjusts the contrast of the screen. This control  
has no effect on the output signals of the  
camcorder.  
j BRIGHT control  
Adjusts the brightness of the screen. This control  
has no effect on the output signals of the  
camcorder.  
k TALLY switch  
Controls the tally indicator located on the front of  
the viewfinder.  
HIGH: The tally indicator brightness is set to  
high.  
OFF: The tally indicator is disabled.  
LOW: The tally indicator brightness is set to low.  
a Plug  
Connect to the VF connector (26-pin) on the  
camcorder.  
l ZEBRA (zebra pattern) switch  
Controls the zebra pattern display on the  
viewfinder screen as follows.  
ON: Display a zebra pattern.  
b Stopper  
Prevents the viewfinder from coming off the  
camcorder when it is slid from side to side.  
OFF: Do not display a zebra pattern.  
c Eyecup  
m DISPLAY switch  
Turns the display of text information on and off.  
ON: Display text information.  
OFF: Do not display text information.  
d Diopter adjustment ring  
Allows for optimal focus adjustment.  
e Eyepiece  
You can raise this up when required by the  
situation.  
n MIRROR switch  
The image display on the monitor screen becomes  
reversed horizontally or vertically when the  
viewfinder barrel is raised up or rotated. Use this  
switch to control the image display in such  
situation.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                               
L/R: Reverse the image horizontally.  
OFF: Do not reverse the image.  
B/T: Reverse the image vertically.  
b BATT (battery) indicator  
This indicator starts flashing when the battery  
connected to the camcorder is nearly exhausted,  
and stays lit when the battery is completely  
exhausted.  
o Viewfinder cable  
To prevent interruption during operation, replace  
the battery as soon as this indicator starts flashing.  
p Microphone holder  
The battery power level at which the indicator starts  
flashing can be set by MAINTENANCE >Battery in  
the setup menu. For details, see page 135.  
Status Display on the Viewfinder  
Screen  
c Recording/red tally indicators  
Indicators (HDVF-20A)  
The following indicators are arranged above and  
below the screen of the HDVF-20A to show the  
current state and adjustments of the camcorder.  
Light when the camcorder is the following states.  
• Recording with the MAINTENANCE >Camera  
Config >HD/SDI Remote I/F menu item set to  
[R-Tally]  
• Green tally signal or call signal received (when  
a camera adaptor is mounted on the camcorder  
and a camera extension unit is connected)  
These indicators also flash to indicate warnings,  
in the same manner as the tally indicator and the  
camera operator tally indicator.  
d Viewfinder screen  
e VTR SAVE indicator  
Do not function on this camcorder.  
f ! (warning) indicator  
This indicator lights when any of the following  
conditions occurs with the corresponding item set  
to [On] by OPERATION >“!” LED in the setup  
menu.  
• The gain is set to other than 0 dB.  
• The SHUTTER selector is set to ON.  
• The WHITE BAL switch is set to PRST.  
• ATW is enabled.  
a Green tally indicator  
Lights when the camcorder is the following  
states.  
• Picture Cache mode enabled  
• Green tally signal received (when a camera  
adaptor is mounted on the camcorder and a  
camera extension unit is connected)  
• Recording with MAINTENANCE >Camera  
Config >HD/SDI Remote I/F in the setup menu  
set to [G-Tally]  
• The lens extender is used.  
• The reference value of auto iris adjustment is  
not the standard value.  
• The FILTER selector is set to other than 1.  
Flashes when the camcorder is the following  
states.  
Viewfinder screen display  
The viewfinder screen displays not only the video  
picture but also characters and messages  
indicating the camcorder settings and operating  
status, a center marker, a safety zone marker, etc.  
When the menu screen is not displayed and the  
DISPLAY switch is set to ON, the items for  
which an ON setting was made with  
• Set to Interval Rec mode or the consecutive  
mode of Frame Rec mode (1 flash per second)  
• Recording in Interval Rec mode or recording in  
the consecutive mode of Frame Rec mode (4  
flashes per second)  
• Set to the single-shot mode of Frame Rec mode,  
or recording in that mode (2 flashes per second)  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
OPERATION >Super Impose in the setup menu  
or with related switches are displayed at the top  
and bottom of the screen.  
Caution messages are indicated for three seconds  
when you carry out operations to change  
camcorder settings. Adjustment execution  
messages are indicated while adjustments  
proceed. When adjustments are finished,  
messages showing the results of adjustments  
appear for three seconds.  
b Zoom position (when the lens is  
mounted)  
Indicates the zoom position of the zoom lens in  
the range from 0 to 99.  
c Focus position (when the serial lens is  
mounted)  
Indicates the focus position as distance to the  
subject (in units of m).  
Not only these indications are displayed on the  
viewfinder screen, but a menu setting enables  
them to be output as video signals.  
d Green tally  
Lights when the camcorder is the following  
states.  
All items that can be displayed on the viewfinder  
screen are shown below.  
• MAINTENANCE >Camera Config >HD-SDI  
Remote I/F is set to [G-Tally] in the setup menu  
and a recording control signal is output from the  
HD/SD SDI OUT connector.  
Top of viewfinder screen  
• When the Picture Cache mode is enabled  
• Green tally signal received (when a camera  
adaptor is mounted on the camcorder and a  
camera extension unit is connected)  
e Media status  
Displays the name of the currently active media  
slot (A or B).  
f Special recording mode/operation  
status  
Indicates the current special recording mode/  
operation status as follows.  
a Extender settings  
Indication  
zREC  
Meaning  
Indicates the setting of the digital extender  
function (when optional CBK-HD02 SDI/  
COMPOSITE Input and 50 Pin Interface is  
installed) of this camcorder and the setting of the  
lens extender.  
EX: The lens extender is on.  
08: The lens shrinker is on.  
x2D: The digital extender function of this  
camcorder is on.  
Ex2D: The lens extender and the digital extender  
function of this camcorder are both on.  
Recording in progress  
STBY  
When recording is on a break in  
Clip Continuous Rec mode or  
standby in other modes  
CONT  
Standby for next recording in Clip  
Continuous Rec mode  
zCACHE  
Standby in Picture Cache mode  
zINT REC Recording in progress in Interval  
Recording mode  
zINT STBY Standby for next recording in  
Interval Recording mode  
INT STBY  
Standby in Interval Recording  
mode  
Digital extender function can be turned on or off  
by an assignable switch to which Digital Extender  
is assigned.  
zFRM REC Recording in progress in Frame  
Recording mode  
Note  
zFRM  
STBY  
Standby for next recording in  
Frame Recording mode  
When slow & Quick motion is selected or the freeze mix  
function is used, the digital extender cannot be turned on.  
When the camcorder is in focus magnification (Focus  
Mag) mode, turning on the digital extender cancels the  
mode.  
FRM STBY Standby in Frame Recording mode  
zS&Q REC Recording in progress in Slow &  
Quick Motion mode  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
+: The value of Offset White is greater than  
3200K.  
–: The value of Offset White is less than 3200K.  
Indication  
Meaning  
S&Q STBY Standby in Slow & Quick Motion  
mode  
CALL  
(displayed in device  
Being called from a connected  
k Number of system lines  
Indicates the number of system lines (1080/720/  
576/480/486 ) of video currently being recorded  
or played back.  
red)  
1)  
BREVIEW During recording review  
g Wireless receiver reception level  
1) In SD mode, when OPERATION >Format >Country  
is set to other than [PAL Area] in the setup menu.  
In UDF mode: 486  
When a wireless receiver is installed in the  
camcorder, “W” appears together with four  
segment reception level indicators for each of the  
channels (1 to 4) that can be used by the receiver.  
The indications are as follows.  
In normal situation: The number of white  
segments indicates the strength of the signal  
level.  
Muting (for an analog receiver) or error rate  
aggravation (for a digital receiver): The  
number of grey segments indicates the  
strength of the signal level.  
In FAT mode: 480  
In UDF mode, the system frequency is also  
displayed here.  
l Video format  
Indicates the video format for recording (59.94i/  
29.97P/23.98P/50i/25P/59.94P/50P) or the video  
format of clip being currently played back (see  
The video aspect ratio (16:9 or 4:3) can also be  
displayed when the recording format is set to  
IMX50 or DVCAM.  
Reception level over peak: “P” is displayed  
1)  
instead of the indicators.  
Tuner battery is low: The channel number and  
indicator of the corresponding channel  
flash.  
1) When an optional DWR-S01D is used  
m Depth of field indication (when the  
serial lens is mounted and when the  
CBK-VF01 is used)  
1)  
h Battery remaining/voltage capacity  
The following is displayed depending on the type  
of power source.  
Error/warning indication  
A bar indicates the depth of field. The display unit  
is meters or feet, as selected by OPERATION  
>Display On/Off >Lens Info in the setup menu.  
An error or warning message is displayed here  
depending on the situation.  
Type of power What is displayed  
source  
InfoLithium  
battery  
Remaining battery capacity icon  
and remaining recording time  
Remaining battery capacity (%  
indication)  
Under this area, you can also display the name of  
the next clip to be recorded (see page 127).  
Anton Bauer  
battery  
Other type than Input voltage  
above  
n Special recording mode indication  
The following is displayed when the camcorder is  
in a special recording mode.  
• Frame Rec (Frame Recording mode)  
• Interval Rec (Interval Recording mode)  
• S&Q Motion (Slow & Quick Motion mode)  
i External power input  
Appears when power is supplied from an external  
power source connected to the DC IN connector.  
j Color temperature  
o Special recording mode settings  
indication  
Appears when the camcorder is in a special  
recording mode.  
Displays a color temperature calculated from the  
gain of R and B, in the range 1.5 K to 50.0 K (in  
steps of 0.1 K). The +/– signs may be displayed  
depending on the Offset White setting (see  
No display: Offset White is OFF  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Bottom of viewfinder screen  
Indication  
Meaning  
zREC  
DV recording in progress  
STBY  
Standby for DV recording  
e Video level indication  
An indication is displayed together with an  
appropriate ND filter position number when the  
light level of the subject is too high or too low.  
f Timecode  
Caution message  
Indicates the elapsed recording/playback time,  
timecode, user bits data or other information  
selected by the DISPLAY switch (see page 22).  
Also indicates a caution message when caution is  
required such as when you try to change settings.  
a TLCS iris control mode  
The following icons are displayed to indicate the  
video level control modes based on the Total  
Level Control System (TLCS).  
g Brightness level (when the CBK-VF01  
is used)  
Indicates the average brightness level (%) of the  
detection area.  
Icon  
TLCS control mode  
Backlight mode  
h External input source  
Indicates the type of external input signal (HDV)  
to be recorded.  
Standard mode  
Spotlight mode  
S
TD  
i Recording of external input  
Indicates “EXT” when an external input is  
recorded.  
b Focus adjustment mode (when the auto  
focus lens is mounted)  
Indicates the current focus adjustment mode of  
the camcorder.  
j Electric color temperature filter  
Appears when the CC 5600K function is set to on.  
• AF (Auto Focus mode)  
• MF (Manual Focus mode)  
• MF* (Manual Focus mode when the MF Assist  
function is on)  
k Filter position  
Indicates the currently selected ND filter position  
number. (see page 17).  
• Full MF (Full Manual Focus mode)  
When ELECTRICAL CC is assigned to an  
assignable switch, the electrical filter position (A/  
B/C/D) appears to the right of the ND filter  
position (1 to 4), as shown on the previous page.  
c External device control  
“REC2” is displayed when MAINTENANCE  
>Camera Config >HD-SDI Remote I/F is set to  
[Chara] in the setup menu and a recording control  
signal is output from the HD/SD SDI OUT  
connector.  
l White balance memory  
Indicates the currently selected white balance  
automatic adjustment memory.  
d Operation status of connected i.LINK  
ATW: ATW (Auto Tracing White Balance) mode  
W:A: Memory A mode  
W:B: Memory B mode  
device  
The operating format (HDV or DV) and operation  
status of that device are indicated as follows.  
W:P: Preset mode  
Indication  
Meaning  
3200: When the assignable switch to which Color  
Temp SW 3200K has been assigned is on  
4300: When the assignable switch to which Color  
Temp SW 4300K has been assigned is on  
zREC  
HDV recording in progress  
STBY  
Standby for HDV recording  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
5600: When the assignable switch to which Color  
Temp SW 5600K has been assigned is on  
6300: When the assignable switch to which Color  
Temp SW 6300K has been assigned is on  
Reference Indicator  
value  
–1  
ss All segments are lit in white.  
ss  
m Gain value  
Indicates the gain value (in dB) of the video  
amplifier, as set by the GAIN selector.  
n Shutter  
Indicates the shutter speed or the shutter mode.  
o Audio level meters  
Indicate the audio levels of channel 1 and  
channel 2.  
p Remaining media capacity  
The available time for recording with the current  
video format (recording bit rate) is calculated  
according to the remaining space of each media  
and indicated in time units of minutes. A lock  
icon appears if the media is write-protected.  
q Histogram (when the CBK-VF01 is  
used)  
Shows a pixel distribution of video luminance (in  
HD mode only).  
r Iris position (when the lens is mounted)  
Indicates the iris position and the setting for iris  
override (reference value for the lens iris) (see  
The iris override setting is indicated by four  
segments indicator as follows.  
Reference Indicator  
value  
+0.25  
Lower left segment is lit in grey.  
x
+0.5  
x
x
Left two segments are lit in grey.  
+0.75  
x
xx  
Left two segments and lower  
right segment are lit in grey.  
+1  
xx All segments are lit in grey.  
xx  
–0.25  
Lower left segment is lit in  
white.  
s
–0.5  
s
s
Left two segments are lit in  
white.  
–0.75  
s
ss  
Left two segments and lower  
right segment are lit in white.  
Locations and Functions of Parts and Controls  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
34  
         
Chapter2 Preparations  
Model name  
Operating time  
Preparing a Power  
Supply  
BP-GL95  
BP-GL65  
BP-L60S  
BP-L80S  
Approx. 180 minutes  
Approx. 120 minutes  
Approx. 110 minutes  
Approx. 145 minutes  
WARNING  
For safety, use only the Sony battery packs and  
AC adaptors listed below.  
• BP-GL95/GL65/L60S/L80S Lithium-ion  
Battery Pack  
Batteries shall not be exposed to excessive heat such as  
sunshine, fire or the like.  
AVERTISSEMENT  
• AC power using the AC-DN2B/DN10 AC  
Adaptor  
N’exposez pas les batteries à une chaleur excessive, au  
soleil ou près d’un feu par exemple.  
WARNUNG  
CAUTION  
Akkus dürfen keinesfalls übermäßiger  
Wärmeeinwirkung ausgesetzt werden, wie z.B.  
Sonneneinstrahlung, Feuer o. ä.  
Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.  
Replace only with the same or equivalent type  
recommended by the manufacturer.  
When you dispose of the battery, you must obey the law  
in the relative area or country.  
Note  
The battery pack operating time depends on the  
frequency of use of the battery pack, and the ambient  
temperature when used.  
ATTENTION  
Il y a danger d’explosion s’il y a remplacement incorrect  
de la batterie. Remplacer uniquement avec une batterie  
du même type ou d’un type équivalent recommandé par  
le constructeur.  
Before use, charge the battery pack with a charger  
suitable for each battery.  
Lorsque vous mettez la batterie au rebut, vous devez  
respecter la législation en vigueur dans le pays ou la  
région où vous vous trouvez.  
For details on the battery charging procedure, refer  
to the battery charger operation manual.  
Note on using the battery pack  
A warm battery pack may not be able to be fully  
recharged.  
VORSICHT  
Explosionsgefahr bei Verwendung falscher Batterien.  
Batterien nur durch den vom Hersteller empfohlenen  
oder einen gleichwertigen Typ ersetzen.  
Wenn Sie die Batterie entsorgen, müssen Sie die Gesetze  
der jeweiligen Region und des jeweiligen Landes  
befolgen.  
To attach the battery pack  
1
Press the battery pack against the back  
of the camcorder, aligning the line on  
the side of the battery pack with the  
matching line on the camcorder.  
Using a Battery Pack  
When a BP-GL95/GL65/L60S/L80S Battery  
Pack is used, the camcorder will operate  
continuously for the time shown below.  
Preparing a Power Supply  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
1 BP-GL95/GL65/L60S/L80S  
2 Align these lines.  
Release button  
Notes  
2
Slide the battery pack down until its  
“LOCK” arrow points at the matching  
line on the camcorder.  
• During recording and playback (while the ACCESS  
lamp on the right-side panel is lit in blue and the  
ACCESS lamp in the card slot section is lit in orange),  
be careful never to remove the battery pack.  
• Make sure to power the camcorder off before replacing  
the battery pack.  
Using AC Power  
Mount an AC-DN2B/DN10 on the camcorder in  
the same way as a battery pack, then connect to  
the AC power supply.  
The AC-DN2B/DN10 can supply up to 100 W of  
power.  
1 “LOCK” arrow  
2 Matching line on the camcorder  
Note  
If the battery pack is not attached correctly, the terminal  
may be damaged.  
To an AC outlet  
To detach the battery pack  
Holding the release button in, pull the battery  
pack up.  
Preparing a Power Supply  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Viewfinder left-to-right positioning ring  
Stopper  
Attaching the Viewfinder  
CAUTION  
When the viewfinder is attached, do not leave the  
camcorder with the eyepiece facing the sun. Direct  
sunlight can enter through the eyepiece, be focused in the  
viewfinder and cause fire.  
Note  
The viewfinder is supplied separately.  
The following procedure is an example for attaching the  
HDVF-20A.  
2
Couple the viewfinder connector to the  
VF connector (20-pin).  
For procedures for attaching other viewfinders, refer  
to a manual supplied with each viewfinder.  
VF connector (20-pin)  
Attaching the Viewfinder  
Note  
When attaching the viewfinder, make notes of the  
following points.  
• Be sure to the power off the camcorder before coupling  
the viewfinder connector to the camcorder’s VF  
connector (20-pin). If you make this connection when  
the camcorder power is on, the viewfinder may not  
function properly.  
• Couple the viewfinder connector firmly to the  
camcorder’s VF connector. If the coupling is loose,  
noise may appear on the video or the tally light may not  
operate properly.  
Detaching the viewfinder  
For more information about the connection of the  
viewfinder and camcorder, contact a Sony service  
representative.  
You can carry out this by following the attaching  
procedure in reverse order, but there is an  
additional action to take: when detaching the  
viewfinder from the fitting shoe, pull up the  
stopper.  
1
1 Loosen the viewfinder left-to-right  
positioning ring, 2 attach the  
viewfinder to the viewfinder fitting  
shoe, and 3 tighten the viewfinder left-  
to-right positioning ring.  
Adjusting the Viewfinder Position  
To adjust the viewfinder left-right position,  
loosen the left-right positioning ring, and to adjust  
the front-back position, loosen the front-to-back  
positioning knob.  
Attaching the Viewfinder  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Viewfinder left-to-right positioning ring  
Bolts with  
hexagonal  
hole  
Viewfinder slide assembly  
Viewfinder front-to-back positioning knob  
3
Attach the BKW-401 with the supplied  
bolts.  
Using the BKW-401 Viewfinder  
Rotation Bracket  
By fitting an optional BKW-401 Viewfinder  
Rotation Bracket, you can rotate the viewfinder  
out of the way so that your right leg does not hit  
the viewfinder while you are carrying the  
camcorder.  
1
Loosen the front-to-back viewfinder  
positioning levers and the front-to-back  
viewfinder positioning knobs, and then  
pull the viewfinder slide assembly  
forward.  
Bolts supplied with the BKW-401  
2
Using a 2.5 mm diameter hexagonal  
wrench, detach the viewfinder slide  
assembly.  
Attaching the Viewfinder  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
38  
   
4
Adjust the front-to-back position so  
that the arm of the BKW-401 does not  
touch the handle when it is raised.  
To reattaching the eyepiece  
1
2
Align the red marks on the eyepiece  
locking ring and the viewfinder barrel.  
Adjust position so that arm  
does not touch handle  
Align the red mark on the end of the  
eyepiece end with the red marks on the  
eyepiece locking ring and the  
viewfinder barrel. Then insert the  
eyepiece into the viewfinder barrel.  
3
Turn the eyepiece locking ring  
clockwise until its “LOCK” arrow  
points at the red mark on the viewfinder  
barrel.  
When the eyecup is worn out, replace it with a  
new one.  
Detaching the Eyepiece  
For details of a replacement eyecup, contact a Sony  
service representative.  
Removing the eyepiece gives a clearer view of the  
screen from further away. It is also easy to  
remove dust from the viewfinder screen and  
mirror when the eyepiece is detached.  
Adjusting the Viewfinder Focus  
and Screen  
1
Turn the eyepiece locking ring fully  
counterclockwise, to align the red  
marks on the locking ring and the  
viewfinder barrel.  
To adjust the viewfinder focus  
Turn the diopter adjustment ring until the  
viewfinder image is sharpest.  
Diopter adjustment ring  
1 Locking ring  
2 Locking ring match mark  
3 Match mark on the viewfinder barrel  
2
Detach the eyepiece.  
To adjust the viewfinder screen  
Adjust the brightness, contrast, and peaking of the  
viewfinder screen with the controls shown below.  
Match mark on end of eyepiece  
Attaching the Viewfinder  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Setting the Area of Use  
When using the camcorder for the first  
time  
The area of use is not factory preset. Before using  
the camcorder, you need to set this item. (You  
cannot use the camcorder without setting this  
item.)  
1 PEAKING control  
2 CONTRAST control  
3 BRIGHT control  
To set the area of use  
POWER switch  
MENU knob  
1
Set the POWER switch to the ON  
position.  
The screen for setting the area of use appears  
in the viewfinder.  
Setting the Area of Use  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
40  
     
2
3
Press the MENU knob.  
The settings for selectable areas of use are  
displayed.  
Setting the Date/Time of  
the Internal Clock  
You can set or change the date and time of the  
internal clock. The date and time set are reflected  
in the timecode.  
For menu operations, see “Basic Setup Menu  
Turn the MENU knob to select the  
desired area of use.  
1
2
3
Select MAINTENANCE >Clock Set  
>Date/Time in the setup menu.  
Setting  
Area of use  
NTSC Area  
NTSC area (for areas other  
a)  
than Japan)  
b)  
NTSC(J) Area  
PAL Area  
NTSC area (Japan)  
c)  
PAL area  
a) The composite signal output from this camcorder  
is an NTSC signal with a black setup (7.5 IRE).  
The system frequency is 59.94i.  
b) The composite signal output from this camcorder  
is an NTSC signal with no black setup. The  
system frequency is 59.94i.  
Press the MENU knob.  
The Date/Time setting window appears.  
c) The composite signal output from this camcorder  
is a PAL signal. The system frequency is 50i.  
4
5
Set the following items.  
• Time Zone  
• Date/Time  
Turn the MENU knob to select  
“Finish”, then press the MENU knob.  
The camcorder is now ready for use.  
Turn the MENU knob to display the  
desired value, and press the knob.  
The selection shifts to the next item on the  
right.  
4
5
To continue the remaining settings,  
repeat step 3.  
Making sure that “SET” is selected,  
press the MENU knob.  
The internal clock is set with the date and  
time set in steps 3 and 4.  
To cancel the setting  
Before executing step 5, push the MENU  
CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE switch up to the  
CANCEL/PRST side.  
Setting the Date/Time of the Internal Clock  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Caution  
Mounting and Adjusting  
the Lens  
If the lens is not firmly locked, it may come off  
while the camcorder is being used. This could cause  
a serious accident. Make sure the lens is firmly  
locked. It is recommended that the lens mount  
securing rubber be put on the lens locking lever as  
illustrated above.  
Note  
4
5
Connect the lens cable to the LENS  
connector.  
Always power the camcorder off before mounting or  
removing a lens.  
Secure the lens cable with the cable  
clamps.  
For information about using the lens, refer to the  
operation manual for the lens.  
If you have attached an aberration correction  
lens  
Note  
The lens is supplied separately.  
The aberration correction function is activated  
automatically. Starting the camcorder with an  
aberration correction lens may require more time  
than normally because of data loading at start-up.  
Contact a Sony service representative for  
information about aberration correction lenses.  
Lens mount  
securing rubber  
Adjusting the Flange Focal Length  
If the lens does not stay in focus properly as you  
zoom from telephoto to wide angle, adjust the  
flange focal length (the distance from the plane of  
the lens mounting flange to the imaging plane).  
Make this adjustment just one time after  
mounting or changing the lens.  
When carrying out the adjustment, use a flange  
focal length adjustment chart as the subject.  
About 3 m (10 ft)  
1
2
3
Push the lens locking lever up and  
remove the lens mount cap from the  
lens mount.  
Notes  
Align the center pin on the lens with the  
center slot in the lens mount, and insert  
the lens into the mount.  
• If you use a subject with insufficient contrast, or move  
the camcorder or subject during adjustment, this will  
cause an adjustment error.  
• Place the subject (the flange focal length adjustment  
chart) so that it appears at the center of the screen at the  
telephoto end. Arrange so that no nearby object (no  
object closer to the camera than the chart) enters the  
screen at the wide-angle end.  
Holding the lens in place, push the lens  
locking lever down to lock the lens.  
Mounting and Adjusting the Lens  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
42  
         
Carrying out the adjustment  
Preparing the Audio  
Input System  
1
2
Set the iris to manual.  
Open the iris, position the supplied  
flange focal length adjustment chart  
approximately 3 meters (10 ft) away  
from the camcorder, and arrange the  
lighting to obtain a satisfactory video  
output.  
Connecting a Microphone to the  
MIC IN Connector  
You can attach the optional ECM-680S stereo  
microphone to the microphone holder of the  
viewfinder (optional).  
The following procedure is an example for  
attaching a microphone holder to the HDVF-20A.  
3
Loosen the fixing screws on the F.f or  
F.B ring (flange focal length adjustment  
ring).  
4
5
Use manual or power zoom to set the  
lens to telephoto.  
For procedures for attaching a microphone holder  
to other viewfinders, refer to a manual supplied with  
each viewfinder.  
Point the camcorder at the chart by  
turning the focus ring and focus on it.  
1
Loosen the screw and open the  
microphone holder clamp.  
6
7
Set the zoom ring to wide angle.  
Microphone holder clamp  
Turn the F.f or F.B ring until the chart  
is in focus, being careful not to disturb  
the focus ring.  
8
9
Repeat steps 4 to 7 until the chart stays  
in focus all the way from wide angle to  
telephoto.  
Tighten the F.f or F.B ring fixing  
screws.  
2
Place the microphone in the  
microphone holder.  
1 Wind the microphone spacer around  
the microphone, while peeling off the  
protective sheets on both sides of the  
microphone spacer.  
2 Place the microphone in the holder so  
that “UP” is at the top.  
3 Close the microphone holder.  
4 Tighten the screw.  
Preparing the Audio Input System  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Connecting Microphones to the  
AUDIO IN Connectors  
You can connect up to two monaural  
microphones to the AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2  
connectors, using an optional CAC-12  
Microphone Holder.  
The following is the procedure for attaching an  
electret condenser microphone such as the ECM-  
674/678.  
On how to attach the CAC-12, refer to the operation  
manual for the CAC-12.  
1
Attach the electret condenser  
microphone.  
1 Loosen the ball joint lock lever.  
2 Wind the microphone spacer (sheet  
type, supplied with the microphone)  
around the microphone, while peeling  
off the protective sheets on both sides  
of the microphone spacer.  
On how to perform this operation, refer to the  
operation manual for the microphone.  
3 Place the microphone in the holder so  
that “UP” is at the top.  
4 Close the microphone holder.  
5 Tighten the screw.  
6 Position so that the microphone does  
not interfere with the viewfinder and  
tighten the ball joint lock lever.  
3
Plug the microphone cable into the MIC  
IN connector, then set the AUDIO IN  
switch for the channel on which you  
want to record the audio from this  
microphone to FRONT.  
Microphone  
4
Secure the microphone cable with the  
cable clamp.  
Preparing the Audio Input System  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
44  
   
Notes  
• If the input level on the camcorder is not at an  
appropriate setting for the microphone sensitivity, loud  
sounds may be distorted, and the signal-to-noise ratio  
may be affected.  
• In order for the AUDIO IN CH-1 and CH-2 connectors  
on the camcorder to be able to provide a phantom 48 V  
power supply, female XLR connectors (3-pin) are  
fitted. If the microphone cable has a female connector,  
use an adaptor.  
• When you detach a CAC-12 Microphone Holder once  
you have attached to the camcorder, be careful not to  
lose the two screws fixing the CAC-12 (in step 1).  
After detaching the CAC-12, be sure to put the two  
screws back into their original places.  
2
3
Connect the microphone cable to the  
AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 connector.  
Set the switches as follows.  
• Set the AUDIO IN selectors indicated  
below, depending on the power supply type  
of the microphone.  
Internal power supply: MIC  
External power supply: +48V  
• Set the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 switch for the  
channel to which the microphone is  
connected to REAR.  
Attaching a UHF Portable Tuner  
(for a UHF Wireless Microphone  
System)  
To use a Sony UHF wireless microphone system,  
power the camcorder off and then fit one of the  
following UHF portable tuners.  
• DWR-S01D Digital Wireless Receiver  
• WRR-855S UHF Synthesized Tuner Unit  
• WRR-860A/861/862 UHF Synthesized  
Diversity Tuner  
For details of these units, refer to the operation  
manuals for them.  
Note  
The optional WRR Mount Bracket (service part number:  
A-8278-057-B) is required to fit the WRR-862.  
For details, contact your vendor or a Sony service  
representative  
To fit the DWR-S01D or WRR-855S  
1 AUDIO IN selectors  
2 Monaural microphone  
3 AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 switches  
4 To AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 connector  
1
Remove the four fixing screws holding  
the cover of the portable tuner/receiver  
housing slot located in the rear of the  
camcorder, to remove the cover.  
4
Switch the input level to match the  
sensitivity of the microphone used.  
Switch the input level by changing the setting of  
MAINTENANCE >Audio >Rear MIC CH1/  
CH2 Ref in the setup menu (factory default  
setting is –60 dB). For details, see page 137.  
Preparing the Audio Input System  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2
Insert the DWR-S01D or WRR-855S  
into the housing slot, and fasten the four  
fixing screws.  
BP-GL65/GL95/L60S/L80S  
Adjustment  
screws  
DWR-S01D or WRR-855S  
Mount plate  
(supplied with  
WRR-862)  
Phillips type  
screwdriver  
3
Set the AUDIO IN selector for the  
channel to which you want to input  
audio signal to WIRELESS (see  
2
3
Attach the battery pack.  
On how to attach the battery pack, see “To  
Mount the tuner on the WRR tuner  
fitting.  
To fit the WRR-862 (when using a BP-  
GL65/GL95/L60S/L80S Battery Pack)  
1
Attach the WRR tuner fitting (not  
supplied; service part number: A-8278-  
057-B) to the back of the camcorder.  
1 Use a Phillips type screwdriver to  
tighten the four screws placed in the  
tuner fitting. For three of these screws,  
insert the screwdriver through the  
corresponding hole and tighten the  
screw.  
WRR-862  
4
5
Connect the tuner power cord to the DC  
OUT connector of the camcorder, and  
the audio output cable to the AUDIO IN  
CH-1 or CH-2 connector.  
Note  
Make sure that all four screws are fully tightened.  
2 Loosen the adjustment screws on the  
tuner fitting.  
Set the switches as follows.  
• Set the AUDIO IN selector for the channel  
to which the audio output cable is attached  
to MIC.  
• Set the AUDIO IN CH1/CH2/CH3/CH4  
switch for the channel to which the audio  
output cable is connected to REAR.  
If the XLR connection automatic detection  
function is on, the input signal for audio  
recording is selected automatically, and  
therefore this setting is not required.  
3 Adjust the tuner fitting position for a  
BP-GL65/GL95/L60S/L80S Battery  
Pack to be attached, and tighten the  
adjustment screws to fix its position.  
4 Attach the mount plate supplied with  
the WRR-862.  
About the WRR tuner fitting (service part  
number: A-8278-057-B), contact a Sony service  
or sales representative.  
Preparing the Audio Input System  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
46  
1 AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 switches  
2 To AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 connector  
3 Audio equipment  
4 AUDIO IN selectors  
1AUDIO IN CH1/CH2 switches  
2To DC OUT connector  
3To AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 connector  
4AUDIO IN selectors  
Connecting Line Input Audio  
Equipment  
Connect the audio output connector of the audio  
equipment that supplies the line input signal to the  
AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 connector.  
Switch settings  
Set the AUDIO IN selector for the channel to  
which the audio signal source is connected to  
LINE.  
Selecting the audio inputs to be recorded  
• With the XLR connection automatic detection  
function being off (the factory default setting):  
A signal must be selected for audio recording by  
setting the AUDIO IN CH1 or CH2 switch to  
REAR depending on which of the AUDIO IN  
CH-1 and CH-2 connectors is used for  
connecting the external audio equipment.  
• With the XLR connection automatic detection  
function being on: When a cable is connected to  
the AUDIO IN CH-1 or CH-2 connector, the  
input from that connector is automatically  
selected for audio recording, regardless of the  
setting of the AUDIO IN CH1 or CH2 switch.  
The XLR connection automatic detection  
function can be switched on or off by  
MAINTENANCE >Audio >Rear XLR Auto in  
the setup menu.  
Preparing the Audio Input System  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Tripod Mounting  
1
Attach the optional VCT-14/U14  
Tripod Adaptor to the tripod.  
Red button  
Tripod adaptor  
Lever  
Note  
The tripod adaptor pin may remain in the engaged  
position even after the camcorder is removed. If this  
happens, press the red button and move the lever as  
shown above until the pin returns to the stowed position.  
If the pin remains in the engaged position, you will not  
be able to mount the camcorder on the tripod adaptor.  
Camera mount  
2
Mount the camcorder on the tripod  
adaptor.  
Slide the camcorder forward along the  
groove in the adaptor until it clicks.  
To remove the camcorder from the tripod  
adaptor  
Hold down the red button and pull the lever in the  
direction of the arrow.  
Tripod Mounting  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Connecting a Video  
Light  
Using the Shoulder  
Strap  
With this camcorder, you can use the Anton  
Bauer Ultralight 2 or equivalent video light  
(powered by 12 V with maximum power  
consumption of 50 W).  
• If you connect the video light to the LIGHT  
connector on the camcorder and set the LIGHT  
switch to AUTO, you can turn the light on and  
off automatically as you start and stop recording  
on this camcorder.  
To attach the shoulder strap  
1
Fit one of the clips to a shoulder strap  
fitting.  
Pull up the strap to lock the fitting.  
• The output of the LIGHT connector on the  
camcorder is controlled to 12 V even when the  
camcorder is supplied with over 12 V power  
(through the DC IN connector or battery pack).  
The brightness or color temperature of the light  
will not change according to voltage increase.  
Clip  
Notes  
• Do not use a video light with power consumption of  
over 50 W.  
• The brightness or color temperature of the light will  
change when the voltage (supplied through the DC IN  
connector or from the battery pack) is under 12 V.  
2
Fit the other clip to the shoulder strap  
fitting on the other side of the grip in the  
same way as in step 1.  
To attach the video light  
Fit the video light to the accessory fitting shoe on  
the camcorder grip, and connect the video light  
cable to the LIGHT connector.  
Note  
The accessory fitting shoe on the camcorder is of the  
1/4-inch tapped hole type. If you want to replace this with  
a slide-type shoe, use the supplied cold shoe kit. On how  
to fit the cold shoe kit, refer to “Using a External Hard  
Disk” in the Supplement supplied in the CD-ROM  
(labeled “Manuals for Solid-State Memory  
Camcorder”).  
Connecting a Video Light / Using the Shoulder Strap  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
49  
           
To remove the shoulder strap  
Adjusting the Shoulder  
Pad Position  
Press here and pull in the direction  
shown by the arrow to release.  
You can slide the shoulder pad back and forth  
within a 40 mm range. This adjustment helps you  
get the best balance for shooting with the  
camcorder on your shoulder.  
Shoulder pad  
1
2
3
Raise the lever in the center of the  
shoulder pad to unlock the shoulder  
pad.  
Slide the shoulder pad backward or  
forward until it is in the most  
convenient position.  
Bring down the lever to lock the  
shoulder pad in the selected position.  
Adjusting the Shoulder Pad Position  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter3 Adjustments and Settings  
Setting the Video Format  
The following recording formats can be selected for different combinations of video resolution and system  
frequency.  
In UDF mode  
UDF  
OPERATION >Format menu settings  
Video format (recording  
Frame size  
a) format/system frequency)  
HD/SD HD System  
Line  
Rec Format  
System Frequency  
HD  
1080  
HD422  
50  
59.94i  
50i  
HD422 1920/59.94i  
HD422 1920/50i  
HD422 1920/29.97P  
HD422 1920/25P  
HD422 1920/23.98P  
HQ 1440/59.94i  
HQ 1440/50i  
1920×1080  
29.97P  
25P  
23.98P  
59.94i  
50i  
HD420  
HQ  
1440×1080  
1280×720  
29.97P  
25P  
HQ 1440/29.97P  
HQ 1440/25P  
23.98P  
59.94P  
50P  
HQ 1440/23.98P  
HD422 1280/59.94P  
HD422 1280/50P  
HD422 1280/29.97P  
HD422 1280/25P  
HD422 1280/23.98P  
HQ 1280/59.94P  
HQ 1280/50P  
720  
HD422  
50  
29.97P  
25P  
23.98P  
59.94P  
50P  
HD420  
HQ  
b)  
23.98P  
HQ 1280/23.98P  
IMX50/59.94i  
c)  
SD  
IMX50  
59.94i  
50i  
720×486  
720×576  
720×486  
720×576  
720×480  
720×576  
720×480  
720×576  
IMX50/50i  
d)  
29.97P  
IMX50/29.97P  
IMX50/25P  
d)  
25P  
c)  
DVCAM  
59.94i  
50i  
DVCAM/59.94i  
DVCAM/50i  
d)  
29.97P  
DVCAM/29.97P  
DVCAM/25P  
d)  
25P  
Setting the Video Format  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
51  
     
a) 59.94i/29.97P/59.94P/23.98P: When OPERATION >Format >Country in the setup menu is set to [NTSC Area] or  
[NTSC(J) Area]  
50i/25P/50P: When OPERATION >Format >Country in the setup menu is set to [PAL Area]  
b) 59.94i after 2-3 pulldown is recorded  
c) When the optional CBK-MD01 is installed  
d) Converted to PsF and recorded  
In FAT mode  
FAT  
OPERATION >Format menu settings  
Video format (recording  
Frame size  
a) format/system frequency)  
HD/SD HD System  
Line  
Rec Format  
System Frequency  
HD  
1080  
HQ 1920  
59.94i  
50i  
HQ 1920/59.94i  
HQ 1920/50i  
1920×1080  
29.97P  
25P  
HQ 1920/29.97P  
HQ 1920/25P  
23.98P  
59.94i  
50i  
HQ 1920/23.98P  
HQ 1440/59.94i  
HQ 1440/50i  
HQ 1440  
1440×1080  
29.97P  
25P  
HQ 1440/29.97P  
HQ 1440/25P  
23.98P  
59.94i  
50i  
HQ 1440/23.98P  
SP 1440/59.94i  
SP 1440/50i  
SP 1440  
HQ 1280  
b)  
23.98P  
SP 1440/23.98P  
HQ 1280/59.94P  
HQ 1280/50P  
720  
59.94P  
50P  
1280×720  
29.97P  
25P  
HQ 1280/29.97P  
HQ 1280/25P  
23.98P  
59.94i  
50i  
HQ 1280/23.98P  
DVCAM/59.94i  
DVCAM/50i  
c)  
SD  
DVCAM  
720×480  
720×576  
720×480  
720×576  
d)  
29.97P  
DVCAM/29.97P  
DVCAM/25P  
d)  
25P  
a) 59.94i/29.97P/59.94P/23.98P: When OPERATION >Format >Country in the setup menu is set to [NTSC Area] or  
[NTSC(J) Area]  
50i/25P/50P: When OPERATION >Format >Country in the setup menu is set to [PAL Area]  
b) 59.94i after 2-3 pulldown is recorded  
c) When the optional CBK-MD01 is installed  
d) Converted to PsF and recorded  
Setting the Video Format  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
5
Select [Execute] to execute, or select  
[Cancel] to cancel, and then press the  
MENU knob.  
Selecting the Recording Mode  
Select the recording mode between UDF and  
FAT.  
When the setting of HD/SD or Country  
was changed, power the camcorder off  
and on again.  
1
Select OPERATION >Format >File  
System in the setup menu (see  
2
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to select [UDF]  
or [FAT], and press the knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
Select [Execute] to execute, or select  
[Cancel] to cancel, and then press the  
MENU knob.  
Power the camcorder off and on again.  
Changing the Video Format  
Refer to the above table and change the settings of  
the relevant items.  
1
Select OPERATION >Format in the  
setup menu (see page 112).  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to select the item  
to change, and press the knob.  
Turn the MENU knob to change the  
setting, and press the knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
Setting the Video Format  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2
Push the AUTO W/B BAL switch to  
BLACK and release the switch.  
The message “Executing...” appears during  
execution, and changes to “Done” when the  
adjustment finishes. Adjustment values are  
saved to memory automatically.  
Adjusting the Black  
Balance and the White  
Balance  
Notes  
To ensure excellent image quality when using this  
camcorder, conditions may require that both the  
black balance and the white balance be adjusted.  
Black balance and white balance adjustment  
values that are automatically set by the camcorder  
and the various settings are stored in the  
camcorder memory and retained even when the  
power is turned off.  
• During the black balance adjustment, the iris is  
automatically closed.  
• During the black balance adjustment, the gain  
selection circuit is automatically activated so you may  
see flickering on the viewfinder screen, but this is not  
a fault.  
• Output from the i.LINK connector stops temporarily if  
you execute black balance adjustment during i.LINK  
output. Output from the connector resumes when black  
balance adjustment finishes.  
Black balance adjustment  
The black balance will require adjustment in the  
following cases.  
• When the camcorder is used for the first time  
• When the camcorder has not been used for a  
long time  
• When the camcorder is used under conditions in  
which the surrounding temperature has changed  
greatly  
• When the GAIN selector (L/M/H/Turbo) values  
have been changed by using OPERATION  
>Gain Switch in the setup menu.  
It is not usually necessary to adjust the black  
balance when using the camcorder after it has  
been off.  
If automatic black balance adjustment  
cannot be made  
If the black balance adjustment cannot be  
completed normally, an error message will appear  
for about three seconds on the viewfinder screen.  
Possible messages are listed below.  
Error message Meaning  
NG: Iris Not  
Closed  
The lens iris did not close;  
adjustment was impossible.  
Adjustment could not be  
completed within the standard  
number of attempts.  
NG: Timeout  
NG: Out of  
Range  
The difference between the  
reference value and the current  
value is so great that it exceeds  
the range. Adjustment was  
impossible.  
White balance adjustment  
Always readjust the white balance when the  
lighting conditions change.  
If any of the above error messages is displayed,  
retry the black balance adjustment.  
If the error message occurs again, an internal  
check is necessary.  
Adjusting the Black Balance  
In automatic black balance mode, adjustments are  
performed in the following order: black set and  
black balance. Manual black balance adjustment  
can be selected from the setup menu.  
For information about this internal check, refer to  
the Maintenance Manual.  
Note  
If the lens cable is not firmly connected to the LENS  
connector, it may not be possible to adjust the lens iris. If  
this happens, the black balance will be incorrect.  
Automatic black balance adjustment is disabled  
in the following case.  
• During recording  
• In a special recording modes (Picture Cache  
Rec, Interval Rec, Frame Rec, Slow & Quick)  
• When the shutter mode is SLS  
1
Set the OUTPUT/DCC switch to CAM.  
Adjusting the Black Balance and the White Balance  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
54  
       
Note  
Adjusting the White Balance  
If the camcorder has a zoom lens with an automatic  
iris, the iris may hunt 1) during the adjustment. To  
prevent this, adjust the iris gain knob (indicated as  
IG, IS, or S) on the lens.  
1
Set the switches and selectors as shown  
below.  
• GAIN switch: L (set to a gain value that is  
For details, refer to the lens operation manual.  
as small as possible)  
• OUTPUT/DCC switch: CAM  
• WHITE BAL switch: A or B  
1) Adjustment values are saved to memory B only  
when OPERATION >White Setting >White  
Switch<B> in the setup menu, is set to  
[Memory].  
1) Hunting: Repeated brightening and darkening of  
the image, resulting from repeated response to  
automatic iris control.  
1)  
If the automatic white balance adjustment  
cannot be made  
If the white balance adjustment cannot be  
completed normally, an error message will appear  
for about three seconds on the viewfinder screen.  
Possible messages are listed below.  
2
3
Set the FILTER selector to suit the  
lighting conditions as follows.  
Place a white test card under the same  
lighting conditions as for the subject to  
be shot and zoom up to it.  
Alternatively, any white object such as a  
cloth or a wall can be used.  
Error message Meaning  
NG: Low Light The white video level is too low.  
Either open the lens iris or  
increase the gain.  
NG: Timeout  
Adjustment could not be  
completed within the standard  
number of attempts.  
The absolute minimum white area is as  
follows.  
Rectangle centered on the screen. The  
lengths of the sides are 70% of the length  
and width of the screen.  
NG: High Light The white video level is too  
high. Either stop down the lens  
iris or change the ND filter.  
If any of the above error messages is displayed,  
retry the white balance adjustment. If the error  
message occurs again, an internal check is  
necessary.  
For information about this internal check, refer to  
the Maintenance Manual.  
Note  
If you have no time to adjust the white  
balance  
Make sure there are not bright spots in the  
rectangle.  
Set the WHITE BAL switch to PRST.  
4
5
Adjust the lens iris.  
Manually adjusted lens: set the iris to an  
appropriate setting.  
Lens with automatic iris: set the automatic/  
manual switch on the lens to automatic.  
This makes it possible to automatically set the  
white balance to 5600K (factory default value) by  
pressing the COLOR TEMP. button.  
The color temperature to which the white balance  
is set when the COLOR TEMP. button is pressed  
can be selected from among 3200K, 4300K,  
5600K, and 6300K on OPERATION  
>Assignable SW in the setup menu. You can also  
assign color temperatures to the ASSIGN. 1/3  
switches or ASSIGNABLE 4/5 switches.  
Push the AUTO W/B BAL switch to  
WHITE and then release the switch.  
The message “Executing...” appears during  
execution, and changes to “OK: (color  
temperature of subject)” when the  
adjustment finishes.  
The adjustment values are saved  
automatically in the memory selected in  
step 1 (A or B).  
Adjusting the Black Balance and the White Balance  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To set no color temperature  
Select “-----” with Electrical CC<C> or <D>  
selected.  
To change the color temperature when  
the ND filter is switched  
When the assignable switch is pressed, the  
setting for that position is not displayed. For  
example, if “-----” is set for one position, then  
switching between the remaining three  
positions is carried out.  
You can assign electrical CC (color correction)  
filters to ND filters (see page 17). This allows you  
to change the color temperature automatically  
when the ND filter is switched.  
1
Set MAINTENANCE >White Filter  
>ND Filter C.Temp in the setup menu  
3
4
Repeat step 2 as required.  
Assign the electrical CC filter switching  
function (ELECTRICAL CC) to an  
assignable switch (see page 158).  
2
To assign an electrical CC filter to  
FILTER selector position number 1,  
select [ND FLT C.Temp<1>]. To assign  
it to positions 2 to 4, select [ND FLT  
C.Temp<2-4>].  
White balance memory  
Values stored in memory are held until the white  
balance is next adjusted even when the camcorder  
power is turned off.  
The camcorder has two white balance memories,  
A and B. You can automatically save adjustment  
values for each ND filter in the memory that  
corresponds to the WHITE BAL switch setting  
(A or B). The camcorder has four built-in ND  
filters, allowing you to save a total of eight  
adjustment values (4 × 2). However, the contents  
of the memories are not linked to ND filter  
settings in the following cases.  
3
4
Turn the MENU knob to select the  
desired color temperature.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the color  
temperature changes as follows: 3200K y  
4300K y 5600K y 6300K.  
Repeat steps 2 and 3 as required.  
To switch between electrical CC filters  
with an assignable switch  
• When the number of memories allocated to  
each of A and B is limited to one by setting  
OPERATION >White Setting >Filter White  
Memory in the setup menu to Off.  
• When the electrical CC filter switching function  
has been assigned to an assignable switch, or  
when a remote control unit has been connected.  
(In these cases, the contents of white balance  
memory are linked to electrical CC filter  
positions (A to D).)  
You can assign the function that switches  
between electrical CC filters to an assignable  
switch. This allows you to switch between color  
temperatures (3200K/4300K/5600K/6300K) that  
have been assigned to up to four positions (A to  
D) with each press of the assignable switch.  
Regardless of assignments to assignable  
switches, you can also switch between the color  
temperatures assigned to each position from a  
RM-B150/B750 Remote Control Unit.  
1
2
Select MAINTENANCE >White Filter  
in the setup menu (see page 143).  
Also, when OPERATION >White Setting  
>White Switch<B> in the setup menu is set to  
[ATW (Auto Tracing White Balance)], and the  
WHITE BAL switch is set to B, the ATW  
function is activated to automatically adjust the  
white balance of the picture being shot for  
varying lighting conditions.  
Select the position to which to assign a  
CC filter by selecting one of [Electrical  
CC<A>] to [Electrical CC <D>], and  
then turn the MENU knob to select the  
desired color temperature.  
As you turn the MENU knob, the color  
temperature changes as follows: 3200K y  
4300K y 5600K y 6300K.  
Adjusting the Black Balance and the White Balance  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
56  
System lines: 1080  
Setting the Electronic  
Shutter  
System  
Shutter speed (unit: Hz)  
frequency  
59.94i  
50i  
S&Q: Off  
S&Q: On  
60.00 to 3800  
50.00 to 3500  
29.97P  
23.98P  
25P  
29.99 to 4100 32.01 to 4100  
23.99 to 3700 32.02 to 3700  
25.00 to 3900 32.03 to 3900  
Shutter Modes  
System lines: 720  
The shutter modes that can be used with the  
electronic shutter and the shutter speeds that can  
be selected are listed below.  
System  
frequency  
Shutter speed (unit: Hz)  
S&Q: Off  
S&Q: On  
59.94P  
50P  
60.07 to 4100 32.01 to 4100  
50.03 to 3900 32.03 to 3900  
29.99 to 4100 32.01 to 4100  
23.99 to 3700 32.02 to 3700  
25.00 to 3900 32.03 to 3900  
Standard mode  
Select this mode for shooting fast-moving  
subjects with little blurring.  
You can set the shutter speed in one of two shutter  
modes: Speed mode, in which the speed is set in  
seconds, and Angle mode, in which the speed is  
set in degrees.  
29.97P  
23.98P  
25P  
SLS (slow speed shutter) mode  
Select this mode for shooting subjects in low level  
lighting conditions.  
Speed mode  
System  
frequency  
59.94i  
59.94P  
50i  
Shutter speed (unit: seconds)  
OPERATION >Format Number of  
>HD System Line setting accumulated frames  
in the setup menu  
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
/
/
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
/
,
60, 100, 120 125 250 500  
1
/
1080  
720  
2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 16  
2, 4, 6, 8, 16  
1000 2000  
50P  
1
1
a)  
,
1
a) 1  
1
1
1
Notes  
29.97P  
/
/
/
/
/
/
, /  
/ , / , /  
/
,
,
40  
50  
,
60 100, 120 125  
1
1
1
/
1
,
/
,
/
• SLS mode cannot be used when the video format is SP  
1440/23.98P or when the camcorder is in Slow &  
Quick Motion mode.  
• It is not possible to use SLS mode when OPERATION  
>Input/Output >i.Link I/O is set to [Enable] in the  
setup menu.  
250 500 1000 2000  
1
1
a)  
a)  
1
1
1
1
25P  
, /  
, / , /  
/
/
33  
50  
60, 100 120, 125  
1
1
1
,
/
1
,
/
,
/
1
250 500 1000 2000  
1
1
a)  
a)  
1
a)  
1
1
23.98P  
, /  
, /  
, / , / , /  
,
32  
48  
50  
60 96 100  
1
1
1
1
1
/
, / , / , /  
, /  
120, 125 250 500 1000 2000  
a) This speed cannot be selected when the camcorder is  
in Slow & Quick Motion mode and OPERATION  
>Rec Function >Frame Rate in the setup menu is set  
to a value that is greater than the system frequency.  
• It is not possible to output the color bar signal, turn the  
SLS mode on or off, or change the number of  
accumulated frames when the number of accumulated  
frames is set to 16.  
Angle mode  
180°, 90°, 45°, 22.5°, and 11.25°  
Selecting the Shutter Mode and  
Shutter Speed  
ECS (Extended Clear Scan) mode  
Select this mode for obtaining images with no  
horizontal bands of noise when shooting subjects  
such as monitor screens.  
As shown in the following tables, the range of  
shutter speeds that can be set varies depending on  
whether the Slow & Quick Motion (S&Q)  
function is on or off.  
Notes  
• When the automatic iris is used, the iris opens wider as  
the shutter speed increases, thus reducing the depth of  
field.  
• The selectable shutter speeds vary depending on the  
current system frequency.  
Setting the Electronic Shutter  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
To switch between Speed mode and  
Angle mode  
To set the shutter speed in ECS mode  
1
2
Set the shutter mode to ECS (see the  
previous item).  
1
Select OPEARTION >Shutter Select  
>Shutter Select in the setup menu (see  
Turn the MENU knob to select the  
desired frequency or number of frames.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to select Second  
or Degree, and then press the knob.  
To set the shutter speed in SLS mode  
1
Set OPERATION >Shutter >Slow  
Shutter in the setup menu to [On] (see  
To set the shutter mode and standard-  
mode shutter speed  
Once the shutter speed is selected, it is retained  
even when the camcorder power is turned off.  
2
Select the desired number of  
accumulated frames with  
OPERATION >Shutter >SLS Frames  
in the setup menu.  
1
Push the SHUTTER selector from ON  
to SELECT.  
The current shutter setting indication appears  
for about three seconds.  
2
Before the shutter setting indication  
disappears, push the SHUTTER  
selector down to SELECT again and  
repeat this until the desired mode or  
speed appears.  
When all modes and speeds are displayed,  
the display changes in the following order.  
Speed Mode (with system frequency 59.94i)  
ECS Mode  
Note  
Depending on the frame rate setting (see page 83), some  
shutter speeds cannot be selected in Slow & Quick  
Motion mode. These speeds are replaced by the slowest  
selectable shutter speed.  
Example: If you perform Slow & Quick Motion  
shooting when setting the frame rate to 60 and the video  
format to HQ1280/29.97P  
The shutter speed is indicated as follows.  
When Slow & Quick Motion mode is off  
1/40t1/50t1/60t1/100t...  
When Slow & Quick Motion mode is on  
1/60t1/60t1/60t1/100t...  
Setting the Electronic Shutter  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To set the automatic iris window  
Changing the Reference  
Value for Automatic Iris  
Adjustment  
1
Set OPERATION >Auto Iris >Iris  
Window Indication in the setup menu to  
On.  
The current automatic iris window appears  
on the viewfinder screen.  
If it is not necessary to display the auto iris  
window on the screen, set to Off.  
The reference value for automatic iris adjustment  
can be changed to aid the shooting of clear  
pictures of back-lit subjects, or to prevent blown-  
out highlights. The reference value for the lens  
iris can be set within the following range with  
respect to the standard value.  
• 0.25 to 1 (increasing by increments of 0.25):  
About 0.25 to 1 stop further open  
• –0.25 to –1 (decreasing by increments of 0.25):  
About 0.25 to 1 stop further close  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to select Iris  
Window, and then press the knob.  
Turn the MENU knob until the desired  
auto iris window appears, and then  
press the knob.  
Also you can set the area where light detection  
occurs.  
The shaded parts indicate the  
area where light detection  
To change the reference value  
If you select “Var”, the following items  
become effective and you can set the window  
of the desired size. Set the following items  
with MAINTENANCE >Auto Iris2.  
1
Set OPERATION >Auto Iris >Iris  
Override in the setup menu to On (see  
Item  
Setting  
2
3
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF.  
Iris Var Width The width of the window  
Iris Var Height The height of the window  
Iris Var H Pos The position of the window  
in the horizontal direction  
Turn the MENU knob to change the  
reference value.  
Note  
Iris Var V Pos. The position of the window  
in the vertical direction.  
Be sure to confirm that the current shutter mode is  
not ECS.  
When you exit the menu, the auto iris window  
selected in step 3 appears.  
Unless you need to keep this window displayed,  
set OPERATION >Auto Iris >Iris Window  
Indication in the setup menu to Off.  
An indicator of the current reference value is  
shown at the iris position indication (see  
page 34) on the viewfinder screen.  
To make the iris more open  
Turn the MENU knob counterclockwise as  
seen from the front of the camcorder.  
Select one of 0.25, 0.5, 0.75, or 1.  
To counter problems with very bright  
highlights  
If the subject is too bright, the iris may close too  
much, leaving the overall image dark, or the  
highlights may be blown out. In such cases,  
setting the highlight clip function on reduces the  
luminance range, avoiding problems from the  
automatic iris correction.  
To stop down the iris  
Turn the MENU knob clockwise as seen  
from the front of the camcorder.  
Select one of –0.25, –0.5, –0.75, or –1.  
The changed reference value is retained until  
the power of the camcorder is turned off.  
Even if the reference value is changed, it  
reverts to the standard value every time the  
power is turned on.  
Set OPERATION >Auto Iris >Clip High Light in  
the setup menu to On.  
Changing the Reference Value for Automatic Iris Adjustment  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
59  
       
2
3
Set the AUDIO SELECT switch(es)  
corresponding to the channel(s) selected  
in step 1 to MANUAL.  
Adjusting the Audio  
Level  
With the LEVEL knob(s) for the  
channel(s) selected in step 1, adjust so  
that the audio level meter shows up to  
–20 dB for a normal input volume.  
When you set the AUDIO SELECT switch to  
AUTO, the input levels of analog audio signals  
recorded on each channel are adjusted  
automatically. You can also make manual  
adjustments.  
Correspondence between recording level  
adjustments and audio level controls  
On MAINTENANCE >Audio in the setup menu,  
you can select which audio level control controls  
the audio recording level of the input to each of  
the AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2 connectors. The  
correspondences between the settings of the menu  
items and the controls are as follows.  
Note  
Even if you set the AUDIO SELECT switch to AUTO,  
the input levels of digital audio signals are not adjusted  
automatically.  
Target audio level for manual audio level  
adjustment  
Make adjustment using –20 dB as the target level.  
If the audio level meter shows a maximum level  
of 0 dB, then it indicates that the input audio level  
is excessive.  
Rear1/WRR Level: Channel 1 recording level  
Setting  
Side1  
Knob  
LEVEL (CH1) knob  
MIC LEVEL control  
LEVEL (CH1) knob and MIC  
LEVEL control (linked  
operation)  
Front  
Front+Side1  
Excessive input level  
Rear2/WRR Level: Channel 2 recording level  
Setting  
Side2  
Knob  
LEVEL (CH2) knob  
MIC LEVEL control  
LEVEL (CH2) knob and MIC  
LEVEL control (linked  
operation)  
Front  
Front+Side2  
Note  
Target input level  
When you have operation of the LEVEL (CH1/CH2)  
knobs and MIC LEVEL control linked together, if the  
MIC LEVEL control is set to 0, the audio signals on  
channels 1 and 2 cannot be recorded. Check the position  
of the MIC LEVEL control before adjusting the LEVEL  
(CH1/CH2) knobs.  
Manually Adjusting the Audio  
Levels of the Audio Inputs from  
the AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2  
Connectors  
Manually Adjusting the Audio  
Level of the MIC IN Connector  
1
To adjust the signal input to the AUDIO  
IN CH-1 or CH-2 connector, set the  
AUDIO IN CH1 or CH2 switch to  
REAR.  
1
Set either or both of the AUDIO IN  
switch(es) to FRONT.  
To adjust both input signals, set both  
switches to REAR.  
Adjusting the Audio Level  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
60  
       
2
3
Set the AUDIO SELECT switch(es) for  
the desired channel(s) selected in step 1  
to MANUAL.  
CH3 switch  
FRONT  
Channel 3 recording target  
Front microphone audio  
Audio signal input to AUDIO IN  
CH1 connector  
REAR  
Turn the MIC LEVEL control, and  
adjust so that the audio level meter  
shows up to –20 dB for a normal input  
volume.  
WIRELESS  
Wireless microphone audio  
CH4 switch  
FRONT  
Channel 4 recording target  
Front microphone audio  
Audio signal input to AUDIO IN  
CH2 connector  
REAR  
Correspondence between recording level  
adjustments and audio level controls  
WIRELESS  
Wireless microphone audio  
On MAINTENANCE >Audio in the setup menu,  
you can select which audio level control controls  
the audio recording level of the front microphone  
input. The correspondences between the settings  
of the menu items and the controls are as follows.  
You can have the selection made automatically,  
as follows.  
To automatically select the same audio as on  
channels 1 and 2  
Set MAINTENANCE >Audio >Audio CH3/4  
Mode of the setup menu to [Ch1/2].  
MIC CH1 Level: Channel 1 recording level  
Setting  
Side1  
Knob  
Adjusting the audio recording levels  
LEVEL (CH1) knob  
MIC LEVEL control  
LEVEL (CH1) knob and MIC  
LEVEL control (linked  
operation)  
Front  
To adjust automatically  
Set the AUDIO SELECT CH 3-4 switch to  
AUTO.  
Front+Side1  
To adjust manually  
MIC CH2 Level: Channel 2 recording level  
1
2
Set the AUDIO SELECT CH 3-4 switch  
to MANUAL.  
Setting  
Side2  
Knob  
LEVEL (CH2) knob  
MIC LEVEL control  
LEVEL (CH2) knob and MIC  
LEVEL control (linked  
operation)  
Front  
Select the knobs that adjust the audio  
levels with the Audio CH3 Level and  
Audio CH4 Level items under  
MAINTENANCE >Audio in the setup  
menu.  
Front+Side2  
Note  
When you have operation of the MIC LEVEL control  
and LEVEL (CH1/CH2) knobs linked together, if the  
LEVEL (CH1/CH2) knobs are set to 0, the audio signals  
on channels 1 and 2 cannot be recorded. Check the  
position of the LEVEL (CH1/CH2) knobs before  
adjusting the MIC LEVEL control.  
Audio CH3 Level: Channel 3 recording  
level  
Setting  
Side3  
Knob  
LEVEL (CH3) knob  
MIC LEVEL control  
LEVEL (CH3) knob and  
MIC LEVEL control (linked  
operation)  
Front  
Front+Side3  
Recording Audio on Channels 3  
and 4  
Audio CH4 Level: Channel 4 recording  
Selecting the recorded audio  
level  
You can select the audio recorded on audio  
channels 3 and 4 with the AUDIO IN CH3/CH4  
switches.  
Setting  
Side4  
Front  
Knob  
LEVEL (CH4) knob  
MIC LEVEL control  
Adjusting the Audio Level  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting  
Knob  
Front+Side4  
LEVEL (CH4) knob and  
MIC LEVEL control (linked  
operation)  
Setting the Time Data  
You can now adjust the levels of audio  
channels 3 and 4 with the knobs selected  
here.  
Note  
When picture cache mode is enabled, it is not possible to  
set time data, even if you set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN  
switch to SET. If you want to set time data, first exit  
picture cache mode.  
Setting the Timecode  
The timecode setting range is from 00 : 00 : 00 :  
00 to 23 : 59 : 59 : 29 (hours : minutes : seconds :  
frames).  
1
Press the DISP SEL/EXPAND button to  
switch the display in the LCD monitor  
to status display.  
2
3
Set the DISPLAY switch to TC.  
Set the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK  
switch to PRESET.  
4
5
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to  
SET.  
The first (leftmost) digit of timecode flashes.  
Use the up and down arrow buttons to  
change values, and use the left and right  
arrow buttons to move the flashing  
digit. Repeat until all digits are set.  
To reset the timecode value to 00:00:00:00  
Press the RESET/RETURN button.  
6
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to  
F-RUN or R-RUN.  
F-RUN: Free run. The timecode generator  
keeps running.  
R-RUN: Recording run. The timecode  
generator runs only while recording.  
To set the drop frame mode/non-drop frame  
mode  
You can select the drop frame (DF) mode or non-  
drop frame (NDF) mode on MAINTENANCE  
>Timecode in the setup menu.  
Setting the Time Data  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
To make the timecode consecutive  
Synchronizing the Timecode  
When the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch is set to  
R-RUN, recording a number of scenes on the  
media normally produces consecutive timecode.  
However, once you remove the media and record  
on another media, the timecode will no longer be  
consecutive when you use the original media  
again for recording. In this case, to make the  
timecode consecutive, set the PRESET/REGEN/  
CLOCK switch to REGEN.  
You can synchronize the internal timecode  
generator of this camcorder with an external  
generator for the regeneration of an external  
timecode. You can also synchronize the timecode  
generators of other camcorders/VTRs with the  
internal generator of this camcorder.  
Connections for timecode  
synchronization  
Connect both the reference video signal and the  
external timecode as illustrated below.  
Saving the real Time in the Timecode  
Setting the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK switch to  
CLOCK saves the real time in the timecode.  
When it is necessary to set the actual time, use  
MAINTENANCE >Clock Set >Date/Time in the  
setup menu.  
Example 1: Synchronizing with an external  
timecode  
Setting the User Bits  
By setting the user bits (up to 8 hexadecimal  
digits), you can record user information such as  
the date, time, or scene number on the timecode  
track.  
External timecode  
Reference video signal  
1
Press the DISP SEL/EXPAND button to  
switch the display in the LCD monitor  
to status display.  
1 GENLOCK IN connector  
2 TC IN connector  
2
3
Set the DISPLAY switch to U-BIT.  
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to  
SET.  
The first (leftmost) digit flashes.  
4
Use the up and down arrow buttons to  
change values, and use the left and right  
arrow buttons to move the flashing  
digit. Repeat until all digits are set.  
To reset the user bit data to 00 00 00 00  
Press the RESET/RETURN button.  
5
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to  
F-RUN or R-RUN, corresponding to the  
desired operating mode for the  
timecode generator.  
To store the user bit setting in memory  
The user bit setting (apart from the real time) is  
automatically retained in memory even when the  
power is turned off.  
Setting the Time Data  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Example 2: Interconnecting a number of  
camcorders (including one reference  
camcorder)  
This operation synchronizes the internal  
timecode generator with the external  
timecode. After about 10 seconds, you can  
disconnect the external timecode without  
losing the synchronization.  
Notes  
• When you finish the above procedure, the internal  
timecode is immediately synchronized with the  
external timecode and the counter display will show  
the value of the external timecode. However, wait for  
a few seconds until the sync generator stabilizes before  
recording.  
• If the frequency of the reference video signal is not the  
same as the system frequency of the camcorder, the  
camcorder cannot be correctly genlocked. In such a  
case, the internal timecode is not correctly  
synchronized with the external timecode.  
User bit settings during timecode  
synchronization  
When the timecode is synchronized, only the time  
data is synchronized with the external timecode  
value.  
To release the timecode synchronization  
First disconnect the external timecode, then set  
the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to R-RUN.  
To another camcorder to be synchronized  
To change the power supply from the battery  
pack to an external power supply during  
timecode synchronization  
1 VIDEO OUT connector  
2 TC OUT connector  
3 TC IN connector  
To maintain a continuous power supply, connect  
the external power supply to the DC IN connector  
before removing the battery pack. You may lose  
timecode synchronization if you remove the  
battery pack first.  
4 GENLOCK IN connector  
To lock the timecode to an external  
source  
Camcorder synchronization during timecode  
synchronization  
During timecode synchronization, the camcorder  
is genlocked to the reference video signal input  
from the GENLOCK IN connector.  
1
2
Turn on the POWER switch.  
Set the PRESET/REGEN/CLOCK  
switch to PRESET.  
3
Set the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to  
F-RUN.  
4
5
Set the DISPLAY switch to TC.  
Supply a timecode signal and a  
reference video signal complying with  
the SMPTE standard and in proper  
phase relationship, to the TC IN  
connector and to the GENLOCK IN  
connector, respectively.  
Setting the Time Data  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
64  
To create a shot ID  
Setting Shot Data  
1
With OPEARTION >Shot ID in the  
setup menu, turn the MENU knob to  
select a shot ID to create (ID-1 to ID-4)  
and press the knob.  
While color bars are output, shot data can be  
displayed.  
The shot ID setting screen appears.  
Example display of shot data  
2
Follow the procedure in “To enter text ”  
(page 110) to create a shot ID.  
You can select which shot data is superimposed  
on the color bars with OPEARTION >Shot  
Display in the setup menu.  
Shot Date  
To superimpose the shot date, turn the MENU  
knob to set Shot Date to [On] and press the knob.  
Shot Time  
To superimpose the shot time, turn the MENU  
knob to set Shot Time to [On] and press the knob.  
Shot Model Name  
To superimpose the model name, turn the MENU  
knob to set Shot Model Name to [On] and press  
the knob.  
Shot Serial Number  
To superimpose the serial number, turn the  
MENU knob to set Shot Serial Number to [On]  
and press the knob.  
Shot ID Select  
To superimpose a shot ID created arbitrarily, turn  
the MENU knob to set Shot ID Select to one of  
[ID-1] to [ID-4] and press the knob.  
To create a shot ID, see the next sexton “Creating  
a Shot ID”.  
Creating a Shot ID  
Up to four shot IDs of up to 16 characters can be  
created.  
Setting Shot Data  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
AUDIO status screen  
This screen displays settings and status  
Checking Camcorder  
Settings and Status  
Information (Status  
Screens)  
information related to audio input and output.  
The status screens allow you to check camcorder  
settings and various types of status information.  
There are five status screens, listed below.  
CH-1/CH-2/CH-3/CH-4: Audio level meters  
and input sources  
Wind Filter: Wind filter settings  
Status screen  
Information displayed  
CAMERA status Settings and status information  
related to shooting  
VIDEO status screen  
This screen displays settings and status  
information related to recording and playback.  
AUDIO status  
Settings and status information  
related to audio input and  
output  
VIDEO status  
Settings and status information  
related to recording and  
playback  
ASSIGN  
Names of functions assigned  
to assignable switches  
Status of the battery mounted  
on the camcorder and the  
media status  
SWITCH status  
BATTERY/  
MEDIA status  
Video Format: Video format  
Rec Mode: Recording bit rate (HD mode only)  
Output&i.LINK: Output&i.LINK setting and  
i.LINK usage status  
SDI Output: HD/SD SDI OUT connector output  
setting  
To display status screens  
With no menu is displayed, press the MENU  
CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE switch up to the  
CANCEL/PRST side. Each push selects the next  
status screen, in the order given in the table  
above.  
Down Converter: SD output down converter  
setting (HD mode only)  
ASSIGN SWITCH status screen  
This screen displays the names of the functions  
assigned to assignable switches  
CAMERA status screen  
This screen displays settings and status  
information related to shooting.  
White Bal: White balance status  
Gain: GAIN switch status  
Zoom Speed: Zoom speed set with the lens  
ZOOM button  
Zebra: Zebra status  
Skin Detail: Skin details status  
Checking Camcorder Settings and Status Information (Status Screens)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
66  
               
BATTERY/MEDIA status screen  
This screen displays the status of the battery  
mounted on the camcorder and the media status.  
Battery: The remaining battery capacity  
Charge Count: The number of times the battery  
has been charged  
HDD A/HDD B: Remaining battery capacity of  
PHU-120R (in FAT mode)  
Media A/Media B:  
• Remaining capacity of media  
• Recordable time  
• Approximate writable lifetime (Life)  
“Life 100%” is shown for unused media.  
Checking Camcorder Settings and Status Information (Status Screens)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
67  
 
Chapter4 Shooting  
Notes on the use of SxS memory cards  
• Recorded data may be lost or corrupted in the  
following cases.  
Handling SxS Memory  
Cards  
- When the camcorder is subjected to shock or  
vibrations during reading, writing, or  
formatting of an SxS memory card, and when  
the camcorder is powered off or an SxS  
memory card is removed during reading,  
writing, or formatting  
- When the camcorder is used in an  
environment subject to static electricity or  
electric noise  
• Do not use or store SxS memory cards in  
locations that are:  
- Outside the specified environmental ranges  
- Very hot, such in as vehicles parked in the sun  
during summer, or exposed to direct sunlight,  
or near heaters  
This camcorder records video and audio on SxS  
memory cards (not supplied) loaded into one or  
both of its memory card slots.  
The PHU-120R Professional Harddisk Unit or  
MEAD-MS01/SD01 Media Adaptor can also be  
used for recording (when the recording mode is  
FAT). For details, refer to the Supplement  
supplied in the CD-ROM (labeled “Manuals for  
Solid-State Memory Camcorder”).  
- Subject to high humidity and corrosion  
• When inserting a memory card, insert with the  
label side facing the correct direction.  
• Carry and store SxS memory cards in their  
cases, and lock the cases securely.  
About SxS Memory Cards  
SxS memory cards that can be used with  
this camcorder  
Use the following Sony SxS memory cards (SxS  
PRO or SxS-1) with this camcorder.  
SxS PRO  
• SBP-16 (16 GB)  
• SBP-32 (32 GB)  
SxS-1  
• SBS-32G1A (32 GB)  
• SBS-64G1A (64 GB)  
• To use SxS-1 memory card “SBS-32G1” in  
UDF mode, the software may need to be  
updated. For details, access the Sony website  
closest to your area. (Refer to the top page of the  
CD-ROM Manual on the supplied CD-ROM.)  
• Guard against accidents and inadvertent data  
loss by backing up the data stored on SxS  
memory cards. Sony cannot be responsible for  
any consequences of damage to or loss of data  
stored on SxS memory cards.  
Proper operation cannot be guaranteed when  
memory cards other than SxS PRO and SxS-1 are  
used.  
The memory cards listed above comply with the  
ExpressCard memory card standard.  
• SxS, SxS PRO and SxS-1 are trademarks of  
Sony Corporation.  
• The ExpressCard label and logo are property of  
the Personal Computer Memory Card  
International Association (PCMCIA) and are  
licensed to Sony Corporation. Other trademarks  
and trade names are the property of their  
respective owners.  
• Do not attach anything other than the supplied  
labels in the designated label space. When  
attaching a label, make sure it does not protrude  
beyond the label space.  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Loading and Ejecting SxS Memory  
Cards  
To load SxS memory cards  
Label space  
1
2
Slide the cover to the left to open.  
• Use this camcorder to format SxS memory  
cards that will be used with this camcorder.  
When memory cards are formatted on another  
unit, the format is regarded as an invalid format,  
making it necessary to format the memory cards  
again.  
Insert an SxS memory card into a card  
slot.  
However, note that the format and delete  
functions of this camcorder do not completely  
remove data from memory cards. Before  
discarding or disposing of a memory card, erase  
it using commercial data erasure software, or  
physically destroy it. Sony cannot be  
responsible for any failure to erase data  
completely.  
• Clip operations may not be possible when the  
remaining capacity of the media is low. In this  
case, use a computer to delete unneeded files  
and try again.  
• Open the memory card case completely before  
storing a card in the case or removing a card  
from the case.  
Insert with the label  
side facing right.  
The ACCESS lamp lights in orange, and then  
lights in green to indicate that the memory  
card is usable.  
3
Close the cover.  
ACCESS lamp status indications  
Card slots A and B each have an ACCESS lamp  
to indicate the slot status.  
Lamp  
Slot status  
Preventing accidental erasure  
You can prevent accidental recording, editing,  
and deletion of data on an SxS memory card by  
setting the write protect switch to the WP side.  
Lights in orange Accessing the SxS memory card  
(lights during data reading and  
writing)  
Lights in green Standby (the loaded SxS  
memory card is ready for  
recording or playback)  
Write protect switch  
Not lit  
• No SxS memory card is  
loaded.  
• An unusable card is loaded.  
• An SxS memory card is  
loaded, but the other slot is  
selected.  
Note  
Do not touch the write protect switch while an SxS  
memory card is loaded in a card slot. Eject the card  
before setting the write protect switch.  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
The camcorder switches automatically to the  
other card if the selected card becomes full during  
recording.  
To eject SxS memory cards  
1
Open the cover, and then press the  
EJECT button to release the lock and  
pull the button out.  
Note  
The SLOT SELECT button is disabled during playback.  
Even when pressed, it does not change the selected slot.  
Button operations are enabled when a thumbnail screen  
(see page 91) is displayed.  
Formatting (Initializing) SxS  
Memory Cards  
When you load an unformatted memory card,  
load a memory card that has been formatted to  
other specifications, or load a memory card that  
has been formatted in UDF mode into the  
camcorder set to FAT mode, a message to  
confirm if formatting is to be executed appears in  
the viewfinder (see page 71). In this case, format  
the memory card in the following way.  
SxS memory cards are formatted in FAT mode as  
factory default.  
Press the button once  
to release the lock.  
2
Press the EJECT button again to eject  
the card.  
Note  
SxS memory cards must be formatted on an  
XDCAM EX device or on this camcorder. Cards  
in other formats cannot be used.  
To format (initialize) a memory card  
If the message for formatting is displayed, turn  
the MENU knob to select “Execute”, and then  
press the knob.  
Execution of the format starts.  
During execution of the format, a progress  
indication appears (%), and the ACCESS lamp  
lights in orange.  
When formatting is completed, the completion  
message is displayed for three seconds.  
Note  
Data integrity cannot be guaranteed if you power the  
camcorder off or remove a memory card while the card  
is being accessed. Doing so may corrupt all data recorded  
on the card. Always make sure that the ACCESS lamp is  
lit green or not lit before you power the camcorder off or  
remove a memory card.  
Recording and playback during format execution  
Even during execution of a format, recording and  
playback are possible using an SxS memory card  
loaded into the other card slot.  
Selecting the SxS Memory Card to  
Use  
If the format operation fails  
A format operation may fail because the SxS  
memory card is write protected, or because it is  
not the type of card specified for use with this  
camcorder.  
When SxS memory cards are loaded in both slot  
A and slot B, you can press the SLOT SELECT  
button to select the SxS memory card to use.  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
In this case, an error message appears. Following  
the instructions in the error message and  
exchange the card for an SxS memory card that  
can be used with this camcorder.  
• An SxS memory card which was used for  
recording in UDF mode is loaded into the  
camcorder set to FAT mode.  
• An SxS memory card which was used for  
recording in FAT mode is loaded into the  
camcorder set to UDF mode.  
• An SxS memory card which was formatted in  
FAT mode is loaded into the camcorder set to  
UDF mode.  
To format by menu operation  
When no formatting message is displayed, you  
can execute formatting by menu operation.  
1
2
3
Select OPERATION >Format Media in  
the setup menu (see page 113).  
Cases in which a message to confirm if  
formatting is to be executed appears  
When an SxS memory card which was formatted  
in UDF mode is loaded into the camcorder set to  
FAT mode. a message to confirm if formatting is  
to be executed in FAT mode appears in the  
viewfinder (see page 70).  
Select [Media(A)] (slot A) or [Media(B)]  
(slot B).  
Turn the MENU knob to select  
[Execute], and then press the knob.  
The confirmation message for formatting is  
displayed on the viewfinder screen.  
Checking the Remaining  
Recording Time  
4
Turn the MENU knob to select  
“Execute”, and press the knob.  
Execution of the format starts.  
You can check the remaining capacity of the SxS  
memory cards loaded in the two slots by checking  
the recording media remaining capacity display  
in the viewfinder.  
During execution of the format, a progress  
indication appears (%), and the ACCESS lamp  
lights in orange.  
When formatting is completed, the completion  
message is displayed for three seconds.  
Notes  
• All data is erased when you format a memory card,  
including setup files and all of the recorded video data.  
• Use the format function of this camcorder to format  
SxS memory cards for use on this camcorder. The  
formats of cards formatted on other devices are not  
recognized as valid formats, making it necessary to  
format them again on this camcorder.  
The camcorder calculates the remaining  
recording time for the media in each slot on the  
basis of the current video format (recording bit  
rate), and displays it in units of minutes.  
You can also check the remaining time in the  
BATTERY/MEDIA status screen (see page 67).  
Note  
If You Load a Memory Card  
Formatted in the Different  
Recording Mode from the Mode  
Selected on the Camcorder  
The  
protected.  
mark appears when a memory card is write  
When to exchange SxS memory cards  
• The warning message “Media Near Full”  
appears, the WARNING indicator and the REC  
indication on the viewfinder screen flash, and  
the buzzer sounds when the total remaining  
recording time of the two memory cards falls to  
five minutes during recording.  
An error message or a message to confirm if  
formatting is to be executed appears.  
Cases in which an error message appears  
The message “Cannot Use Media(A)/  
Unsupported File System” appears in the  
viewfinder in the following cases.  
Exchange one of the cards for media with  
available recording capacity.  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
• If you continue recording, the message “Media  
Full” appears and recording stops when the total  
remaining recording time falls to 0.  
2
3
Format the unusable SxS memory card on  
the camcorder.  
Copy the required clips back to the newly  
formatted SxS memory card.  
Note  
Recording and playback during restoration  
Even while restoration is in progress, you can  
record and play an SxS memory card in the other  
card slot.  
About up to 600 clips can be recorded on one SxS  
memory card.  
The display of remaining recording time changes to “0”  
and the message “Media Full” appears when the clip  
limit is reached.  
Note  
For restoration of media recorded with this camcorder,  
be sure to use this camcorder. Media recorded with a  
device other than this camcorder or with another  
camcorder of different version (even of the same model)  
may not be restored using this camcorder.  
Restoring SxS Memory Cards  
If for any reason an error should occur in a  
memory card, the card must be restored before  
use.  
When you load an SxS memory card that needs to  
be restored, a message appears in the viewfinder  
to ask whether you want to restore it.  
To restore a card  
Turn the MENU knob to select [Execute], and  
then press the knob.  
The restoration starts.  
During the restoration, a execution message  
appears, the progress is displayed (%), and the  
ACCESS lamp lights in orange.  
When the restoration finishes, a completion  
message is displayed for three seconds.  
If restoration fails  
• Write protected SxS memory cards and cards on  
which memory errors have occurred cannot be  
restored. A warning message appears for such  
cards. Follow the instructions in the message  
and unprotect the card or replace it with another  
card.  
• SxS memory cards on which memory errors  
have occurred may become usable if they are  
reformatted.  
• In some cases, some clips can be restored while  
others cannot. The restored clips can be played  
normally.  
• If the message “Could not Restore Some Clips”  
keeps appearing after repeated attempts at  
restoration, it may be possible to restore the SxS  
memory card with the following procedure.  
1
Use the camcorder’s copy function (see  
page 102) or the supplied application  
software (see page 170) to copy the  
required clips to another SxS memory card.  
Handling SxS Memory Cards  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
72  
   
2
Turn the MENU knob to select  
“Execute” and press the knob.  
When formatting is completed, the message  
“Format USB Memory Done” is displayed.  
The \MSSONY\PRO\XDCAM\MEMDISC  
folder and the \General\Sony\Planning folder  
are automatically created in the drive.  
Handling USB Flash  
Drives  
If the format operation fails  
UDF  
A format operation may fail because the USB  
flash drive is write protected, or because it is not  
the type of drive specified for use with this  
camcorder.  
In this case, an error message appears. Following  
the instructions in the error message and  
exchange the drive for one that can be used with  
this camcorder.  
In UDF mode, you can connect a USB flash drive  
connected to the external device to record, save  
and load the following data.  
• Record proxy data (see page 85)  
• Load planning metadata (see page 87)  
• Save and load setting data (see page 160)  
The following Sony USB flash drives are  
recommended for use with this camcorder.  
To format by menu operation  
When no formatting message is displayed, you  
can execute formatting by menu operation.  
Pocket Bit L Series  
• USM16GL  
• USM8GL  
• USM4GL  
1
2
3
Connect a USB flash drive to the  
external device connector.  
Pocket Bit Hi-Speed LX Series  
• USM32GLX  
• USM16GLX  
• USM8GLX  
• USM4GLX (available in Japan only)  
Select OPERATION >USB > Format  
USB Memory in the setup menu.  
Turn the MENU knob to select  
[Execute], and then press the knob.  
The confirmation message for formatting is  
displayed on the viewfinder screen.  
Notes  
• Use USB flash drives with capacity from 4 GB to 32  
GB.  
• USB flash drives other than the recommended flash  
drives listed above may not be recognized when  
connected to the USB connector.  
4
Turn the MENU knob to select  
“Execute” and press the knob.  
A progress indication appears (%), and  
execution of the format starts.  
Formatting (Initializing) USB  
Flash Drives  
When formatting is completed, the message  
“Format USB Memory Done” is displayed.  
The \MSSONY\PRO\XDCAM\MEMDISC  
folder and the \General\Sony\Planning folder  
are automatically created in the drive.  
USB flash drives must be formatted with the  
FAT32 file system.  
Note  
Notes  
Before using a drive, format it on this camcorder or a PC.  
If a drive formatted on a PC cannot be used, format it on  
the camcorder.  
• All data is erased when you format a USB flash drive,  
including setup files and all of the recorded video data.  
• Use the format function of this camcorder to format  
USB flash drives for use on this camcorder. The  
formats of drives formatted on other devices are not  
recognized as valid formats, making it necessary to  
format them again on this camcorder.  
1
Connect a USB flash drive to the  
external device connector.  
When the drive is unformatted or has been  
formatted to other specifications, a message  
to confirm if formatting is to be executed  
appears on the viewfinder screen.  
Handling USB Flash Drives  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Restoring USB Flash Drives  
Basic Operations  
When you load a USB flash drive that can be  
mounted normally because the file system is  
destroyed, a message appears on the viewfinder  
screen to ask whether you want to restore it.  
Pressing the MENU knob after turning the  
MENU knob to select “Execute” starts execution  
of the format and a progress indication appears  
(%).  
This section explains the basic shooting and  
recording procedures.  
Before starting to shoot, inspect the camera  
system to verify that it is operating properly.  
When formatting is completed, the message  
“Format USB Memory Done” is displayed.  
1
Attach a fully charged battery pack (see  
2
3
Select the recording mode (see page 53).  
Load one or two SxS memory cards (see  
If you load two cards, the camcorder  
switches automatically to the second card  
when the first card becomes full.  
4
5
Set the camcorder’s POWER switch  
Make the following settings.  
Marker display: On (see page 118)  
Iris: Auto (see page 59)  
Zoom: Auto  
Camera output: Select the picture currently  
being shot (camera picture), and turn the  
DCC function on (see page 19).  
Timecode advance mode: F-RUN (Free  
Run) or R-RUN (Rec Run) (see page 62)  
Audio input channel selection: Auto (see  
6
7
Push the AUTO W/B BAL switch to the  
BLACK side to adjust the black balance  
Select a filter according to the lighting  
conditions, and adjust the white balance  
8
9
Point the camcorder at the subject, and  
adjust the focus and zoom.  
If you are using the electronic shutter,  
select an appropriate shutter mode and  
speed (see page 57).  
Basic Operations  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
You can use MAINTENANCE >Camera  
Config >Rec Review in the setup menu (see  
page 142) to change the playback time.  
When the Rec Review function is assigned to  
the RET button on the lens, you can also  
conduct a review by using the RET button.  
10 Do one of the following to start  
recording.  
- Press the REC START button (see  
- Press the VTR button on the lens.  
- Turn on the assignable switch to which the  
Rec function has been assigned (see  
12 Repeat steps 10 and 11 to continue  
recording.  
With each repetition, another clip is created  
on the memory card.  
During recording, the TALLY indicators, the  
tally indicator on the front panel of the  
viewfinder, and the REC indication on the  
viewfinder screen light. Adjust the zoom and  
focus as required.  
Clip 1  
Clip 2  
Clip 3  
Notes  
• Never remove the battery pack while the  
camcorder is recording (while the ACCESS lamp  
on the right-side panel is lit in blue and the  
ACCESS lamp in the card slot section is lit in  
orange). Doing so risks the loss of several  
seconds of data before the recording was  
interrupted, because internal processing will not  
end normally.  
Notes  
• You cannot resume recording for about one second  
after stopping recording.  
• The maximum number of clips that can be recorded on  
one memory card is 600. Even if the memory card has  
enough free capacity to record more clips, when 600  
clips have been recorded, no further recording is  
possible.  
• The playback control buttons (EJECT, F REV, F  
FWD, NEXT, PREV, PLAY/PAUSE, STOP) do  
not function during recording.  
Clip file sizes  
Clip file sizes vary according to file formats.  
11 To stop recording, perform one of the  
operations listed in step 10.  
File  
File size  
Clip size  
format  
The TALLY indicators, the tally indicator on  
the front panel of the viewfinder, and the  
REC indication on the viewfinder screen go  
out, and camcorder enters recording standby  
(STBY) mode.  
A clip is created from the video and audio  
data and the metadata recorded between steps  
10 and 11.  
MP4  
Less than 4 GB  
Less than 2 GB  
Less than half an  
hour  
AVI  
Less than 9 minutes  
and 30 seconds  
MXF  
Less than 43 GB Less than 6 hours  
If you continue recording for an extended period,  
recorded materials may be segmented into  
multiple files, depending on the file size (the  
maximum number of partitions is 99).  
The camcorder regards continuous recording as  
one clip even if it has been segmented into  
multiple files.  
Note  
When the recording mode is UDF, if you stop  
recording within two seconds of starting, recording  
continues and this results in a two-second clip.  
To check the recording (recording review)  
With the camcorder in recording standby  
(STBY) mode, turn on the assignable switch  
to which the Rec Review function or the  
Freeze Mix function has been assigned (see  
Clip names  
Eight-character clips names (consisting of a four-  
character prefix and a four-digit number) are  
generated automatically for clips recorded by this  
camcorder.  
Example: ABCD0001  
The camcorder plays the entire last clip, or  
the last few seconds of that clip (three  
seconds or 10 seconds), and then returns to  
standby mode.  
You can also use OPERATION >Clip >Title  
Prefix (see page 126) in the setup menu to set the  
clip name prefix to a user-specified string of  
characters (four to 46 characters in length). (A  
Basic Operations  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
user-specified prefix cannot be changed after  
recording.)  
The four-digit number at the end of clip names is  
generated automatically, counting up in order as  
clips are recorded.  
To display the camera picture during play  
(Live & Play function)  
Live & Play is a function that allows you to  
display the camera picture (live video) on the  
viewfinder screen during play.  
This allows you to frame the next scene or adjust  
the focus and exposure while checking the  
camera picture (live video) on the viewfinder  
screen. To frame the next scene, you can use this  
function together with the Freeze Mix function  
Playing Recorded Clips  
When the camcorder is in standby (STBY) mode,  
you can play all or part of the most recently  
recorded clip (see page 75).  
The Live & Play function is enabled when the  
camcorder is set up as follows.  
1
2
Insert the SxS memory card to play (see  
HD/SD Number of system System frequency  
lines  
Press the PREV button (see page 21) or  
the F REV button (see page 21) to cue  
up the clip to play.  
HD  
1080  
1920/59.94i  
1920/50i  
1440/59.94i  
1440/50i  
1280/59.94P  
1280/50P  
59.94i  
3
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
The PLAY/PAUSE indicator lights, and the  
playback picture appears in the viewfinder.  
720  
To pause the playback  
SD  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
The PLAY/PAUSE indicator flashes during  
pause.  
50i  
59.94i  
50i  
Press the button again to return to playback mode.  
To use the Live & Play function, set  
OPERATION >Output >Live&Play in the setup  
menu to [On].  
To play at high speed  
Press the F FWD button (see page 21) or the  
F REV button (see page 21).  
To return to normal playback, press the PLAY/  
PAUSE button.  
Notes  
• The Live & Play function cannot be turned on and off  
during playback or during thumbnail display.  
• The Live & Play function cannot be used in Frame  
Rec, Interval Rec, and Slow & Quick Motion modes,  
and when the Slow Shutter function is enabled.  
• To use the Live & Play function together with the  
Freeze Mix function, start by operating while viewing  
the LCD monitor (with the DISP SEL/EXPAND  
button pressed to set the display mode other than  
STATUS). When the operation finishes and the Freeze  
Mix function is activated, the same picture appears on  
the viewfinder screen.  
• The play picture cannot be switched to the camera  
picture when playing a clip that was recorded with a  
number of system lines or a system frequency that  
differs from the current settings of this camcorder.  
• The output from the HD/SD SDI OUT connector and  
the VIDEO OUT connector may freeze momentarily  
when the output is switched between the play picture  
and the camera picture.  
To switch between memory cards  
When two memory cards are loaded, press the  
SLOT SELECT button (see page 25) to select the  
active slot.  
It is not possible to switch between memory cards  
during playback.  
To end playback  
Press the STOP button: Playback stops, and the  
camcorder enters E-E mode.  
Press the THUMBNAIL button: Playback  
stops, and a thumbnail screen (see page 91)  
appears in the viewfinder.  
Playback also stops and the timecode screen  
appears in the viewfinder when you start  
recording during playback, and when you eject an  
SxS memory card.  
Basic Operations  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Deleting Recorded Clips  
Advanced Operations  
You can use the assignable switches to delete the  
last recorded clips (Last Clip DEL function).  
You can also use the THUMBNAIL menu to delete all  
recorded clips (All Clips DEL function) or to delete  
selected clips. For details, see “Deleting Clips”  
Recording Shot Marks  
1
Turn on the assignable switch to which  
the Last Clip DEL function has been  
assigned (see page 156).  
UDF / FAT-HD  
On this camcorder, two types of shot marks are  
available in HD mode. You can record them at  
user-specified positions to make it easier for  
editors to cue up those positions.  
The maximum numbers of shot marks per clip  
vary according to file formats.  
A confirmation message appears.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to select  
[Execute], and then press the knob.  
File format  
MP4  
Maximum number  
127  
999  
MXF  
Note  
Shot marks cannot be recorded in SD mode.  
You can also use the THUMBNAIL menu to add and  
delete shot marks in clips. For details, see “Adding  
To record shot marks  
Do one of the following.  
• Turn on an assignable switch to which Shot  
Mark 1 or Shot Mark 2 has been assigned (see  
• If Lens RET has been assigned to the RET  
button on the lens, operate as follows.  
To record shot mark 1: Press the RET button  
once.  
To record shot mark 2: Press the RET button  
twice in quick succession.  
When a shot mark is recorded, a “Shot Mark 1” or  
“Shot Mark 2” indication appears in the  
viewfinder for about three seconds near the  
timecode indication.  
Advanced Operations  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
thumbnails. It is not possible to record picture data  
from the time you were conducting playback or a  
recording review.  
Setting OK Marks  
UDF / FAT-HD  
To select picture cache mode and set the picture  
cache time  
To make it easier for editors to select good clips,  
you can set OK marks in clips recorded in HD  
mode.  
Notes  
• Picture cache recording is not possible in Frame Rec,  
Interval Rec, Slow & Quick Motion, and Clip  
Continuous Rec mode. The camcorder exits Frame  
Rec, Interval Rec, Slow & Quick Motion or Clip  
Continuous Rec mode, whenever you select picture  
cache mode. The camcorder exits picture cache mode  
automatically whenever you select Frame Rec,  
Interval Rec, Slow & Quick Motion, or Clip  
Continuous Rec mode.  
• The data stored in picture cache memory is cleared  
when you change the system settings, for example by  
selecting a different video format. Picture data from  
before the change is not recorded even if you start  
recording immediately after the change. The  
camcorder exits picture cache mode automatically.  
• It is not possible to set the picture cache time during  
recording.  
Note  
OK marks cannot be set or deleted during recording or  
playback.  
To add/delete OK marks  
You can use the THUMBNAIL menu to add and  
delete OK marks in previously recorded clips. For  
Starting to Record from Pre-  
stored Video (Picture Cache  
Function)  
1
In the setup menu, select OPERATION  
>Rec Function >Picture Cache Rec.  
The camcorder is equipped with enough internal  
memory to pre-store up to 15 seconds of video  
and audio data in a picture cache. This allows you  
to begin recording a specified number of seconds  
in advance of the time when you press a recording  
start button.  
For menu operations, see “Basic Setup Menu  
2
3
Turn the MENU knob to select [On],  
and then press the knob.  
Selecting picture cache mode and setting  
the picture cache time  
Before recording in picture cache mode, you must  
select picture cache mode and set the picture  
cache time (the number of seconds of video and  
audio data stored to memory) in the  
Select [P. Cache Rec Time], turn the  
MENU knob to select the desired  
picture cache time, and then press the  
knob.  
You can select from 0-2sec, 2-4sec, 4-6sec,  
6-8sec, 8-10sec, 10-12sec, 12-14sec, and  
13-15sec.  
OPERATION menu.  
The picture cache time determines how far in  
advance you can start recording, counting back in  
seconds from the operation that starts recording.  
Note that it may not be possible to start this far in  
advance in the special cases explained in the  
following notes.  
Once made, picture cache mode settings remain  
in effect until changed.  
Instead of carrying out steps 1 and 2, you can also  
select picture cache mode by using an assignable  
switch to which the Picture Cache function has  
been assigned (see page 155).  
Notes  
Camcorder data handling while recording in  
picture cache mode  
Recording procedures in picture cache mode are  
basically the same as normal recording  
procedures. However, note the following  
differences with respect to how the camcorder  
handles video, time, and output data.  
• Storage of picture data to memory begins when you  
select picture cache mode. Therefore, if you start  
recording immediately after selecting picture cache  
mode, the picture data from before the selection is not  
recorded.  
• No data is recorded to picture cache memory during  
playback or recording review and display of  
Advanced Operations  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
• If you start recording while the media is being  
accessed, the start point of the video that is  
actually recorded may be later than the  
currently specified picture cache time. Because  
the delay increases as the number of recorded  
clips increases, you should avoid rapid start-  
and-stop recording operations in picture cache  
mode.  
• Regardless of the setting of the F-RUN/SET/  
R-RUN switch, the advance mode of the  
internal timecode generator is always F-RUN.  
• In picture cache mode, you cannot set time data  
by setting the F-RUN/SET/R-RUN switch to  
SET.  
Recording Time-lapse Video  
(Interval Rec Function)  
The camcorder’s Interval Rec function allows  
you to capture time-lapse video to the  
camcorder’s internal memory. This function is an  
effective way to shoot slow-moving subjects.  
When you start recording, the camcorder  
automatically records a specified number of  
frames at a specified interval time.  
Interval time  
To set time data, exit picture cache mode.  
• If the remaining free capacity of the media in  
the currently selected slot is less than the picture  
cache time, and the media in the other slot has  
enough remaining capacity, then data is  
recorded to the media in the other slot.  
However, no data is recorded when there is no  
media in the other slot, and when the media in  
the other slot does not have enough remaining  
capacity. (A message appears in the viewfinder  
to inform you that there is not enough remaining  
capacity.)  
Number of frames in one take  
A pre-lighting function is available when Interval  
Rec is enabled. This function automatically turns  
on a video light before recording starts, which  
allows you to record pictures under stable light  
and color temperature conditions.  
• Shot marks are not recorded if they are set  
before the recording start operation.  
• When you select a video format that supports  
i.LINK HDV output and play a clip that was  
recorded in picture cache mode, two or more  
frames with the same picture and timecode may  
follow on each other.  
Interval Rec settings and shooting  
• i.LINK output is possible during picture cache  
recording. However, the picture cache time is  
limited.  
Notes  
• The Interval Rec function cannot be used at the same  
time as the picture cache, Frame Rec, Slow & Quick  
Motion, or Clip Continuous Rec function. When you  
select Interval Rec mode, the picture cache, Frame  
Rec, Slow & Quick Motion, and Clip Continuous Rec  
functions are disabled. When you select picture cache,  
Frame Rec, Slow & Quick Motion, or Clip Continuous  
Rec mode, the Interval Rec function is disabled.  
• The data stored in picture cache memory is cleared  
when you change the system settings, for example by  
selecting a different video format. Picture data from  
before the change is not recorded even if you start  
recording immediately after the change. The  
camcorder exits picture cache mode automatically.  
• Interval Rec settings cannot be changed during  
recording.  
If power is lost during recording  
• If you set the camcorder’s POWER switch to  
OFF, the camcorder is powered off  
automatically after a few seconds, during which  
the media is accessed to record the video and  
audio data stored in the camcorder’s memory up  
to that point.  
• If power is lost because the battery was  
removed, the DC cable was disconnected, or the  
power was turned off on the AC adaptor side,  
then the video and audio data stored in memory  
is lost. The data stored in memory is not  
recorded. Be careful to avoid this when  
exchanging the battery.  
• Interval Rec is disabled when the following formats  
are selected.  
- In FAT mode, SP 1440/59.94i or SP 1440/50i, when  
the output setting is HD and OPERATION >Input/  
Advanced Operations  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Output >i.LINK I/O in the setup menu is set to  
[Enable]  
automatically. However, the video light remains lit  
when the time that it is off is five seconds or less.  
• If you set the LIGHT switch to [MANUAL] and turn  
the video light’s switch on, the video light is always lit.  
(It does not go on and off automatically.)  
- In FAT mode, SP 1440/23.98P (pull-down  
recording)  
- In UDF mode, HD420 HQ 1280×720/23.98P (pull-  
down recording)  
- Other than HQ 1920/23.98P or HQ 1280/23.98P,  
when the output setting is SD and OPERATION  
>Input/Output >i.LINK I/O in the setup menu is set  
to [Enable]  
The camcorder exits Interval Rec mode when it is  
powered off, but the number of frames, interval  
time, and pre-lighting settings are maintained.  
You do not need to set them again the next time  
you shoot in Interval Rec mode.  
To make Interval Rec settings  
To shoot in Interval Rec mode  
1
2
Select OPERATION >Rec Function  
>Interval Rec in the setup menu.  
Make the settings and preparations described in  
camcorder so that it does not move, and begin  
shooting.  
For menu operations, see “Basic Setup Menu  
Turn the MENU knob to select [On],  
and then press the knob.  
The camcorder enters Interval Rec mode, the  
“Interval” indication on the viewfinder  
screen flashes.  
When recording starts, the “Interval” indication  
in the viewfinder changes from flashing to lit, and  
“INT REC” and “INT STBY” appear  
alternatively at the position of the REC  
indication. The TALLY indicators and the tally  
indicator on the front panel of the viewfinder light  
as they do during normal recording. (The green  
tally indicator in the viewfinder flashes at high  
frequencies.)  
(The green tally indicator in the HDVF series  
viewfinder also flashes.)  
3
Select [Number of Frames], turn the  
MENU knob to select the number of  
frames to record in one take, and then  
press the knob.  
You can select from 1, 3, 6, 9 (or from 2, 6,  
12 when the video format setting is 720/  
59.94P or 720/50P).  
If you are using the pre-lighting function, the  
video light comes on before recording starts.  
To stop shooting  
Stop the recording.  
When shooting ends, the video data stored in  
memory up to that point is written to the media.  
4
5
Select [Interval Time], turn the MENU  
knob to select the desired interval, and  
then press the knob.  
You can select 1 to 10/15/20/30/40/50 sec,  
1 to 10/15/20/30/40/50 min, 1 to 4/6/12/24  
hour.  
To exit Interval Rec mode  
Do one of the following.  
• Set the POWER switch to OFF.  
• With the camcorder in recording standby mode,  
set OPERATION >Rec Function >Interval Rec  
in the setup menu to “Off”.  
As required, select [Pre-Lighting], turn  
the MENU knob to select the length of  
lighting time before recording starts,  
and then press the knob.  
You can select 1 to 10/15/20/30/40/50 sec,  
1 to 10/15/20/30/40/50 min, 1 to 4/6/12/24  
hour.  
Limitations during recording  
• The i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector cannot be  
used.  
• Regardless of the setting of the F-RUN/SET/  
R-RUN switch, the advance mode of the  
internal timecode generator is always F-RUN.  
• Audio cannot be recorded.  
Notes  
• Recording review is not possible.  
• If you press the SLOT SELECT button, the  
camcorder completes recording of the specified  
number of frames, creates a clip, and switches  
• If you want to turn the video light on before the start of  
recording, set the camcorder’s LIGHT switch to  
[AUTO]. The video light’s switch must also be turned  
on. When this is done, the video light turns on and off  
Advanced Operations  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Output >i.LINK I/O in the setup menu is set to  
Enable  
to the other media. (when the recording mode is  
UDF)  
• Genlock is not possible.  
- In FAT mode, SP 1440/23.98P (pull-down  
recording)  
- In UDF mode, HD420 HQ 1280×720/23.98P (pull-  
down recording)  
If power is lost during recording  
• If you set the camcorder’s POWER switch to  
OFF, the camcorder is powered off  
- Other than HQ 1920/23.98P or HQ 1280/23.98P,  
when the output setting is SD and OPERATION  
>Input/Output >i.LINK I/O in the setup menu is set  
to Enable  
automatically after a few seconds, during which  
the media is accessed to record the video and  
audio data stored in the camcorder’s memory up  
to that point.  
To make Frame Rec settings  
• If power is lost because the battery was  
removed, the DC power cord was disconnected,  
or the power was turned off on the AC adaptor  
side, then the video and audio data shot up to  
that point may be lost (maximum 10 seconds).  
Be careful to avoid this when exchanging the  
battery.  
1
2
Select OPERATION >Rec Function  
>Frame Rec in the setup menu.  
For menu operations, see “Basic Setup Menu  
Turn the MENU knob to select [On],  
and then press the knob.  
The camcorder enters Frame Rec mode, the  
“Frame Rec” indication on the viewfinder  
screen flashes.  
(The green tally indicator in the HDVF series  
viewfinder also flashes.)  
Shooting Stop Motion Animations  
(Frame Rec Function)  
The Frame Rec function is useful for shooting  
stop motion animations, such as animations with  
puppets or clay figures.  
Each time that you press the recording start  
button, the camcorder shoots a specified number  
of frames and then stops.  
3
Select [Number of Frames], turn the  
MENU knob to select the number of  
frames to record in one take, and then  
press the knob.  
You can select from 1, 3, 6, 9 (or from 2, 6,  
12 when the video format setting is 720/  
59.94P or 720/50P).  
Frame Rec settings and shooting  
Notes  
• The Frame Rec function cannot be used at the same  
time as the picture cache, Interval Rec, Slow & Quick  
Motion, or Clip Continuous Rec function. When you  
select Frame Rec mode, the picture cache, Interval  
Rec, Slow & Quick Motion, and Clip Continuous Rec  
functions are disabled. When you select picture cache,  
Interval Rec, Slow & Quick Motion, or Clip  
Continuous Rec mode, the Frame Rec function is  
disabled.  
• The data stored in memory is cleared when you change  
the system settings, for example by selecting a  
different video format. Picture data from before the  
change is not recorded even if you start recording  
immediately after the change. The camcorder exits  
Frame Rec mode automatically.  
The camcorder exits Frame Rec mode when it is  
powered off, but the setting for the number of  
frames setting is maintained. You do not need to  
set it again the next time you shoot in Frame Rec  
mode.  
To shoot in Frame Rec mode  
Make the settings and preparations described in  
camcorder so that it does not move, and begin  
shooting.  
When recording starts, the “Frame Rec”  
indication in the viewfinder changes from  
flashing to lit, and “FRM REC” and “FRM  
STBY” appear alternatively at the position of the  
REC indication. The TALLY indicators and the  
tally indicator on the front panel of the viewfinder  
light as they do during normal recording.  
• Frame Rec settings cannot be changed during  
recording.  
• Frame Rec is disabled when the following formats are  
selected.  
- In FAT mode, SP 1440/59.94i or SP 1440/50i, when  
the output setting is HD and OPERATION >Input/  
Advanced Operations  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To stop shooting  
Stop the recording.  
OPERATION >Format menu Video format  
settings  
Country File  
HD System  
When shooting ends, the video data stored in  
memory up to that point is written to the media.  
System Line  
NTSC  
Area or  
NTSC(J)  
Area  
UDF  
FAT  
1080  
720  
HD422 50/29.97P  
HD422 50/23.98P  
HD422 50/59.94P  
HD422 50/29.97P  
HD422 50/23.98P  
HQ 1920/29.97P  
HQ 1920/23.98P  
HQ 1280/59.94P  
HQ 1280/29.97P  
HQ 1280/23.98P  
HD422 50/25P  
HD422 50/25P  
HD422 50/50P  
HQ 1920/25P  
To exit Interval Rec mode  
Do one of the following.  
• Set the POWER switch to OFF  
• With the camcorder in recording standby mode,  
set OPERATION >Rec Function >Interval Rec  
in the setup menu to “Off”.  
1080  
720  
Limitations during recording  
• The i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector cannot be  
used.  
PAL  
Area  
UDF  
FAT  
1080  
720  
• Regardless of the setting of the F-RUN/SET/  
R-RUN switch, the advance mode of the  
internal timecode generator is always R-RUN.  
• Audio cannot be recorded.  
• Recording review is not possible.  
• If you press the SLOT SELECT button, the  
camcorder completes recording of the specified  
number of frames, creates a clip, and switches  
to the other media.  
1080  
720  
HQ 1280/50P  
HQ 1280/25P  
By shooting with a frame rate that differs from the  
playback frame rate, you can obtain slow and  
quick motion effects that are smoother than low-  
speed or high-speed playback of content recorded  
at the normal frame rate.  
• Genlock is not possible.  
If power is lost during recording  
• If you set the camcorder’s POWER switch to  
OFF, the camcorder is powered off  
automatically after a few seconds, during which  
the media is accessed to record the video and  
audio data stored in the camcorder’s memory up  
to that point.  
Example  
When the video format is HQ 1280/23.98P, you  
can obtain quick-motion effects by setting the  
frame rate to 1 to 23, and obtain slow-motion  
effects by setting the frame rate to 25 to 60.  
• If power is lost because the battery was  
removed, the DC power cord was disconnected,  
or the power was turned off on the AC adaptor  
side, then the video and audio data shot up to  
that point may be lost (maximum 10 seconds).  
Be careful to avoid this when exchanging the  
battery.  
Slow & Quick Motion settings and  
shooting  
Notes  
• The Slow & Quick Motion function cannot be used at  
the same time as the picture cache, Interval Rec, Frame  
Rec, or Clip Continuous Rec function. When you  
select Slow & Quick Motion mode, the picture cache,  
Interval Rec, Frame Rec, and Clip Continuous Rec  
functions are disabled. When you select picture cache,  
Frame Rec, Interval Rec, or Clip Continuous Rec  
mode, the Slow & Quick Motion function is disabled.  
• Slow & Quick Motion is disabled when the slow  
shutter function (viewfinder display “SLS”) function is  
enabled. The slow shutter function is disabled when  
the Slow & Quick Motion function is enabled.  
• Slow & Quick Motion is disabled when OPERATION  
>Input/Output >i.LINK I/O in the setup menu is set to  
[Enable]. When Slow & Quick Motion is enabled,  
i.LINK I/O is fixed as [Disable].  
Shooting with Slow & Quick  
Motion  
When the camcorder is in HD mode and the video  
format (see page 51) is set to one of the formats  
listed below, you can specify a recording frame  
rate that is different from the playback frame rate.  
Advanced Operations  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
• Slow & Quick Motion settings cannot be changed  
during recording.  
When recording starts, the “S&Q STBY”  
indication in the viewfinder changes to the  
zS&Q REC” indication. The TALLY  
indicators and the tally indicator on the front  
panel of the viewfinder light as they do during  
normal recording.  
To make Slow & Quick Motion settings  
1
2
Select OPERATION >Rec Function >  
Slow & Quick in the setup menu.  
For menu operations, see “Basic Setup Menu  
To stop shooting  
Stop the recording.  
Note  
Turn the MENU knob to select [On],  
and then press the knob.  
It takes longer than normal for recording to stop when  
Frame Rate is set to a low value (for a slow frame rate).  
The camcorder enters Slow & Quick Motion  
mode, and the “S&Q STBY” indication in  
the viewfinder lights.  
To exit Slow & Quick Motion mode  
With the camcorder in recording standby mode,  
set OPERATION >Rec Function > Slow & Quick  
in the setup menu to [Off].  
3
Select [Frame Rate], turn the MENU  
knob to select the recording frame rate,  
and then press the knob.  
Limitations during recording  
• The i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector cannot be  
used.  
The setting range for the frame rate is as  
follows.  
• Regardless of the setting of the F-RUN/SET/  
R-RUN switch, the advance mode of the  
internal timecode generator is always R-RUN.  
• Audio cannot be recorded when the recording  
and playback frame rates differ.  
• Recording review is not possible.  
• If you change the recording frame rate to a value  
faster than the current shutter speed, the shutter  
speed is changed to the slowest value for which  
shooting is possible.  
System Frame rate  
lines  
1080  
When OPERATION >Format  
>Country in the setup menu is set to  
[PAL Area] in UDF mode:  
1 to 25  
In FAT mode or when OPERATION  
>Format >Country in the setup menu  
is set to other than [PAL Area] in  
UDF mode:  
Example: If the frame rate is 32 and the shutter  
1 to 30  
1
speed is / , and you change the frame rate to  
40  
720  
When OPERATION >Format  
>Country in the setup menu is set to  
[PAL Area] in UDF mode:  
1 to 50  
1
55, then the shutter speed is changed to /  
.
60  
If is not possible to select a shutter speed that is  
slower than the recording frame rate.  
• Genlock is not possible.  
In FAT mode or when OPERATION  
>Format >Country in the setup menu  
is set to other than [PAL Area] in  
UDF mode:  
Recording with the Clip  
Continuous Rec Function  
1 to 60  
When you finish making these settings, the  
system frequency and the frame rate appear at the  
top of the viewfinder screen. You can change the  
frame rate while viewing the display in the  
viewfinder by turning the MENU knob.  
The Slow & Quick Motion mode setting and the  
frame rate are retained even after the camcorder is  
powered off.  
Normally, a clip is created as an independent file  
each time that you start and stop recording. But  
this function allows you to start and stop  
recording while continuously recording to the  
same clip, for as long as the function remains  
enabled. This is convenient when you do not want  
to generate a large number of short clips, and  
when you want to record without worrying about  
exceeding the clip limit. It is still easy to find  
recording start points, because a Rec Start essence  
mark is recorded at the recording start point each  
time you start recording.  
To shoot in Slow & Quick Motion mode  
Shoot as described in “Basic Operations”  
Advanced Operations  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
To stop shooting  
Stop the recording.  
Clip Continuous Rec settings and  
shooting  
Note  
Notes  
Stop the recording after the recording continues for two  
or more seconds.  
• The Clip Continuous Rec function cannot be used at  
the same time as the Picture Cache, Interval Rec,  
Frame Rec, or Slow & Quick Motion function. When  
you select Clip Continuous Rec mode, the Picture  
Cache, Interval Rec, Frame Rec, and Slow & Quick  
Motion functions are disabled. When you select  
picture cache, Frame Rec, Interval Rec, or Slow &  
Quick Motion mode, the Clip Continuous Rec function  
is disabled.  
To exit Clip Continuous Rec mode  
With the camcorder in recording standby mode,  
set OPERATION >Rec Function >Clip  
Continuous Rec in the setup menu to [Off].  
Limitations during recording  
A single continuous clip cannot be created if you  
perform one of the following operations while the  
camcorder is in recording or recording standby  
mode (A new clip will be created when you next  
start recording.)  
• The Clip Continuous Rec function is disabled when the  
recording mode is FAT.  
To make Clip Continuous Rec settings  
• Operate on a clip (lock, delete, or rename a clip)  
• Change the recording format  
• Turn off the POWER switch  
1
Select OPERATION >Rec Function  
>Clip Continuous Rec in the setup  
menu.  
• Playback  
• Switched to thumbnail mode  
for more information about menu operations.  
Framing Shots with the Freeze  
Mix Function  
2
Turn the MENU knob to select [On],  
and then press the knob.  
“CONT” appears in the viewfinder, and the  
function is enabled.  
The freeze mix function allows you to  
temporarily overlap a still image (freeze picture)  
from a clip shot in HD mode onto the current  
camera picture. This makes it easier to frame the  
shot.  
You can assign the Clip Continuous Rec on/off  
function to one of the ASSIGN 1/2/3 switches,  
ASSIGNABLE 4/5 switches, and the COLOR  
TEMP button.  
Note  
The freeze mix function is not available in the following  
cases.  
To shoot in Clip Continuous Rec mode  
Shoot as described in “Basic Operations”  
When recording starts, the “Cont” indication in  
the viewfinder changes to “zREC” indication.  
The TALLY indicators and the tally indicator on  
the front panel of the viewfinder light as they do  
during normal recording.  
• When the recording format is SP 1080/23.98P (FAT  
mode) or HQ 1280/23.98P (UDF mode)  
• When the video formats of the recorded picture and the  
camera picture differ  
• When you are shooting in Slow & Quick Motion mode  
or slow shutter mode  
• When there is i.LINK input  
To display a freeze mix picture  
Note  
During recording or in recording standby mode (when  
“Cont” indication is lit), if you remove the media, the  
battery, or the power source, the media needs to be  
restored. It is not possible to restore media on a device  
other than this camcorder.  
Exit Clip Continuous Rec mode (see page 84) and then  
remove the media.  
When “Cont” indication is flashing (at 1 flash/s), you can  
remove the media.  
1
Play a clip or conduct a recording  
review of a clip with the same format as  
the camera picture.  
2
Display the picture that you want to use  
as the frame, and then turn on the  
assignable switch to which the Freeze  
Mix function has been assigned.  
Advanced Operations  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
The recording review picture is frozen and  
overlaps the camera picture.  
Recording Proxy Data  
Note  
The following functions are disabled at the freeze mix  
times.  
• Menu operations  
• During Focus Mag display  
• Marker display  
• Zebra display  
UDF  
Proxy data is made up of low-resolution video  
data (MPEG-4) and audio data (A-Low) (video:  
1.5 Mbps; audio: 64 Kbps per channel). This  
lightweight proxy data can be used in the same  
way as the original data, but it can be transferred  
more quickly, for more efficient viewing and  
editing.  
In UDF mode, proxy data is generated and  
recorded automatically when you record video  
and audio with a USB flash drive connected to the  
external device connector. By loading the proxy  
data from the USB flash drive into a computer,  
you can quickly check the recorded content or  
perform rapid offline editing.  
• Peaking display  
• Skin tone details display  
To cancel the freeze mix display  
Do one of the following.  
• Press an assignable switch again to which the  
Freeze Mix function has been assigned.  
The freeze mix display is canceled and the  
display returns to the normal camera picture.  
• Start recording (see page 75).  
Normal recording starts.  
Note  
Do not power this unit off or do not remove the USB  
flash drive while the USB flash drive is being accessed.  
Doing so may cause the loss of all data recorded on the  
USB flash drive.  
Recording Proxy Data While  
Recording Clips  
You can record proxy data to a USB flash drive  
while recording clips to an SxS memory card.  
1
2
Set MAINTENANCE >USB >Memory  
Rec in the setup menu to [Enable].  
Connect a USB flash drive formatted  
with the FAT32 file system to the  
external device connector (see page 73).  
3
Start recording.  
At the same time that the original data is  
recorded to an SxS memory card, proxy data  
is saved to the automatically generated  
\MSSONY\PRO\XDCAM\MEMDISC\  
<Proav-ID> folder (Proav-ID is an ID  
specified in the DISCMETA.XML file on the  
SxS memory card).  
Proxy data: Saved in <Proav-ID>\Sub\  
Recording Proxy Data  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Metadata: Saved in <Proav-ID>\Clip\  
2
Connect a USB flash drive formatted  
with the FAT32 file system to the  
external device connector (see page 73).  
To stop recording of proxy data  
To stop recording of proxy data only, without  
stopping recording of original data, set  
MAINTENANCE >USB >Memory Rec in the  
setup menu to [Disable].  
3
4
5
Insert an SxS memory card with  
recorded clips.  
If recording fails  
Cue up the clip for which you want to  
record proxy data.  
The message “USB Memory Error” appears. If  
recording fails because the USB flash drive is  
full, the message “USB Memory Full” appears.  
Proxy data is saved in this unit’s internal memory.  
If recording fails because of a USB flash drive  
defect or for some other reason, you can exchange  
the USB flash drive or reconnect it, and rerecord  
the proxy data saved in internal memory.  
Select MAINTENANCE >USB > Copy  
Current Clip in the setup menu, and  
press the MENU knob.  
6
Turn the MENU knob to select  
[Execute], and then press the knob.  
Recording of the proxy data starts.  
The message “Copy Current Clip Done”  
appears when recording finishes.  
Recording Proxy Data for Existing  
Clips  
Deleting All Proxy Data from a  
USB Flash Drive  
You can record proxy data for clips on SxS  
memory cards to USB flash drives.  
You can delete all proxy data in the  
\MSSONY\PRO\XDCAM\MEMDISC folder by  
deleting the folder.  
To record proxy data for all clips  
1
2
Set MAINTENANCE >USB >Memory  
Rec in the setup menu to [Enable].  
1
2
Set MAINTENANCE >USB >Memory  
Rec in the setup menu to [Enable].  
Connect a USB flash drive formatted  
with the FAT32 file system to the  
Connect a USB flash drive containing  
proxy data to the external device  
connector.  
external device connector (see page 73).  
3
4
Insert an SxS memory card with  
recorded clips.  
3
4
Select MAINTENANCE >USB > Del  
All Memory Clips in the setup menu,  
and press the MENU knob.  
Select MAINTENANCE >USB > Copy  
All Clips in the setup menu, and press  
the MENU knob.  
Turn the MENU knob to select  
[Execute], and then press the knob.  
Deletion of the folder starts.  
5
Turn the MENU knob to select  
[Execute], and then press the knob.  
Recording of the proxy data starts.  
The message “Copy All Clips Done” appears  
when recording finishes.  
The message “Delete All Clips Done”  
appears when the deletion finishes.  
To cue up a clip and record its proxy data  
1
Set MAINTENANCE >USB >Memory  
Rec in the setup menu to [Enable].  
Recording Proxy Data  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
86  
   
Loading a Planning Metadata File  
into Camcorder’s Internal Memory  
Planning Metadata  
Operations  
To record planning metadata together with  
recording clips, you need to load a planning  
metadata file into the camcorder’s memory before  
starting to shoot.  
Planning metadata is information about shooting  
and recording plans, recorded in an XML file.  
There are two ways to load files.  
• Load a file that has been written to the following  
directories on an SxS memory card or a USB  
flash drive.  
Recording Media  
mode  
Directory to which  
files are written  
FAT  
SxS memory BPAV/General/Sony/  
card  
Planning  
SDHC  
PRIVATE/SONY/  
BPAV/General/Sony/  
Planning  
UDF  
SxS memory General/Sony/Planning  
card  
Example of a planning metadata file  
USB flash  
drive  
You can shoot using clip names and shot mark  
names defined in advance in a planning metadata  
• When a Wi-Fi connection is made between the  
camcorder and a computer, operate the Web  
menu built in the camcorder from the computer  
to transfer a file.  
file.  
This unit can display clip names and shot mark  
names defined in the following languages.  
• English  
• Chinese  
• German  
• French  
• Italian  
• Spanish  
• Dutch  
For details on how to use the Web menu to load  
a planning metadata file, refer to the  
Supplement supplied in the CD-ROM (labeled  
“Manuals for Solid-State Memory  
Camcorder”).  
1)  
1)  
• Portuguese  
• Swedish  
• Norwegian  
• Danish  
To load a planning metadata file by menu  
operation  
Do the following procedures with OPERAION  
>Planning Metadata in the setup menu.  
1)  
• Finnish  
1) Some characters are displayed as different but similar  
characters.  
To load a file in an SxS memory card  
1
Insert an SxS memory card into the  
memory card slot A or B, and set Load/  
Slot(A) or Load/Slot(B) to [Execute].  
A file list appears.  
Note  
If you define clip name and shot mark names in  
languages other than the above, they may not be  
displayed on the viewfinder screen or the LCD monitor  
screen (with the display mode set to STATUS).  
In the LCD monitor (with the display mode set to  
STATUS), only alphanumeric characters and symbols  
can be displayed.  
Note  
The file list displays up to 64 files.  
Even if the total number of planning metadata files  
is 64 or less, all of the planning metadata files may  
not appear if the directory where they are located on  
the SxS memory card (General/Sony/Planning)  
contains 512 or more files.  
Planning Metadata Operations  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2
Turn the MENU knob to select a file to  
load and press the knob.  
Item  
Information  
File name  
File Name  
Assign ID  
Created  
Modified  
To load a file in a USB flash drive (in UDF mode)  
Assign ID  
Date and time of creation  
Date and time of most recent  
modification  
1
Connect a USB flash drive formatted  
with the FAT32 file system to the  
external device connector (see page 73).  
A file list appears.  
Modified by  
Title  
Name of person who  
modified the file  
Title1 specified in file (ASCII  
format clip name)  
Title2 specified in file (UTF-8  
format clip name)  
Number of clips in material  
group a)  
Note  
The file list displays up to 64 files.  
Title2  
Even if the total number of planning metadata files  
is 64 or less, all of the planning metadata files may  
not appear if the directory where they are located on  
the USB flash driver (General/Sony/Planning)  
contains 512 or more files.  
Material Gp  
Shot Mark0 to Names defined in file for Shot  
Shot Mark9 Mark 0 to Shot Mark 9  
2
Turn the MENU knob to select a file to  
load and press the knob.  
a) Material group: A group of clips recorded with  
the same planning metadata.  
To display detailed information in  
planning metadata  
After loading planning metadata into this unit,  
you can check the detailed information that it  
contains, such as file names, date and time of  
creation, and titles.  
You can turn the MENU knob to scroll the  
list.  
After turning the MENU knob to select an  
item, you can press the SET button to display  
the selected item only.  
To clear the planning metadata loaded  
1
Under OPERATION >Plan.Metadata  
>Properties in the setup menu, select  
[Execute].  
1
Under OPERATION >Plan.Metadata  
>Clear in the setup menu, select  
[Execute].  
2
Turn the MENU knob to select  
[Execute], and then press the knob.  
The PLANNING METADATA  
PROPERTIES list appears.  
The list contains the following information.  
2
Turn the MENU knob to select  
[Execute], and then press the knob.  
Deletion of the file starts.  
The message “Clear Planning Metadata File  
OK” appears when the deletion finishes.  
Defining Clip Names in Planning  
Metadata  
The following two types of clip name strings can  
be written in a planning metadata file.  
• The ASCII format name that appears in the  
viewfinder  
• The UTF-8 format name that is actually  
registered as the clip name  
You can select which type of clip name is  
displayed with OPERAION >Planning Metadata  
>Clip Name Disp in the setup menu.  
Planning Metadata Operations  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
88  
   
format name string can be used, the standard format  
clip name is used.  
When a clip name is set with planning metadata,  
the name is displayed under the depth of field  
indication on the viewfinder screen.  
You can use the Sony Planning Metadata Add-in  
application software supplied with the CBK-WA01  
Wi-Fi Adapter to define clip names. For details, refer  
to the Operating Instructions supplied with the CBK-  
WA01.  
Note  
When you define both of ASCII format name and UTF-  
8 format name with planning metadata, the UTF-8  
format string is used as the clip name string. If you define  
either of ASCII format name and UTF-8 format name  
with planning metadata, the defined format name is  
displayed though it is not selected by menu setting.  
To set clip names  
1
Load a planning metadata file that  
contains clip names into this  
camcorder.  
Clip name string example  
Use a text editor to modify the two fields in the  
<Title> tag that contain the clip name strings.  
The shaded fields in the example are clip name  
strings. “Typhoon” is described in ASCII format  
(up to 44 characters). “Typhoon_Strikes_Tokyo”  
is described in UTF-8 format (up to 44 bytes).  
“sp” indicates a space and 3 indicates a carriage  
return.  
2
Set OPERATION >Clip >Auto Naming  
in the setup menu to [Plan].  
Each time that you record a clip, the unit  
automatically generates a name consisting of  
the clip name defined in the planning  
metadata file, with the addition of an  
underbar (_) and a five-digit serial number  
(00001 to 99999).  
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="  
sp  
sp  
Examples:  
UTF-8"?>3  
Typhoon_Strikes_Tokyo_00001,  
Typhoon_Strikes_Tokyo_00002, ...  
<PlanningMetadata xmlns="http://  
sp  
xmlns.sony.net/pro/metadata/  
planningmetadata" assignId="  
Note  
sp  
P0001" creationDate="  
2011-08-20T17:00:00+09:00"  
lastUpdate="  
2011-09-28T10:30:00+09:00"  
version="1.00">3  
sp  
When you load another planning metadata file, the serial  
number returns to 00001 with the next recording  
operation.  
sp  
sp  
To select the clip name display format  
When names are defined in both ASCII format  
and UTF-8 format, you can use OPERATION  
>Clip >Clip Name Disp in the setup menu to  
select which of the names to display on the LCD  
monitor and on the viewfinder screen.  
To display ASCII format names: Select  
Title1(ASCII).  
<Properties propertyId="  
sp  
assignment" update="  
sp  
2011-09-28T10:30:00+09:00"  
sp  
modifiedBy="Chris">3  
Typhoon  
<Title usAscii="  
"
sp  
sp  
Typhoon_Strikes_Tokyo  
xml:lang="en">  
</Title>3  
</Properties>3  
</PlanningMetadata>3  
The clip name becomes  
“Typhoon_Strikes_Tokyo_SerialNumber”,  
but “Typhoon_SerialNumber” is displayed  
on the screens.  
Notes  
To display UTF-8 format names: Select  
Title2(UTF-8).  
• When you create a file, enter each statement as a single  
line with a CRLF only after the last character in the  
statement line, and do not enter spaces except where  
specified.  
• Up to 44 bytes (or characters) string is available for the  
clip name.  
The clip name becomes  
“Typhoon_Strikes_Tokyo_SerialNumber”,  
and the same name is displayed on the  
screens.  
If the UTF-8 format string exceeds 44 bytes, 44 bytes  
string is used as the clip name.  
If only ASCII format name is specified, 44 characters  
string is used as the clip name.  
When neither an ASCII format name string nor UTF-8  
Planning Metadata Operations  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
<Meta name="_ShotMark4"  
sp  
sp  
sp  
sp  
sp  
sp  
sp  
sp  
Defining Shot Mark Names in  
Planning Metadata  
Free Kick  
content="  
<Meta name="_ShotMark5"  
"/>3  
sp  
Goal Kick  
content="  
"/>3  
When you use planning metadata to set shot  
marks, you can define names for Shot Mark 0 to  
Shot Mark 9. When you record shot marks, you  
can add the shot mark name strings defined in the  
planning metadata.  
<Meta name="_ShotMark6"  
sp  
Foul  
content="  
<Meta name="_ShotMark7"  
"/>3  
sp  
PK  
content="  
"/>3  
<Meta name="_ShotMark8"  
sp  
1st Half  
content="  
"/>3  
Note  
<Meta name="_ShotMark9"  
sp  
Shot Mark 1 and Shot Mark 2 can be recorded on the  
camcorder. Shot Mark 3 to Shot Mark 9 and Shot Mark  
0 can be recorded by operation from a computer which is  
connected with the camcorder via Wi-Fi.  
2nd Half  
content="  
"/>3  
<Meta name="_ShotMark0"  
sp  
Kick Off  
content="  
"/>3  
</Properties>3  
</PlanningMetadata>3  
Shot mark name string example  
Use a text editor to modify the fields in the < Meta  
name> tag.  
The shaded fields in the example are essence  
mark name strings. Names can be either in ASCII  
format (up to 32 characters) or UTF-8 format (up  
to 16 characters).  
“sp” indicates a space and 3 indicates a carriage  
return.  
Note  
When you create a definition file, enter each statement as  
a single line with a CRLF only after the last character in  
the statement line, and do not enter spaces except where  
specified, except within essence mark name strings.  
You can use the Sony Planning Metadata Add-in  
application software supplied with the CBK-WA01  
Wi-Fi Adapter to Essence mark names. For details,  
refer to the Operating Instructions supplied with the  
CBK-WA01.  
Note  
If a name string contains even one non-ASCII character,  
the maximum length of that string is 16 characters.  
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="  
sp  
sp  
UTF-8"?>3  
<PlanningMetadata xmlns="http://  
xmlns.sony.net/pro/metadata/  
planningmetadata" assignId="  
sp  
H00123" creationDate="  
sp  
2011-04-15T08:00:00Z" lastUpdate="  
sp  
2011-04-15T15:00:00Z" version=  
sp  
"1.00">3  
<Properties propertyId=  
sp  
"assignment" class="original"  
sp  
sp  
update="2011-04-15T15:00:00Z"  
sp  
modifiedBy="Chris">3  
<Title usAscii="Football  
sp  
Game" xml:lang="en">  
sp  
Football Game 15/04/2011</  
Title>3  
<Meta name="_ShotMark1"  
sp  
sp  
sp  
sp  
Goal  
content="  
<Meta name="_ShotMark2"  
"/>3  
sp  
Shoot  
content="  
<Meta name="_ShotMark3"  
"/>3  
sp  
Corner Kick  
content="  
"/>3  
Planning Metadata Operations  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
90  
   
Chapter5 Clip Operations  
Clip Playback  
A thumbnail screen appears if you press the THUMBNAIL button in E-E or playback mode. Thumbnail  
screens display lists of the clips stored on SxS memory cards in the form of index pictures. (A message  
appears if you insert a memory card that contains no clips.)  
You can select any clip (see page 94) in a thumbnail screen and start playback of that clip (see page 94).  
Thumbnail Screen  
In thumbnail screens, the timecode of the index picture appears beneath the thumbnail for each clip. (An  
OK, NG or KP mark also appears when a clip has been marked with an OK, NG or KP mark.)  
Note  
Normal thumbnail screens display SD clips only or HD clips only, even if the SxS memory card contains clips in both  
formats. You can select the format to display by selecting a mode with OPERATION >Format >HD/SD (see page 112)  
in the setup menu.  
If you want to display all recorded clips, regardless of the HD/SD mode, switch to the all clips thumbnail screen.  
However, it is not possible to start playback from the all clips thumbnail screen (see page 99).  
Clip Playback  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
UDF mode/FAT-HD mode thumbnail screen  
UDF / FAT-HD  
Cursor (yellow)  
The icon of the currently selected SxS memory card is highlighted.  
(If the card is write protected, a lock appears on the left.)  
Clip number/Number of clips  
a Index picture  
f Video format of recording  
When a clip is recorded, its first frame is set  
automatically as the index picture. You can  
change to index picture to any frame (see  
g Special recording information  
This displays the mode of clips that have been  
recorded in a special mode (Slow & Quick  
Motion, Interval Rec, Frame Rec).  
b Lock mark  
Indicates the selected clip is marked with an OK  
mark or protected.  
For Slow & Quick Motion clips, the frame rates  
are displayed to the right as [Recording frame  
rate/Playback frame rate] fps.  
h OK/NG/KP mark  
c Date and start time of recording  
d Clip name  
When the recording mode is UDF, an OK, NG, or  
KP mark appears if the clip has been marked with  
an OK, NG or KP mark (see page 101).  
When the recording mode is FAT, an OK mark  
appears only if the clip has been marked with an  
OK mark (see page 101).  
e Independent AV file icon  
This appears only when a clip is an independent  
AV file. SxS memory cards may contain  
independent files that have been added directly  
from a computer. Because independent files lack  
the associated management files, some operations  
and information displays may not be available.  
i File format  
Indicates the file format of the selected clip (MXF  
or MP4).  
(This item is not indicated when the recording  
mode is UDF-HD mode.)  
Clip Playback  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
j Clip duration  
k Timecode  
This is the timecode of the index picture.  
FAT-SD mode thumbnail screen  
FAT-SD  
The icon of the currently selected SxS memory card is highlighted.  
(If the card is write protected, a lock appears on the left.)  
Cursor (yellow)  
Clip number/Number of components  
a Take mark  
e Video format of recording  
Indicates that the file size is larger than 2 GB, and  
that the clip has been split before being saved.  
You can check the segment files on the expand  
thumbnail screen (see page 104).  
f File format  
Indicates the file format of the selected clip  
(AVI).  
g Clip duration  
b Index picture  
When a clip is recorded, its first frame is set  
automatically as the index picture.  
h Timecode  
This is the timecode of the index picture.  
c Date and start time of recording  
To switch between SxS memory cards  
When two SxS memory cards are loaded, you can  
switch between them by pressing the SLOT  
SELECT button.  
d Clip name/Number of components  
The number after the clip name (delimited by /) is  
the number of components. This appears only for  
clips larger than 2 GB in size, which have been  
split into smaller files for storage.  
Note  
While an expand thumbnail screen (see page 104) or an  
essence mark thumbnail screen (see page 105) is  
displayed, SxS memory cards cannot be switched.  
Clip Playback  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
To pause play  
To hide the thumbnail screen  
Press the THUMBNAIL button.  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
The PLAY/PAUSE indicator flashes while play  
is paused.  
Press the button again to return to play mode.  
Playing Clips  
To play at high speed  
Press the F FWD button (see page 21) or the  
F REV button (see page 21).  
To return to normal playback, press the PLAY/  
PAUSE button.  
To select clip thumbnails  
Do one of the following to move the yellow  
cursor to the clip that you want to select.  
• Press an arrow button (J, j, K, k).  
• Turn the MENU knob.  
To stop play  
Press the STOP button: Play stops and the  
• Press the PREV or NEXT button.  
camcorder enters E-E mode.  
Press the THUMBNAIL button: Play stops and  
the thumbnail screen (see page 91) appears  
in the viewfinder.  
To select the first thumbnail  
With the F REV button held down, press the  
PREV button.  
To select the last thumbnail  
With the F FWD button held down, press the  
NEXT button.  
Play also stops if you eject the memory card. In  
this case, the camera picture appears in the  
viewfinder.  
To play clips sequentially starting from a  
selected clip  
To cue up clips  
To return to the top of the current clip  
Press the PREV button.  
1
2
Select the thumbnail of the clip that you  
want to play first.  
• During playback or F FWD, this jumps to the  
top of the current clip and starts play.  
• During F REV or pause, this jumps to the top of  
the current clip and displays a still image.  
• Each subsequent press of the button moves to  
the previous clip.  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
Play begins from the top of the selected clip.  
Play continues through all clips after the selected  
clip.  
When the last clip has been played to the end, the  
camcorder enters pause (still image) mode at the  
last frame of the last clip.  
To play from the top of the first clip  
Simultaneously press the PREV and F REV  
buttons. This jumps to the top of the first clip on  
the SxS memory card.  
Press the THUMBNAIL button to return to the  
thumbnail screen.  
To jump to the top of the next clip  
Press the NEXT button.  
Notes  
• During playback or F FWD, this jumps to the  
top of the next clip and starts play.  
• During F REV or pause, this jumps to the top of  
the next clip and displays a still image.  
• Each subsequent press of the button moves to  
the next clip.  
• There may be momentary picture breakup or still  
image display at the transition from one clip to another.  
During this time, the play controls and the  
THUMBNAIL button cannot be operated.  
• When you select a clip in the thumbnail screen and  
begin playback, there may be momentary picture  
breakup at the top of the clip. To view the top of the  
clip without breakup, put the camcorder into playback  
mode, pause, use the PREV button to return to the top  
of the clip, and start play again.  
• On SxS memory cards that contain both HD-mode and  
SD-mode clips, you cannot play all clips in sequence.  
For example, while an HD mode thumbnail screen is  
displayed, only HD mode clips are played in sequence.  
To play from the top of the last clip  
Simultaneously press the NEXT and F FWD  
buttons. This jumps to the top of the last clip on  
the SxS memory card.  
Clip Playback  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
(page 104) for more information about the expand  
thumbnail screen.  
To add a shot mark during play  
HD  
To search for essence marks in clips with  
the essence mark thumbnail screen  
You can add shot marks to clips during play by  
using the same method used during recording (see  
UDF / FAT-HD  
Notes  
When a clip contains one or more essence marks,  
you can easily find them with the essence mark  
thumbnail screen. The essence mark thumbnail  
screen displays a thumbnail of each essence mark  
frame in the clip.  
• Shot marks cannot be recorded when the SxS memory  
card is write protected.  
• Shot marks cannot be added at the first frame of each  
clip or last frame of the last clip.  
To display the essence mark thumbnail screen,  
press the ESSENCE MARK button (see page 23)  
or select THUMBNAIL >Thumbnail View >  
Essence Mark Thumbnail in the setup menu.  
Using Thumbnails to Search  
Inside Clips  
You can switch a thumbnail screen to the  
following thumbnail search screens, which allow  
you quickly find the clips you want.  
• Expand thumbnail screen  
Screen” (page 105) for more information about the  
essence mark thumbnail screen.  
• Essence mark thumbnail screen (in HD mode  
only)  
Like the normal thumbnail screen and the OK clip  
thumbnail screen, these screens allow you to  
select clip thumbnails (see page 94) and to start  
clip playback (see page 94).  
To search for scenes in clips with the  
expand thumbnail screen  
The expand thumbnail screen is convenient when  
you want to find and cue up a specific scene in a  
long clip.  
To display the expand thumbnail screen, select a  
clip in the thumbnail screen and press the DISP  
SEL/EXPAND button (see page 21) or select  
THUMBNAIL >Thumbnail View >Forward  
Expansion in the setup menu. The selected clip is  
displayed as follows.  
HD mode: The clip is divided into 12 equally-  
sized blocks, and a thumbnail of the first  
frame in each block is displayed.  
SD mode: Only in the case of clips that have been  
split into partial files because the file size was  
larger than 2 GB, a thumbnail of the first  
frame of each partial file is displayed.  
This helps you to quickly cue up to a desired  
scene in a clip of long duration.  
Clip Playback  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Thumbnail Operations  
You can use the THUMBNAIL menu to perform various operations on clips, to check clip properties, and  
to change clip metadata.  
THUMBNAIL Menu Configuration  
Menu items  
Sub-items  
Description  
Clip Properties  
Set Index Picture  
Displays detailed properties (see page 100).  
Changes index pictures in the expand thumbnail screen or  
the essence mark thumbnail screen (see page 106).  
UDF / FAT-HD  
Thumbnail View  
Forward Expansion  
• Displays the expand thumbnail screen (see page 104).  
• In the expand thumbnail screen, increases the number of  
divisions (see page 105).  
Back Expansion  
In the expand thumbnail screen, decreases the number of  
divisions.  
Essence Mark Thumbnail  
Displays the essence mark thumbnail screen (see  
UDF / FAT-HD  
Clip Thumbnail  
All Clip Thumbnail  
Add Shot Mark1  
Displays the normal thumbnail screen.  
Displays the all clips thumbnail screen (see page 99).  
Set Shot Mark  
In the expand thumbnail screen or the essence mark  
thumbnail screen, adds a Shot Mark1 mark (see page 106).  
UDF / FAT-HD  
Delete Shot Mark1  
In the expand thumbnail screen or the essence mark  
thumbnail screen, deletes a Shot Mark1 mark (see  
Add Shot Mark2  
In the expand thumbnail screen or the essence mark  
thumbnail screen, adds a Shot Mark2 mark (see page 106).  
Delete Shot Mark2  
In the expand thumbnail screen or the essence mark  
thumbnail screen, deletes a Shot Mark2 mark (see  
Set Clip Flag  
OK  
Adds an OK mark.  
NG  
Adds an NG mark.  
UDF  
KP(Keep)  
None  
Adds a KP mark.  
Deletes an OK, an NG or a KP mark.  
Adds an OK mark and protects a clip (see page 101).  
Add OK Mark  
FAT-HD  
Delete OK Mark  
Deletes an OK mark and unprotects a clip (see page 101).  
Protects a clip.  
FAT-HD  
Lock Clip  
UDF  
Unlock Clip  
UDF  
Cancels protection of a clip.  
Thumbnail Operations  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
96  
       
Menu items  
Copy Clip  
Sub-items  
Description  
Copies a clip (see page 102).  
Deletes a clip (see page 103).  
Divides a clip (see page 106).  
Delete Clip  
Divide Clip  
FAT-HD  
Filter Clips  
Displays the OK clip thumbnail screen (see page 98).  
FAT-HD  
Filter Clips  
OK  
Displays the OK clip thumbnail screen.  
Displays the NG clip thumbnail screen.  
Displays the KP clip thumbnail screen.  
NG  
UDF  
KP(Keep)  
None  
Displays the None clip (clip which have been marked with  
an OK, NG, or KP mark) thumbnail screen.  
Lock All Clips  
Protects all clips displayed.  
UDF  
Unlock All Clips  
UDF  
Cancels protection of all clips displayed.  
Batch copies groups of clips/files (see page 103).  
Copy All  
All Clips  
General Files  
All Clips & General Files  
Execute/Cancel  
Delete All Clips  
Deletes all unprotected clips (see page 103).  
Thumbnail Operations  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
According to the selected item or sub-item, a  
selection list or a clip properties screen appears  
To return to the previous state, push the MENU  
CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE switch down to the  
ESCAPE side.  
Basic THUMBNAIL Menu  
Operations  
information about menu operations.  
Notes  
To display the THUMBNAIL menu  
• When an SxS memory card is write protected, it is not  
possible to copy, delete, or divide clips, to change  
index pictures, or to add and delete OK/NG/KP marks  
and shot marks.  
• Some items cannot be selected, depending on the state  
of the camcorder when the menu was displayed.  
1
2
3
Press the THUMBNAIL button to  
display the thumbnail screen.  
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON,  
or press the MENU button.  
To hide the clip properties screen  
Do one of the following.  
Press the RESET/RETURN button: This  
returns to the THUMBNAIL menu.  
Press the THUMBNAIL button: The  
camcorder enters E-E mode, and the camera  
picture appears.  
Turn the MENU knob to select “TH”,  
and then press the knob. Or press the J  
or j button to select “TH”, and then  
press the SET button.  
The THUMBNAIL menu appears.  
FAT  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button: Playback from  
the selected clip starts.  
Changing the Thumbnail Screen  
Type  
in FAT mode  
UDF  
To display OK/NG/KP/None clip  
thumbnails  
When the recording mode is UDF, from among  
all clips stored on the currently selected SxS  
memory card, only clips which have been marked  
with a OK, NG or KP mark can be displayed, or  
only clips with no marks (None clips) can be  
displayed.  
When the recording mode is FAT, from among all  
clips stored on the currently selected SxS memory  
card, only clips which have been marked with an  
OK mark can be displayed.  
When the normal thumbnail screen is displayed,  
you can select THUMBNAIL >Filter Clips to  
switch to the screen.  
in UDF mode  
To hide the THUMBNAIL menu, press the  
MENU button again.  
To select menu items and sub-items  
In FAT-HD mode: Switched to the OK clip  
thumbnail screen.  
Do one of the following.  
• Turn the MENU knob to select an item or sub-  
item, and then press the knob.  
• Press the arrow buttons (J, j, K, k) to  
select an item or sub-item, and then press the  
SET button.  
In UDF mode: By selecting one of OK, NG, KP  
(Keep) and None in the setting area, you can  
display the thumbnail screen containing only  
clips which have been marked with the  
selected mark or only clips which have been  
marked with no marks (None clips).  
Thumbnail Operations  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
(page 101) for information about how to add OK  
marks.  
To display the all clips thumbnail screen  
The all clips thumbnail screen displays  
thumbnails of all of the clips on the selected  
memory card, including both HD-mode and  
SD-mode clips. This is useful when you want to  
check whether the memory card contains clips in  
another mode.  
You can switch to the all clips thumbnail screen  
by selecting THUMBNAIL >All Clip Thumbnail  
in the setup menu in the normal thumbnails  
screen.  
Pressing the RESET/RETURN button returns  
you to the normal thumbnails screen, where you  
can perform playback and other clip operations.  
Note  
You cannot start playback from the all clips thumbnail  
screen.  
Thumbnail Operations  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
99  
   
Displaying Clip Properties  
The clip properties screen appears when you select Clip Properties in the THUMBNAIL menu.  
UDF / FAT-HD  
FAT-SD  
a Image of the current clip  
d Clip name  
In SD mode, only for clips that have been divided  
because the file size was greater than 2 GB, the  
number of component clips appears after the clip  
name.  
b Image of the previous clip  
Press the PREV button to display the properties of  
the previous clip.  
When clip names are 12 characters or longer, only  
the first five characters and the last five characters  
are displayed. If you want to check the  
abbreviated characters, press the MENU knob to  
switch to long display mode. In long display  
mode, up to 53 characters are displayed in clip  
names.  
c Image of the next clip  
Press the NEXT button to display the properties  
of the next clip.  
Thumbnail Operations  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Press the MENU knob again to exit long display  
mode. Pressing the PREV or NEXT button to  
display the previous or next clip also exists long  
display mode.  
To add an OK mark  
FAT-HD  
e Lock mark  
This appears when the clip is marked with an OK  
mark or protected.  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select  
THUMBNAIL >Add OK Mark.  
The screen changes to the clip properties  
screen, and a confirmation message appears  
beneath the index picture.  
f OK/NG/KP mark  
This appears only when an OK/NG/KP mark has  
been added.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
An OK mark is added to the selected clip.  
g Date and start time of recording  
h File format  
The file format of the clip (MXF, MP4 or AVI)  
appears.  
You can use an assignable switch to which Clip  
Flag OK is assigned to add OK marks.  
To add an OK, NG or KP mark  
i Special recording information  
This displays the mode of clips that have been  
recorded in a special mode (Slow & Quick  
Motion, Interval Rec, Frame Rec).  
For Slow & Quick Motion clips, the frame rates  
are displayed to the right as [Recording frame  
rate/Playback frame rate].  
UDF  
1
2
3
In the thumbnail screen, select  
THUMBNAIL >Set Clip Flag.  
Select one of OK, NG or KP in the  
setting area.  
j Timecode of the displayed image  
k Timecode of the recording start point  
l Timecode of the recording end point  
m Duration  
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The mark selected in step 2 is added to the  
selected clip.  
You can use assignable switches to which Clip  
Flag OK, Clip Flag NG and Clip Flag Keep are  
assigned to add OK, NG and KP marks.  
n Recorded audio channels  
o Video format of recording  
To delete an OK mark  
Adding and Deleting OK, NG or  
KP Marks  
FAT-HD  
A Delete OK Mark item appears in the  
THUMBNAIL menu when you have selected a  
clip that has an OK mark.  
UDF / FAT-HD  
You can add OK, NG or KP marks to clips. This  
makes it possible to display thumbnails of only  
the clips that you need by pressing the  
THUMBNAIL button.  
When the recording mode is FAT, clips with OK  
marks cannot be deleted or divided (protected). If  
you want to delete or divide such a clip, delete the  
OK mark.  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select  
THUMBNAIL >Delete OK Mark.  
The screen changes to the clip properties  
screen, and a confirmation message appears  
beneath the index picture.  
Thumbnail Operations  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
A confirmation message appears beneath the  
index picture.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The OK mark is deleted from the selected  
clip.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
All clips are protected.  
To delete an OK, NG or KP mark  
To cancel protection of a clip  
UDF  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select the  
thumbnail of the clip which you want to  
unprotect, and select THUMBNAIL  
>Unlock Clip.  
The screen changes to the clip properties  
screen, and a confirmation message appears  
beneath the index picture.  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select the  
thumbnail of the clip from which you  
want to delete an OK, NG or KP mark,  
and select THUMBNAIL >Set Clip Flag  
>None.  
The screen changes to the clip properties  
screen, and a confirmation message appears  
beneath the index picture.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The selected clip is unprotected.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The mark selected in step 2 is added to the  
selected clip.  
To cancel protection of all clips  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select  
THUMBNAIL >Unlock All Clip.  
A confirmation message appears beneath the  
index picture.  
Protecting Clips  
UDF  
When the recording mode is UDF, you can  
protect a selected clip or all clips. Protected clips  
cannot be deleted or divided.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
All clips are unprotected.  
To protect a clip  
Copying Clips  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select the  
thumbnail of the clip which you want to  
protect, and select THUMBNAIL  
>Lock Clip.  
You can copy clips to other SxS memory cards.  
Clips are copied to destination SxS memory cards  
using the same names as the original clips.  
Notes  
The screen changes to the clip properties  
screen, and a confirmation message appears  
beneath the index picture.  
• If a clip with the same name already exists at the copy  
destination SxS memory card, a one-digit number in  
parentheses is added to the original name.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The number in parentheses is the smallest number that  
does not exist at the copy destination.  
The selected clip is protected.  
Examples:  
ABCD0002tABCD0002(1)  
ABCD0002(1)tABCD0002(2)  
ABCD0005(3)tABCD0005(4)  
To protect all clips  
• If the parenthetical numbers (1) to (9) already exist at  
the copy destination, it is not possible to copy any more  
clips under that name. (A tenth clip cannot be copied.)  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select  
THUMBNAIL >Lock All Clips.  
Thumbnail Operations  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
102  
       
• A message appears if there is not enough free capacity  
at the copy destination SxS memory card. Exchange  
the card for one with more free capacity.  
During the copy, the progress of the copy is  
displayed.  
If you executed the copy in HD mode, only  
HD-mode clips are copied.  
If you executed the copy in SD mode, only  
SD-mode clips are copied.  
• When multiple clips are recorded in a source SxS  
memory card, it may not be possible to copy all clips  
to the end. Depending on memory characteristics and  
usage of the memory cards, this can occur even when  
the source and destination memory cards have the  
same capacity.  
To cancel the copy operation  
Press the RESET/RETURN button.  
When the copy finishes  
A completion message appears, and the  
THUMBNAIL menu screen appears again.  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select the  
thumbnail of the clip to copy, and then  
select THUMBNAIL >Copy Clip.  
The screen changes to the properties screen  
of that clip, and a confirmation message  
appears beneath the index picture.  
To copy all files in the General directory  
To copy all files only, without copying clips,  
select THUMBNAIL >Copy All >General Files  
in step 1.  
To copy all files together with all clips, select  
THUMBNAIL >Copy All >All Clips & General  
Files in step 1.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The copy starts.  
During the copy, an execution message and  
progress bar are displayed.  
When the copy finishes, the display returns to the  
thumbnail screen.  
Deleting Clips  
You can delete clips from SxS memory cards.  
To cancel a copy operation  
Note  
Press the RESET/RETURN button.  
The copy is cancelled, and the display returns to  
the thumbnail screen.  
HD clips with OK marks cannot be deleted.  
If you want to delete such clips, first delete the OK marks  
1
2
In the thumbnail screen, select the  
thumbnail of the clip to delete, and then  
select THUMBNAIL >Delete Clip.  
The screen changes to the properties screen  
of that clip, and a confirmation message  
appears beneath the index picture.  
To batch copy groups of clips/files  
You can batch copy groups of clips from one SxS  
memory card to another SxS memory card.  
When both HD-mode and SD-mode clips exist on  
the source SxS memory card, only clips in the  
currently selected mode are copied. This is a  
convenient way to extract clips in one of the  
modes.  
You can also copy of the files in the General  
directory, either together with or separately from  
clips.  
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The clip is deleted.  
In the thumbnail screen, the clips that followed  
the deleted clip move up one position.  
1
2
In the thumbnail screen, select the  
thumbnails of the clips to copy and then  
select THUMBNAIL >Copy All >All  
Clips.  
The confirmation message “Copy All Clip?”  
appears.  
To batch delete groups of clips  
You can batch delete groups of clips from an SxS  
memory card.  
Notes  
• When both HD-mode and SD-mode clips exist on the  
SxS memory card, only clips in the currently selected  
mode are deleted.  
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The copy starts.  
Thumbnail Operations  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
• In HD mode, clips with OK marks are not deleted,  
even when a deletion is executed for a group of clips  
that includes them.  
thumbnail of the first frame in each block is  
displayed.  
Number of the selected frame  
1
In the thumbnail screen, select the  
thumbnails of the clips to delete and  
then select THUMBNAIL >Delete All  
Clips.  
The confirmation message “Delete All  
Clips?” appears.  
S1  
S2  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
S2  
S1  
The deletion starts.  
During the deletion, the progress of the  
deletion is displayed.  
If you executed the deletion in HD mode,  
only HD-mode clips are deleted.  
If you executed the deletion in SD mode,  
only SD-mode clips are deleted.  
Clip properties are shown at the bottom of the  
screen.  
Except for the items listed below, the information  
displayed here is the same as the information  
displayed in the normal thumbnail screen.  
To cancel the deletion  
Press the RESET/RETURN button.  
a Frame information  
This displays frame information using icons.  
When the deletion finishes  
A completion message appears, and the  
THUMBNAIL menu screen appears again.  
Index picture  
Frame with Shot Mark1  
S1  
Displaying the Expand Thumbnail  
Screen  
Frame with Shot Mark2  
S2  
The expand thumbnail screen allows you to  
search inside clips by using thumbnails (see  
page 95), to change index pictures (see  
page 106), and to add and delete shot marks (see  
The same icons are also displayed beneath the  
thumbnails. However, when several icons could  
be displayed for the same frame, one icon is  
selected for display, in the order of priority Index  
picture > Shot Mark1 > Shot Mark2.  
To display the screen  
b Timecode  
This displays the timecode of the selected frame  
in the expand thumbnail screen.  
In the thumbnail screen, select a thumbnail and  
press the DISP SEL/EXPAND button (see  
page 21) or select THUMBNAIL >Thumbnail  
View >Forward Expansion.  
Expand thumbnail screen in FAT-SD  
mode  
An expand thumbnail screen for the selected clip  
appears.  
Expand thumbnail screen in UDF/FAT-HD  
mode  
FAT-SD  
In FAT-SD mode, only in the case of clips that  
have been split into partial files because the file  
size was larger than 2 GB, a thumbnail of the first  
frame of each partial file is displayed.  
UDF / FAT-HD  
In UDF mode or FAT-HD mode, the selected clip  
is divided into 12 equally-sized blocks, and a  
Thumbnail Operations  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
1
2
In the thumbnail screen, select the  
thumbnail of a clip, and press the  
ESSENCE MARK button (see page 23)  
or select THUMBNAIL >Thumbnail  
View >Essence Mark Thumbnail.  
The essence mark thumbnail screen appears,  
and a selection list is displayed.  
Number of the selected frame  
Select the type of the essence mark  
thumbnail screen  
All: Display all frames marked with essence  
marks.  
Rec Start: Display frames marked with Rec  
Start marks and of the first frames of  
clips when the first frames are not  
marked with Rec Start marks (In UDF  
mode only).  
Shot Mark1: Display only frames marked  
with Shot Mark1 marks.  
Shot Mark2: Display only frames marked  
with Shot Mark2 marks.  
Clip properties are displayed at the bottom of the  
screen.  
Except for the items listed below, the information  
displayed here is the same as the information  
displayed in the normal thumbnail screen.  
a Timecode  
This is the timecode of the selected partial file.  
b Duration  
This is the duration of the selected partial file.  
You can also select Shot Mark 0 and Shot  
Mark 3 to Shot Mark 9.  
If you have recorded clips by using planning  
metadata that defined names for Shot Mark 0  
to Shot Mark 9, the defined names are  
displayed instead of the above item names in  
the list.  
To increase the number of divisions  
When you press the DISP SEL/EXPAND button,  
or select THUMBNAIL >Thumbnail View  
>Forward Expansion, the divided clip or file is  
further divided into 12 equally-sized blocks (a  
clip or file that has been divided into 12 is further  
divided into 12, for 12 × 12 = 144 divisions). You  
can repeat the same operation to increase the  
number of division.  
Example shot mark thumbnail screen  
(with Shot Mark1 selected)  
To return to the previous division level  
Press the DISP SEL/EXPAND button with the  
SHIFT button held down, or select  
S1  
S
S2  
S1  
THUMBNAIL >Thumbnail View >Back  
Expansion. The expand thumbnail screen returns  
to the previous division level.  
S1  
S1  
Displaying the Essence Mark  
Thumbnail Screen  
The properties of the clip appear at the bottom of  
the screen.  
UDF / FAT-HD  
Except for the following item, the information  
displayed here is the same as the information  
displayed in the expand thumbnail screen.  
In the essence mark thumbnail screen (shown  
only in HD mode), you can search for shot marks  
in clips (see page 95), change index pictures (see  
page 106), and add and delete shot marks (see  
Thumbnail Operations  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
a Timecode  
This is the timecode of the selected frame in the  
shot mark thumbnail screen.  
1
2
Select the thumbnail of the frame that  
you want to use as the index picture,  
and then select THUMBNAIL >Set  
Index Picture.  
The properties screen of the selected frame  
appears, and a confirmation message appears  
below the image.  
Adding and Deleting Shot Marks  
UDF / FAT-HD  
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
In the essence mark thumbnail screen (see  
page 105) or the expand thumbnail screen (see  
page 104), you can add thumbnails to any frame  
of clips recorded in HD mode, and delete  
recorded shot marks.  
Note  
Even if you set the index picture to a frame that is not the  
first frame of a clip, playback of that clip from a  
thumbnail screen always begins at the first frame.  
To add shot marks  
Dividing Clips  
1
Select the frame where you want to add  
a shot mark, and then select  
THUMBNAIL > Set Shot Mark > Add  
Shot Mark1 (or Add Shot Mark2).  
The properties screen of the selected frame  
appears, and a confirmation message appears  
below the image.  
FAT-HD  
In the expand thumbnail screen (see page 104)  
and the essence mark thumbnail screen (see  
page 105), clips recorded in FAT-HD mode can  
be divided into two clips at the selected frame.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
1
Select the thumbnail of the frame where  
you want to divide the clip, and then  
select THUMBNAIL >Divide Clip.  
The properties screen of the selected frame  
appears, and a confirmation message appears  
below the image.  
To delete shot marks  
1
Select the frame where you want to  
delete a shot mark, and then select  
THUMBNAIL > Set Shot Mark >  
Delete Shot Mark1 (or Delete Shot  
Mark2).  
The properties screen of the selected frame  
appears, and a confirmation message appears  
below the image.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
The clip is divided at the selected frame, and  
two clips with different names are created.  
The first four characters of the clip name are  
taken from the name of the original clips, and the  
last four characters are new serial numbers.  
2
Select [Execute], and press the MENU  
knob.  
Example: When the name of a newly recorded  
clip would be EFGH0100, and a clip named  
ABCD0002 is divided, the names of the two  
newly created clips are ABCD0100 and  
ABCD0101.  
Changing Clip Index Pictures  
UDF / FAT-HD  
Note  
In the essence mark thumbnail screen (see  
page 105) or the expand thumbnail screen (see  
page 104), you can set the selected frame of the  
clip recorded in UDF/FAT-HD mode as the index  
picture.  
When there is not enough remaining capacity on the SxS  
memory cards to store the divided clips, a message  
appears to inform you that there is not enough capacity.  
Thumbnail Operations  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Chapter6  
Menu and Detailed Settings  
Setup Menu  
Organization and Levels  
USER  
Format Media  
Rec Function  
Input/Output  
Clip  
On this camcorder, settings for shooting and  
playback are made in the setup menu, which  
appears in the viewfinder.  
The setup menu can also be displayed on an  
external video monitor (see page 167).  
Assignable SW  
Camera Config  
OPERATION Menu (see page 112)  
OPERATION  
Format  
Format Media  
Input/Output  
Super Impose  
LCD  
Setup Menu Organization  
The setup menu consists of the following menus.  
Us: USER menu  
Rec Function  
Assignable SW  
VF Setting  
Marker  
Menu items added in any order from other menus  
Op: OPERATION menu  
Settings related to shooting, except settings  
Gain Switch  
TLCS  
related to picture quality (see page 112)  
Pa: PAINT menu  
Settings related to picture quality (see page 129)  
Zebra  
Display On/Off  
“!” LED  
Th: THUMBNAIL menu  
Settings related to clip thumbnails (see page 96)  
Auto Iris  
Note  
Shot ID  
The THUMBNAIL menu is used only when a thumbnail  
screen (see page 91) is displayed. It is disabled when no  
thumbnail screen is displayed.  
Shot Display  
White Setting  
Offset White  
Shutter  
Ma: MAINTENANCE menu  
Settings related to audio and timecode (see  
Time Zone  
Clip  
Fi: FILE menu  
Settings related to file operations (see page 150)  
Plan.Metadata  
USB  
Setup Menu Levels  
for the organization of the THUMBNAIL menu.  
Setup Menu Organization and Levels  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
107  
         
PAINT  
FILE  
User  
Switch Status  
White  
All  
Black  
Scene  
Reference  
Lens  
Flare  
Gamma  
Black Gamma  
Knee  
White Clip  
Detail(HD Mode)  
Detail(SD Mode)  
Aperture  
Skin Detail  
Matrix  
Multi Matrix  
V Modulation  
Low Key Saturation  
Noise Suppress  
MAINTENANCE Menu (see page 135)  
MAINTENANCE  
White Shading  
Black Shading  
Battery  
Audio  
WRR Setting  
Timecode  
Essence Mark  
Camera Config  
Preset White  
White Filter  
DCC Adjust  
Auto Iris2  
Genlock  
ND Comp  
Lens  
Auto Shading  
APR  
Trigger Mode  
Network Setting  
Wi-Fi Setting  
Clock set  
Language  
Hours Meter  
Version  
Setup Menu Organization and Levels  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
• The menu item selection area displays a  
maximum of seven lines. You can scroll  
through menus with more than seven lines  
by moving the cursor up and down.  
Triangles appear at the upper right and  
lower right of the menu item selection area  
to indicate that a menu is scrollable.  
Basic Setup Menu  
Operations  
To display the setup menu  
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to ON, or press  
the MENU button.  
The camcorder enters menu mode and the menu  
list appears on the screen.  
A cursor appears over the first two characters of the  
most recently used menu, and the corresponding  
menu item selection area appears to the right.  
Appears when more menu items  
are available below the last line.  
(v appears when more menu items  
are available above the first line.)  
Example: When the cursor is positioned at the  
OPERATION menu  
Menu item selection area  
B appears to the right when more detailed  
sub-items are available.  
Settings appear to the right when a menu  
item has no sub-items.  
Menu list  
You can select  
previous level.  
to return to the  
3
Turn the MENU knob, or press the J or  
j button, to move the cursor to the item  
that you want to set, and then confirm  
by pressing the MENU knob or the SET  
button.  
Menu item selection area  
Note  
The sub-items area appears to the right of the  
menu item selection area, and the cursor  
moves to the first sub-item.  
The setup menu cannot be used when the camcorder is in  
focus magnification mode. Exit focus magnification  
mode by pressing the assignable switch to which the  
Focus Mag function has been assigned.  
To make menu settings  
1
2
Turn the MENU knob, or press the J or  
j button, to move the cursor to the item  
that you want to set.  
A list of selectable menu items appears in the  
menu item selection area to the right of the  
icon.  
Sub-items area  
• Displays sub-items and their current  
settings  
• To return to the previous level, select  
press the K button, or push the MENU  
CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE switch down to  
the ESCAPE side.  
Press the MENU knob or the SET  
button.  
The cursor moves to the menu item selection  
area.  
You can also move the cursor to the menu  
item selection area by pressing the k  
button.  
Basic Setup Menu Operations  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
Turn the MENU knob, or press the J or  
j button, to move the cursor to the sub-  
item that you want to set, and then  
confirm the selection by pressing the  
MENU knob or the SET button.  
The settings of the selected sub-item appear,  
and the cursor moves to the currently  
selected value.  
1
Turn the MENU knob, or press the J or  
j button, to select a character, and then  
confirm by pressing the MENU knob or  
the SET button.  
The cursor moves to the next position.  
To return to the previous position, push the  
MENU CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE switch  
down to the ESCAPE side.  
2
3
Select characters for all positions up to  
the last.  
The cursor moves to “SET”.  
Press the MENU knob or the SET  
button.  
This confirms the setting.  
Settings area  
• The settings area displays a maximum of  
seven lines. You can scroll through menus  
with more than seven sub-items by moving  
the cursor up and down. Triangles appear at  
the upper right and lower right of the  
settings area to indicate that a sub-item  
menu is scrollable.  
To cancel the setting change  
Push the MENU CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE  
switch down to the ESCAPE side.  
To reset a setting to the initial value  
1
Before a setting is changed or after a  
setting change is cancelled, push the  
MENU CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE  
switch up to the CANCEL/PRST side.  
• For sub-items with a large settings range  
(for example, –99 to +99), the settings area  
is not displayed. Instead, the sub-item name  
is highlighted to indicate that the sub-item  
can be set.  
2
When the message to confirm whether  
the current setting is reset to the initial  
value, push the MENU CANCEL/  
PRST/ESCAPE switch up to the  
CANCEL/PRST side again.  
5
Turn the MENU knob, or press the J or  
j button, to select the value to set, and  
then confirm by pressing the MENU  
knob or the SET button.  
The setting is changed, and the display is  
The current setting is reset to the initial value.  
updated to show the new setting.  
If you select [Execute] for an executable  
item, the corresponding function is executed.  
To exit the menu  
Set the MENU ON/OFF switch to OFF or press  
the MENU button.  
Items that require confirmation before execution  
In step 3, the menu disappears and a confirmation  
message appears if you select an item that  
requires confirmation before execution. Follow  
the instructions in the message to execute or  
cancel the operation.  
The normal camera picture reappears.  
To enter text  
Some items, such as time data or file names, must  
be set by entering text. When you select one of  
these items, the text entry area is highlighted, with  
“SET” displayed to the right.  
Basic Setup Menu Operations  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Menu List  
USER Menu (Factory Default Configuration)  
The USER menu consists of the following items when it is in the factory default state.  
• Format Media (see page 113)  
• Input/Output (see page 114)  
• Rec Function (see page 116)  
1)  
• Assignable Sw (see page 117)  
2)  
• Camera Config (see page 142)  
1) Excluding sub-item <0>  
2) Contains only User Menu Only as sub-item  
You can change the configuration of the USER menu by adding desired menu items and arranging them  
in a desired order.  
For details, refer to the Supplement supplied in the CD-ROM (labeled “Manuals for Solid-State Memory  
Camcorder”).  
Menu List  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
OPERATION Menu  
Settings in bold are the factory default values.  
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Format  
Specifies the  
Sub-item  
File System  
Settings  
UDF/FAT  
Description  
Switches between UDF and FAT as the  
recording mode (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
Switches between HD or SD as the  
operating mode (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
camcorder’s  
recording mode,  
operating mode and  
recording format.  
HD/SD  
HD/SD  
Note  
When the optional CBK-MD01 is not  
installed, [SD] cannot be selected. (SD  
recording is not allowed.)  
HD System Line  
1080/720  
When the operating mode is HD, sets  
the number of system lines to 1080 or  
720 (execute by selecting Execute).  
Selects the system frequency (execute  
by selecting Execute).  
System Frequency The available settings  
vary depending on the  
settings in HD/SD, HD  
System Line, and  
Country.  
59.94i/29.97P/23.98P  
When the HD/SD setting is [HD], the  
HD System Line setting is [1080], and  
the Country setting is other than [PAL  
Area].  
50i/25P  
• When the HD/SD setting is [HD], the  
HD System Line setting is [1080], and  
the Country setting is [PAL Area].  
• When the HD/SD setting is [SD], and  
the Country setting is [PAL Area].  
When the HD/SD setting is [HD], the  
HD System Line setting is [720], and  
the Country setting is other than [PAL  
Area].  
59.94P/29.97P/23.98P  
50P/25P  
When the HD/SD setting is [HD], the  
HD System Line setting is [720], and  
the Country setting is [PAL Area].  
When the HD/SD setting is [SD], and  
the Country setting is other than [PAL  
Area].  
59.94i/29.97P  
Menu List  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Format  
Specifies the  
camcorder’s  
Sub-item  
Rec Format  
Settings  
Description  
Selects the recording format (execute by  
selecting Execute).  
The available settings  
vary depending on the  
settings in UDF/FAT, HD/  
SD, HD System Line, and  
System Frequency.  
operating mode and  
recording format.  
HD422 50/HD420 HQ  
• When the UDF/FAT setting is [UDF],  
the HD/SD setting is [HD], the HD  
System Line setting is [1080].  
• When the UDF/FAT setting is [UDF],  
the HD/SD setting is [HD], the HD  
System Line setting is [720], and the  
System Frequency setting is  
[23.98P].(When the System  
Frequency setting is [25P], [29.97P],  
or [50P], this setting is fixed to  
[HD422 50].)  
HQ 1920/HQ 1440  
When the UDF/FAT setting is FAT, the  
HD/SD setting is [HD], the HD System  
Line setting is [1080], and the System  
Frequency setting is [29.97P] or [25P].  
When the UDF/FAT setting is FAT, the  
HD/SD setting is [HD], the HD System  
Line setting is [1080], and the System  
Frequency setting is other than [29.97P]  
and [25P].  
HQ 1920/HQ 1440/  
SP 1440  
HQ 1280  
When the UDF/FAT setting is FAT, the  
HD/SD setting is [HD], and the HD  
System Line setting is [720].  
IMX50/DVCAM  
When the UDF/FAT setting is [UDF]  
and the HD/SD setting is [SD].  
When the UDF/FAT setting is [FAT] and  
the HD/SD setting is [HD].  
DVCAM  
Aspect Ratio (SD) 16:9/4:3  
Selects the aspect ratio when SD mode  
is selected (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
Audio  
Length(IMX)  
Country  
24bit/16bit  
Selects the audio bit rate for recording  
in IMX format.  
Selects the area of use (execute by  
selecting Execute).  
NTSC Area/NTSC(J)  
Area/PAL Area  
Format Media  
Executes a media  
format.  
Media(A)  
Media(B)  
Execute/Cancel  
Initializes the SxS memory card in slot  
A (execute by selecting Execute).  
Initializes the SxS memory card in slot  
B (execute by selecting Execute).  
Execute/Cancel  
Menu List  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Input/Output  
Makes settings  
related to I/O signals.  
In FAT mode  
Output& i.LINK  
In UDF mode  
Output  
HD&HDV/SD&HDV/  
SD&DV  
HD/SD  
Selects the signals output from the  
video connectors and the i.LINK (HDV/  
DV) connector.  
When the HD/SD setting is SD,  
“SD&DV” or “SD” is selected.  
When the video format is HQ 1920/  
23.98P or HQ 1440/23.98P, selects  
whether to use progressive output (PsF)  
or pulldown output (Pull Down).  
Selects whether to use the camera  
picture (Camera), the i.LINK input (in  
FAT mode only) or the SDI/composite  
input (External) as the video input  
source.  
23.98P Output  
PsF/Pull Down  
a)  
Source Select  
Camera/i.LINK  
/External  
Notes  
• When Rec Source is assigned to the  
ASSIGN. 2 switch, this setting is  
disabled.  
• Changing the setting of File System  
>UDF/FAT resets this item to  
[Camera] (factory default setting).  
Selects the external input signal.  
HD-SDI: HDSDI signals (in HD mode  
only)  
a)  
Ext Video Source HD SDI/SD SDI/  
Composite  
SD-SDI: SDSDI signals  
Composite: Composite signals  
Selects whether to enable or disable  
input and output of signals via the  
i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector.  
When Enable is selected, you can  
execute auto black balance adjustment  
during i.LINK output.  
i.LINK I/O  
Enable/Disable  
SDI Output  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the output of signals  
from the HD/SD SDI OUT connector.  
Turns on or off the superimposition of  
text information on the output of the  
HD/SD SDI OUT connector  
SDI Out Super  
On/Off  
Video Out Super  
Live & Play  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the superimposition of  
text information on the output of the  
VIDEO OUT connector.  
On/Off  
Turns Live & Play function on or off.  
Menu List  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Input/Output  
Makes settings  
related to I/O signals.  
Down Converter  
Crop/Letter/Squeeze  
Selects the signal conversion mode for  
output of SD signals.  
Crop: Crop the edges of the 16:9  
picture and output as a 4:3 picture.  
Letter: Mask the top and bottom of the  
4:3 picture and display in the center  
of the screen as a 16:9 picture.  
Squeeze: Squeeze the 16:9 picture  
horizontally and output as a 4:3  
picture.  
Wide ID  
Through/Auto  
Selects whether to add a wide ID signal  
to the SD output signal.  
Through: Output without adding a  
wide ID signal.  
Auto: Add and output a wide ID signal  
when the Down Converter setting is  
Squeeze.  
Wide  
Mode(EXT)  
Auto/16:9  
When the input signal is SD, select the  
method that determines whether the  
signal is treated as a wide signal.  
Auto: When wide a ID signal is  
detected in the input signal, treat  
the signal as a wide signal and set  
the up-converter operating mode to  
squeeze mode. When a wide ID  
signal is not detected, set the  
upconverter operating mode to  
edge crop mode and do not record a  
wide ID signal.  
a)  
16:9: Always treat the signal as a wide  
signal and set the upconverter  
operating mode to squeeze mode.  
When the Country setting is other than  
[PAL Area], selects whether to remove  
the setup level of analog input video  
signals.  
Setup  
Remove(EXT)  
7.5%/0.0%  
a)  
7.5%: Remove the setup.  
0.0%: Do not remove the setup.  
When the setting of Input/Output >SDI  
Out Super or Video Out Super is On,  
superimpose text information on the  
output from the HD/SD SDI OUT  
connector, and VIDEO OUT connector,  
as specified (On or Off) for each item.  
When the setting of Input/Output  
>Video Out Super is On, specifies  
whether to superimpose markers on the  
output from the VIDEO OUT  
connector.  
Super Impose  
Makes settings  
related to  
superimposed text  
and markers.  
Super(VF Display) On/Off  
Super(Menu) On/Off  
Super(Timecode) On/Off  
Super(Marker)  
On/Off  
LCD  
LCD Color  
LCD  
Marker&Zebra  
–99 to 0 to +99  
On/Off  
Adjusts the LCD color.  
Turns the marker and zebra display in  
the LCD monitor on or off.  
Menu List  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Rec Function  
Makes settings  
related to special  
recording modes.  
Slow & Quick  
On/Off  
Turns the Slow & Quick Motion  
function on or off. (When this is set to  
On, the Picture Cache Rec, Interval Rec,  
and Frame Rec sub-items are set to Off.)  
When the Slow & Quick setting is On,  
sets the frame rate for Slow & Quick  
Frame Rate  
The available settings  
vary depending on the  
Format >HD System Line Motion shooting.  
setting.  
Note  
When Picture Cache  
is assigned to an  
assignable switch,  
this item is disabled  
(displayed in grey).  
When Format >Country is When the HD System Line setting is  
set to other than [PAL  
Area] in UDF mode or in  
FAT mode: 1 to 30  
1080.  
When Format >Country is  
set to [PAL Area] in UDF  
mode: 1 to 25  
When Format >Country is When the HD System Line setting is  
set to other than [PAL  
Area] in UDF mode or in  
FAT mode: 1 to 30 to 60  
When Format >Country is  
set to [PAL Area] in UDF  
mode: 1 to 25 to 50  
On/Off  
720.  
Clip Continuous  
Rec  
Turns the Clip Continuous Rec function  
on or off. (When this is set to On, the  
Slow & Quick, Picture Cache Rec,  
Interval Rec, and Frame Rec sub-items  
are set to Off.)  
Picture Cache Rec On/Off  
Turns the picture cache function on or  
off. (When this is set to On, the Slow &  
Quick, Interval Rec, Frame Rec sub-  
items are set to Off.)  
P. Cache Rec Time 0-2sec/2-4sec/4-6sec/  
When the Picture Cache Rec setting is  
6-8sec/8-10sec/10-12sec/ On, set the picture cache time.  
12-14sec/13-15sec  
Interval Rec  
Frame Rec  
On/Off  
Turns the Interval Rec function on or  
off. (When this is set to On, the Slow &  
Quick, Picture Cache Rec, and Frame  
Rec sub-items are set to Off.)  
Turns the Frame Rec function on or off.  
(When this is set to On, the Slow &  
Quick, Picture Cache Rec, and Interval  
Rec sub-items are set to Off.)  
On/Off  
Number of Frames The available settings  
vary depending on the  
When Interval Rec or Frame Rec is set  
to On, specifies the number of frames to  
shoot in one Interval Rec or Frame Rec  
settings in Format >HD  
System Line and Format take.  
>System Frequency.  
2frame/6frame/12frame When the HD System Line setting is  
720, and the System Frequency setting  
is 59.94P or 50P.  
1frame/3frame/6frame/ When the HD System Line setting is  
9frame  
other than 720, or the System Frequency  
setting is other than 59.94P or 50P.  
Menu List  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Rec Function  
Sub-item  
Interval Time  
Settings  
1/2/3/4/5/6/7/8/9/10/15/ When the Interval Rec setting is On,  
20/30/40/50 (sec) sets the interval for Interval Rec  
Description  
Makes settings  
related to special  
recording modes.  
1/2/3/4/5/6/7/8/9/10/15/ shooting.  
20/30/40/50 (min) 1/2/3/  
4/6/12/24 (hour)  
Pre-Lighting  
Live Logging  
Off/2sec/5sec/10sec  
If you want the video light to be turned  
on before Interval Rec shooting, select a  
number of seconds before the start of  
shooting. If you do not want it to be  
turned on, select Off.  
In UDF mode: Selects the Live  
Logging operation mode.  
d)  
Live/View  
In FAT mode: Fixed to [Live] (live  
mode).  
Note  
When one of Frame Rec, Interval Rec,  
and Clip Continuous Rec modes is  
selected, [View] cannot be selected.  
For details on Live Logging functions,  
refer to the Supplement supplied in the  
CD-ROM (labeled “Manuals for Solid-  
State Memory Camcorder”).  
Assigns function to ASSIGN. 0 switch.  
Assigns function to ASSIGN. 1 switch.  
Assigns function to ASSIGN. 2 switch.  
Assigns function to ASSIGN. 3 switch.  
Assigns function to ASSIGNABLE 4  
switch.  
Assignable SW  
Assigns functions to  
assignable switches.  
<0>  
<1>  
<2>  
<3>  
<4>  
See page 155.  
Functions to  
(page 155) for more  
information about  
assigning functions.  
<5>  
Assigns function to ASSIGNABLE 5  
switch.  
RET  
Assigns function to RET button on the  
lens.  
C. Temp  
Zoom Speed  
Assigns function to COLOR TEMP.  
button.  
When Zoom has been assigned to the  
ASSIGNABLE 4 or 5 switch, specifies  
the zoom speed.  
0 to 20 to 99  
Menu List  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
OPERATION  
Menu items  
VF Setting  
Makes settings  
related to the  
Sub-item  
Color  
Settings  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Description  
b)  
Adjusts the density of the colors  
displayed in the viewfinder screen.  
Selects the display mode of the  
viewfinder.  
b)  
Mode  
Color/B&W  
viewfinder screen.  
Color: Color  
B&W: Monochrome  
Selects the peaking type.  
Normal: Normal peaking  
Color: Color peaking  
Both: Both  
b)  
Peaking Type  
Normal/Color/Both  
Peaking  
Frequency  
Peaking Color  
Normal/High  
Selects Normal or High as the peaking  
frequency.  
b)  
b)  
White/Red/Yellow/Blue When the Peaking Type setting is Color,  
selects the peaking color from among  
White, Red, Yellow, and Blue.  
Adjusts the detail level (set on the  
camcorder) of the viewfinder  
c)  
VF Detail Level  
Color Peaking  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Low/Mid/High  
When the Peaking Type setting is Both,  
selects the color peaking level from  
among Low, Mid, and High.  
b)  
Level  
Marker  
Setting  
On/Off  
Turns all markers on or off.  
Makes settings  
related to marker  
display in the  
Note  
When Marker is assigned to the ASSIGN.  
2 switch, this setting is disabled.  
viewfinder screen.  
Center Marker  
1/2/3/4/Off  
When the center marker is displayed,  
selects the type. Select Off if you do not  
want to display the marker.  
Note  
When three of Safety Zone, User Box,  
Guide Frame, and 100% Marker are set to  
[On], this setting cannot be turned on.  
Center H Position –40 to 0 to 40  
Specifies the horizontal position of the  
center marker.  
Center V Position –40 to 0 to 40  
Specifies the vertical position of the  
center marker.  
Safety Zone  
On/Off  
Turns the safety zone display on or off.  
Note  
When three of Center Marker, User Box,  
Guide Frame, and 100% Marker are set to  
[On], this setting cannot be turned on.  
Safety Area  
Aspect Marker  
80%/90%/92.5%/95%  
Line/Mask/Off  
Selects the safety zone range.  
When an aspect marker is to be  
displayed, selects the display method.  
Select Off if you do not want to display  
the marker.  
Line: Show as white lines.  
Mask: Display by lowering the video  
signal level of areas outside the  
marker range.  
Aspect Select  
15:9/14:9/13:9/4:3/  
Selects the aspect ratio of the marker.  
1.66:1/1.85:1/2.35:1/2.4:1  
Menu List  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Marker  
Makes settings  
related to marker  
display in the  
Sub-item  
100% Marker  
Settings  
On/Off  
Description  
Turns the 100% safety zone display on  
or off.  
Note  
viewfinder screen.  
When three of Center Marker, Safety Zone,  
User Box, and Guide Frame are set to [On],  
this setting cannot be turned on.  
Aspect Mask  
User Box  
0% to 30% to 90% (10% When the Aspect Marker setting is  
step)  
Mask, specifies the video signal level of  
areas outside the marker range as a  
percentage value relative to the video  
signal level of areas inside the marker  
range.  
On/Off  
Turns the box cursor display on or off.  
Note  
When three of Center Marker, Safety Zone,  
Guide Frame, and 100% Marker are set to  
[On], this setting cannot be turned on.  
User Box Width  
User Box Height  
40 to 500 to 999  
Specifies the box cursor width (distance  
from the center to the left and right  
edges).  
Specifies the box cursor height  
(distance from the center to the top and  
bottom edges).  
70 to 500 to 999  
User Box H  
Position  
User Box V  
Position  
–479 to 0 to 479  
–464 to 0 to 464  
On/Off  
Specifies the horizontal position of the  
box cursor center.  
Specifies the vertical position of the box  
cursor center.  
Turns display of the guide frame on or  
off.  
Guide Frame  
Note  
When three of Center Marker, Safety Zone,  
User Box, and 100% Marker are set to  
[On], this setting cannot be turned on.  
Gain Switch  
Gain Low  
–6dB/–3dB/0dB/3dB/  
6dB/9dB/12dB/18dB/  
24dB/30dB/36dB/42dB  
–6dB/–3dB/0dB/3dB/  
6dB/9dB/12dB/18dB/  
24dB/30dB/36dB/42dB  
–6dB/–3dB/0dB/3dB/  
6dB/9dB/12dB/18dB/  
24dB/30dB/36dB/42dB  
–6dB/–3dB/0dB/3dB/  
6dB/9dB/12dB/18dB/  
Specifies the gain value for the  
L position of the GAIN switch.  
Makes settings  
related to the GAIN  
switch.  
Gain Mid  
Specifies the gain value for the  
M position of the GAIN switch.  
Gain High  
Gain Turbo  
Shockless Gain  
Specifies the gain value for the  
H position of the GAIN switch.  
Specifies the gain value for the Turbo  
Gain function, which can be assigned to  
24dB/30dB/36dB/42dB an assignable switch.  
On/Off Turns shockless gain (a function that  
switches smoothly when the gain is  
switched) on or off.  
Menu List  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
OPERATION  
Menu items  
TLCS  
Makes settings  
related to total level  
control.  
Sub-item  
Mode  
Settings  
Backlight/Standard/  
Spotlight  
Description  
Selects the auto iris mode used when the  
TLCS system is activated.  
Backlight: Backlight mode (lessens the  
blackout of the main subject that  
occurs under backlit conditions)  
Standard: Standard mode  
Spotlight: Spotlight mode (lessens the  
whiteout of the main subject that  
occurs under a spotlight)  
Speed  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the control speed (speed of  
reaction to changes in the video) used  
when the TLCS system is activated.  
(Larger values specify quicker reaction  
times.)  
AGC  
On/Off  
Turns the AGC (auto gain control)  
function on or off.  
AGC Limit  
AGC Point  
3dB/6dB/9dB/12dB/  
18dB  
F5.6/F4/F2.8  
Specifies the maximum gain used when  
AGC is on.  
Specifies the F value where control by  
auto iris switches to control by AGC,  
used when AGC is on.  
Auto Shutter  
Auto Shutter Limit 1/100 / 1/150 / 1/200 /  
1/250  
On/Off  
Turns the auto shutter function on or off.  
Selects the maximum shutter speed used  
when auto shutter is on.  
Auto Shutter Point F5.6/F8/F11/F16  
Specifies the F value where control by  
auto iris switches to control by auto  
shutter, used when auto shutter is on.  
Selects the zebra pattern type (Zebra1,  
Zebra2, Both).  
Zebra  
Zebra Select  
1/2/BOTH  
Makes settings  
related to zebra  
displays.  
Zebra1 Level  
Zebra1 Aperture  
Level  
50% to 70% to 107%  
1 to 10% to 20%  
Specifies the Zebra1 display level.  
Specifies the Zebra1 aperture level.  
Zebra2 Level  
Video Level  
Warnings  
52% to 100% to 109%  
On/Off  
Specifies the Zebra2 display level.  
Turns the warnings that appear when the  
video level is too bright or too dark on  
or off.  
Turns the numerical indication of the  
video brightness on or off.  
Turns the histogram display of video  
signal levels on or off.  
Display On/Off  
Selects the items to  
display in the  
viewfinder screen.  
Brightness Display On/Off  
Histogram Display On/Off  
(In HD mode only)  
Lens Info  
Meter/Feet/Off  
Selects whether or not to display the  
depth of field indication and the unit for  
display of the depth of field.  
Meter: Displayed in meters  
Feet: Displayed in feet  
Off: Do not display  
Focus Position  
Zoom Position  
On/Off  
Turns the indication of the lens focus  
position on or off.  
Turns the indication of the lens zoom  
position on or off.  
On/Off  
Audio Level Meter On/Off  
Turns the display of the audio level  
meters on or off.  
Menu List  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Display On/Off  
Selects the items to  
display in the  
Timecode  
On/Off  
Turns the display of time data  
(timecode, user bits, counter, duration)  
on or off.  
viewfinder screen.  
Battery Remain  
Media Remain  
TLCS Mode  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
On/Off  
Turns the indications of the remaining  
battery time and input voltage on or off.  
Turns the indication of the remaining  
media capacity on or off.  
Turns the indication of the TLCS  
operating mode on or off.  
Turns the indication of the focus  
operating mode on or off.  
Turns the indication of the white  
balance mode on or off.  
Turns the indication of the ND filter  
setting on or off.  
Turns the indication of the iris position  
on or off.  
Turns the indication of the gain setting  
on or off.  
Turns the indications of the shutter  
mode and shutter speed on or off.  
Turns the indication of the color  
temperature on or off.  
Turns the indication of the video format  
on or off.  
Turns the indication of the system lines  
on or off.  
Turns the indication of special recording  
modes (S&Q, Interval, Frame Rec,  
Picture Cache Rec) on or off.  
Turns the lens extender indication on or  
off.  
Focus Mode  
White Balance  
Mode  
Filter Position  
Iris Position  
Gain Setting  
Shutter Setting  
Color Temp  
Video Format  
System Line  
Rec Mode  
Extender  
On/Off  
WRR RF Level  
On/Off  
Turns the indication of the digital  
wireless receiver reception level on or  
off.  
Clip Number(PB) On/Off  
Turns the indication of clip information  
on or off.  
Menu List  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATION  
Menu items  
“!” LED  
Sub-item  
Gain<!>  
Settings  
On/Off  
Description  
c)  
Turns on or off the function to light the !  
indicator when the gain is set to other  
than 0 dB.  
Shutter <!>  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the function to light the !  
indicator when the SHUTTER selector  
is set to ON.  
White Preset <!> On/Off  
Turns on or off the function to light the !  
indicator when the WHITE BAL switch  
is set to PRST.  
ATW Run <!>  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the function to light the !  
indicator when White Setting >White  
Switch<B> is set to [ATW].  
Turns on or off the function to light the !  
indicator when the lens extender is used.  
Turns on or off the function to light the !  
indicator when the reference value of  
auto iris adjustment is not the standard  
value.  
Extender <!>  
On/Off  
Iris Override <!>  
On/Off  
Auto Iris  
Makes settings  
related to auto iris.  
Iris Override  
Iris Speed  
On/Off  
Turns iris override (a setting that opens  
or closes the iris more than normal) on  
or off.  
Specifies the iris control speed (speed of  
reaction to changes in the video).  
(Larger values specify quicker reaction  
times.)  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Clip High light  
Iris Window  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the function that  
disregards highlights and forces a flatter  
reaction to high luminance.  
Selects the auto iris detection window  
type.  
1/2/3/4/5/6/Var  
On/Off  
Var: Variable  
Iris Window  
Indication  
ID-1  
Turns the indication of the auto iris  
detection window frame on or off.  
Creates ID-1 strings (up to 16  
characters) superimposed.  
Shot ID  
Creates the shot IDs  
superimposed on  
the color bars.  
ID-2  
Creates ID-2 strings (up to 16  
characters) superimposed.  
ID-3  
Creates ID-3 strings (up to 16  
characters) superimposed.  
ID-4  
Creates ID-4 strings (up to 16  
characters) superimposed.  
Shot Display  
Selects which shot  
data is  
superimposed on  
the color bars and  
recorded.  
Shot Date  
Shot Time  
On/Off  
Selects whether to superimpose the shot  
date (On) or not (Off).  
Selects whether to superimpose the shot  
time (On) or not (Off).  
Selects whether to superimpose the  
model name (On) or not (Off).  
Selects whether to superimpose the  
serial number (On) or not (Off).  
On/Off  
Shot Model Name On/Off  
Shot Serial  
Number  
On/Off  
Shot ID Select  
ID-1/ID-2/ID-3/ID-4/Off Selects whether or not to superimpose  
the shot ID set with the Shot ID item  
and which shot ID is superimposed.  
Menu List  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
White Setting  
Makes settings  
related to auto white  
balance adjustments.  
White Switch<B> Memory/ATW  
Specifies the operating mode selected  
by the B position of the WHITE BAL  
switch.  
Memory: Auto white balance  
ATW: Auto tracing white balance  
Specifies the reaction speed when the  
WHITE BAL switch setting is changed.  
Off is an instant reaction, and 1 is faster  
than 2 or 3.  
Shockless White  
ATW Speed  
Off/1/2/3  
1/2/3/4/5  
Specifies the reaction speed when the  
White Switch<B> setting is [ATW]. 1 is  
the fastest reaction.  
AWB Fixed Area On/Off  
Specifies whether auto white balance is  
executed at the center of the screen.  
On: Execute in an area corresponding  
to 25% of the height and width of  
the screen.  
Off: Execute in an area corresponding  
to 70% of the height and width of  
the screen.  
Filter White  
Memory  
On/Off  
Specifies whether to allocate a white  
balance memory area for each FILTER  
knob position.  
On: Allocation a white balance memory  
area for each FILTER knob  
position.  
Off: Use A/B memory regardless of the  
filter position.  
Menu List  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Offset White  
Makes settings  
related to white  
Sub-item  
Offset White <A> On/Off  
Settings  
Description  
Specifies whether to add (On) or not to  
add (Off) an offset value to the white  
balance value in memory A.  
When the setting of Offset White<A> is  
[On], specifies (as a color temperature)  
the offset to add to the white balance  
value in memory A. (Note that the error  
range becomes larger for higher offset  
color temperatures. Adjust while  
viewing the actual video.)  
balance offset values.  
Warm Cool <A>  
Approximate color  
temperature  
Warm Cool  
Balance<A>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies a more precise color  
temperature, for use when satisfactory  
video cannot be obtained with the Warm  
Cool <A> setting.  
Offset White <B> On/Off  
When this is set to [On], the offset  
adjusted set with this item is added to  
the white balance of channel B.  
When the setting of Offset White<B> is  
[On], specifies (as a color temperature)  
the offset to add to the white balance  
value in memory B. (Note that the error  
range becomes larger for higher offset  
color temperatures. Adjust while  
viewing the actual video.)  
Warm Cool <B>  
Approximate color  
temperature  
Warm Cool  
Balance<B>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies a more precise color  
temperature, for use when satisfactory  
video cannot be obtained with the Warm  
Cool <B> setting.  
Shutter  
Shutter Select  
Second/Degree  
Specifies the unit used to select shutter  
speeds.  
Makes settings  
related to the shutter  
setting.  
Second: Select in units of seconds.  
Degree: Select in units of degrees.  
Turns the SLS mode on or off.  
Selects the number of accumulated  
frames in SLS mode.  
Slow Shutter  
SLS Frames  
On/Off  
2Frames/3Frames/  
4Frames/Frames/  
6Frames/7Frames/  
8Frames/16Frames  
Time Zone  
Zone  
–12:00 to +0:00 to +14:00 Specifies a difference from UTC  
Specifies the time  
zone.  
(in steps of 30 minutes)  
(Greenwich Mean Time) in units of  
30 minutes.  
Menu List  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Clip  
Make settings for clip  
name or clip  
Sub-item  
Auto Naming  
Settings  
Description  
In Fat mode: Title/Plan  
In UDF mode: C****/  
Title/Plan  
Selects the clip naming format.  
C****: XDCAM standard name (In  
UDF mode only)  
Title: Name specified by Title Prefix  
Plan: Name specified in planning  
metadata (if no name is specified in  
planning metadata, the name  
specified by Title Prefix is  
selected.)  
management.  
Note  
Do not assign clip  
names that begin with  
the “.” (period)  
symbol.  
Clips with names in  
which the first  
character is “.” cannot  
be viewed on the  
application software  
for computers.  
Menu List  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Clip  
Make settings for clip  
name or clip  
Sub-item  
Title Prefix  
Settings  
Text input  
Description  
Specifies the title part (4 to 46  
alphanumeric characters) of clip titles.  
When the currently specified title is  
eight characters or fewer in length, the  
entire title appears. When the title is  
longer than eight characters, the first  
seven characters appear and a “···”  
symbol appears in place of the eighth  
character.  
management.  
Note  
Do not assign clip  
names that begin with  
the “.” (period)  
symbol.  
Clips with names in  
which the first  
Displays the Character Set screen.  
Character Set screen configuration  
• Character selection area (three lines)  
Select the character to insert at the title  
prefix cursor position.  
character is “.” cannot  
be viewed on the  
application software  
for computers.  
!#$%()+.-.;=@[]^_~0123456789  
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ  
• Cursor operation area (one line)  
Space: Changes the character at the  
cursor position to a space  
INS: Inserts a space at the cursor  
position  
DEL: Deletes the character at the cursor  
position  
T: Moves the cursor to the left  
t: Moves the cursor to the right  
ESC: Cancels the change and return to  
the normal menu  
END: Executes the change and return to  
the normal menu  
• Title prefix area (one line)  
An area to enter the title  
To set titles  
1 Turn the MENU knob or press the  
arrow buttons to select a character,  
highlighting it, in the character  
selection area, and then press the  
MENU knob or the SET button to  
insert it at the cursor position in the  
title prefix area. (The cursor moves to  
the right.)  
2 Repeat step 1 to add more characters  
to the title (using Space, INS, and  
DEL as required).  
3 When you have finished entering the  
title, select END to close the  
Character Set screen.  
Menu List  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Clip  
Make settings for clip  
name or clip  
Sub-item  
Number Set  
Settings  
00001 to 99999  
Description  
Specifies the initial value of the numeric  
part (five digits) of clip names (The  
numeric part of clip names is limited to  
four digits number if Auto Naming is  
set to other than [Plan] or if planning  
metadata is invalid though Auto  
Naming is set to [Plan].)  
Selects whether or not to display the  
name of the next clips to be recorded (in  
E-E mode), and where to display the  
name.  
management.  
Note  
Do not assign clip  
names that begin with  
the “.” (period)  
symbol.  
Clips with names in  
which the first  
character is “.” cannot  
be viewed on the  
application software  
for computers.  
Name Display  
Off/Viewfinder/LCD  
Status/Both  
Off: Do not display  
Viewfinder: Display on the viewfinder  
screen  
LCD Status: Display on the LCD  
monitor (with the display mode se  
to STATUS)  
Both: Display on both the viewfinder  
screen and the LCD monitor  
Note  
If a clip with the same name as the next  
clip to be recorded already exists on the  
recording media, then immediately after  
recording begins the clip name is displayed  
with a different serial number (when the  
selection is other than Off).  
Update  
Media<A>/Media<B>  
Updates the management files on the  
media in the selected slot (execute by  
selecting Execute).  
Menu List  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
OPERATION  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Plan.Metadata  
Makes settings for  
operating planning  
metadata.  
Load/Slot(A)  
Execute/Cancel  
Executes load of planning metadata  
from the SxS memory card in slot A.  
Select [Execute] to show the list of the  
planning metadata files stored in the slot A  
SxS memory card and select a file to  
execute the load.  
Load/Slot(B)  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Executes load of planning metadata  
from the SxS memory card in slot B.  
Select [Execute] to show the list of the  
planning metadata files stored in the slot  
B SxS memory card and select a file to  
execute the load.  
Executes load of planning metadata  
from the USB flash drive connected to  
the external device connector.  
Select [Execute] to show the list of the  
planning metadata files stored in the  
USB flash drive and select a file to  
execute the load.  
Load/USB  
(in UDF mode  
only)  
Properties  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Displays the detailed information in the  
planning metadata loaded on the  
camcorder (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Clears the planning metadata loaded on  
the camcorder (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Clear  
Clip Name Disp  
Memory Rec  
Title1(ASCII)/  
Title2(UTF-8)  
Selects the display mode of the clip  
name specified in planning metadata  
Select whether to enable or disable the  
record of proxy data to a USB flash  
drive.  
USB  
Makes settings for  
operating a USB  
Enable/Disable  
flash drive (in UDF Copy Current Clip Execute/Cancel  
mode only)  
Executes the copy of the proxy data for  
the current clip to a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Executes the copy of the proxy data for  
all clips stored in the selected SxS  
memory card to a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Executes the clear of the proxy data for  
all clips copied to a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Executes the FAT32 format of a USB  
flash drive (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Copy All Clips  
Execute/Cancel  
Del All Memory  
Clips  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Format USB  
Memory  
a) When the optional CBK-HD02 is installed  
b) When the CBK-VF01 is used.  
c) When an HDVF series viewfinder is used.  
d) When the optional CBK-UPG01 is installed.  
Menu List  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PAINT Menu  
Settings in bold are the factory default values.  
PAINT  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Gamma  
Settings  
On/Off  
On/Off  
Description  
Switch Status  
Turns gamma correction on or off.  
Turns black gamma correction on or  
off.  
Turns various signal  
correction functions  
and a test signal on or  
off.  
Black Gamma  
Matrix  
On/Off  
Turns linear matrix correction and  
user matrix correction on or off.  
Turns knee correction on or off.  
Turns white clip correction on or  
off.  
Knee  
On/Off  
White Clip  
On/Off  
Detail  
On/Off  
Turns detail correction on or off.  
Turns aperture correction on or off.  
Turns flare correction on or off.  
Turns the test saw signal on or off.  
Displays the white balance color  
temperature saved in memory A.  
Specifies the white balance gain  
values saved in memory A (linked R  
gain and B gain).  
Aperture  
Flare  
On/Off  
On/Off  
Test Saw  
Color Temp <A>  
On/Off  
White  
Sets the color  
temperature, and  
performs manual white  
balance adjustment.  
1500K to 3200K to  
50000K  
Color Temp BAL  
<A>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
R Gain <A>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the white balance R gain  
value saved in memory A.  
B Gain <A>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the white balance B gain  
value saved in memory A.  
Color Temp <B>  
1500K to 3200K to  
50000K  
Displays the white balance color  
temperature saved in memory B.  
Specifies the white balance gain  
values saved in memory B (linked R  
gain and B gain).  
Color Temp BAL  
<B>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
R Gain <B>  
B Gain <B>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the white balance R gain  
value saved in memory B.  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the white balance B gain  
value saved in memory B.  
Black  
Master Black  
R Black  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the master black level.  
Specifies the R black level.  
Specifies the B black level.  
Specifies the black  
level (level of the  
unilluminated parts of  
the video).  
B Black  
You can achieve a  
desired look by  
adjusting the black  
level for deeper or  
shallower blacks.  
Menu List  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
PAINT  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Flare  
Settings  
Description  
Flare  
Makes settings related  
to flare.  
Flare is light generated  
from a bright image  
region that spreads  
broadly across the  
image, adding light to  
dark regions and  
On/Off  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Turns flare correction on or off.  
Sets the master flare correction  
level.  
Master Flare  
R Flare  
G Flare  
B Flare  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Sets the R flare correction level.  
Sets the G flare correction level.  
Sets the B flare correction level.  
reducing contrast. It is  
caused by reflection  
inside the lens system.  
Gamma  
Gamma  
On/Off  
Turns gamma correction on or off.  
Makes settings related  
to gamma.  
Gamma correction  
allows you to  
significantly alter the  
impression made by the  
video by adjusting the  
contrast.  
Step Gamma  
0.35 to 0.45 to 0.90 (0.05 Specifies a gamma correction value  
step)  
in steps of 0.05  
Master Gamma  
R Gamma  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
The available settings  
vary depending on the  
setting in Gamma  
Category (see  
Specifies the master gamma level.  
Specifies the R gamma level.  
Specifies the G gamma level.  
Specifies the B gamma level.  
Select the gamma table to use in  
gamma correction.  
When Gamma Category is STD:  
1 DVW: DVW camcorder  
equivalent  
G Gamma  
B Gamma  
Gamma Select  
“Description”).  
2 ×4.5: ×4.5 gain  
3 ×3.5: ×3.5 gain  
4 240M: SMPTE-240M equivalent  
5 R709: ITU-R709 equivalent  
(default setting)  
6 ×5.0: ×5.0 gain  
When Gamma Category is HG:  
1 3250: Condense 325% video input  
to 100% video output  
2 4600: Condense 460% video input  
to 100% video output  
3 3259: Condense 325% video input  
to 109% video output  
4 4609: Condense 460% video input  
to 109% video output (default  
setting)  
Gamma Category  
Black Gamma  
Gamma Level  
Range  
STD/HG  
Selects use of standard gamma  
(STD) or HyperGamma (HG).  
Black Gamma  
On/Off  
Turns black gamma correction on or  
off.  
Makes settings related  
to black gamma  
correction.  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the master black gamma  
level.  
Black gamma  
Low/L Mid/H.Mid/High Selects the black gamma correction  
correction allows you  
to reproduce gradations  
and color nuances in  
black or near-black  
(dark) parts of the  
picture.  
effective range.  
LOW: 0 to 3.6%  
L.MID: 0 to 7.2%  
H MID: 0 to 14.4%  
HIGH: 0 to 28.8%  
Menu List  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PAINT  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Knee  
Settings  
Description  
Knee  
Makes settings related  
to knee correction.  
Knee correction is  
processing that  
prevents washout by  
compressing the bright  
parts of the video  
according to an upper  
limit for the dynamic  
range of the recorded  
and output picture. The  
signal level where knee  
processing begins is  
called the “knee point”,  
and the slope of knee  
compression is called  
the “knee slope”.  
On/Off  
50.0% to 95.0% to  
109.0%  
Turns knee correction on or off.  
Specifies the knee point.  
Knee Point  
Knee Slope  
–99 to 0 to +99  
On/Off  
Specifies the knee slope.  
Turns the knee saturation function  
on or off.  
Knee Saturation  
Knee Saturation  
Level  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the knee saturation level.  
White Clip  
White Clip  
Level  
On/Off  
Turns white clipping adjustment on  
or off.  
Makes settings related  
to white clipping  
adjustments.  
[NTSC Area] or [NTSC Specifies the white clip level.  
Area(J)] is selected for  
Country  
90.0% to 108.0% to  
109.0%  
[PAL Area] is selected for  
Country  
White clipping is  
processing that limits  
the maximum level of  
video output signals.  
The maximum video  
signal output value is  
called the “white clip  
level”.  
90.0% to 105.0% to  
109.0%  
Menu List  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PAINT  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Detail  
Settings  
Description  
Detail(HD Mode)/  
Detail(SD Mode)  
Makes settings related  
to details adjustments  
in HD mode and SD  
mode.  
Detail adjustment is  
processing that  
improves the clarity of  
the video by adding  
detail signals to the  
edges of the subject.  
On/Off  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Turns detail adjustment on or off.  
Specifies the detail level.  
Specifies the mix ratio between the  
H detail level and the V detail level.  
Specifies the crispening level.  
Turns the level depend adjustment  
function on or off.  
Level  
H/V Ratio  
Crispening  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Level Depend  
On/Off  
Level Depend Level –99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the level depend level.  
Specifies the central frequency for H  
detail signals. Larger values give  
finer details.  
Frequency  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Knee Aperture  
On/Off  
Turns the knee aperture function on  
or off.  
Knee Aperture Level –99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the knee aperture level.  
Specifies the detail limiter values for  
both the white-side and black-side  
direction.  
Limit  
–99 to 0 to +99  
White Limit  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
NAM/G/R+G/Y  
Specifies the white-side detail  
limiter value.  
Black Limit  
Specifies the black-side detail  
limiter value.  
V-BLK Limit  
V Detail Creation  
Specifies the black-side V detail  
limiter value.  
Selects the source signal used to  
generate the V detail signal.  
NAM: A V detail signal created  
from the R signal, or a V detail  
signal created from the G  
signal, or a V detail signal  
created from the B signal,  
whichever is the signal with the  
highest level  
G: G signal  
G+R: Composite signal comprising  
the G signal and R signal in a  
1:1 ratio  
Y: Y signal  
Cross Color  
(in SD mode only)  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Sets the cross color reduction level  
for details.  
Note  
When Detail is set to [Off] or  
OPERATION >Format >Country is set  
to [Pal Area], this setting is disabled.  
Menu List  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PAINT  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Aperture  
Level  
Settings  
Description  
Aperture  
On/Off  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Turns aperture correction on or off.  
Sets the aperture level.  
Makes settings related  
to aperture correction.  
Aperture correction is  
processing to improve  
resolution by adding  
high-frequency  
aperture signals to the  
video signal, which  
corrects degeneration  
due to high-frequency  
characteristics.  
Skin Detail  
Makes settings related  
to skin detail  
correction.  
Skin detail correction is  
processing that  
increases or decreases  
the detail level of a  
specified color range  
(skin tone range), for  
the purpose of  
obtaining attractive  
reproduction of skin  
tones.  
Skin Detail  
On/Off  
Turns skin detail correction on or  
off.  
Area Detection  
Area Indication  
Color detection screen  
On/Off  
Detects the color to be targeted by  
skin detail correction.  
Turns on or off the function that  
displays a zebra pattern in the area  
targeted by skin detail correction.  
Specifies the skin detail level.  
Specifies the saturation of the color  
targeted by skin detail correction.  
Specifies the hue of the color  
targeted by skin detail correction.  
Specifies a range for the hue of the  
color targeted by skin detail  
correction.  
Level  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Saturation  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Hue  
0 to 359  
Width  
0 to 40 to 90  
Matrix  
Matrix  
On/Off  
Turns the matrix correction function  
on or off.  
Makes settings related  
to matrix correction.  
Matrix correction  
Preset Matrix  
Preset Select  
On/Off  
Turns the preset matrix function on  
or off.  
allows you to adjust the  
color and vividness of  
the video. Depending  
on the effect you want,  
you can select one from  
among a number of  
preset matrixes, which  
define different  
1/2/3/4/5/6  
Selects a preset matrix.  
1: SMPTE-240M equivalent  
2: ITU-709 equivalent  
3: SMPTE WIDE equivalent  
4: NTSC equivalent  
5: EBU equivalent  
6: PAL equivalent  
parameter sets. Or you  
can select a user matrix  
with your own  
User Matrix  
On/Off  
Turns the user matrix function on or  
off.  
parameters.  
User Matrix R-G  
User Matrix R-B  
User Matrix G-R  
User Matrix G-B  
User Matrix B-R  
User Matrix B-G  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies a freely defined R-G user  
matrix.  
Specifies a freely defined R-B user  
matrix.  
Specifies a freely defined G-R user  
matrix.  
Specifies a freely defined G-B user  
matrix.  
Specifies a freely defined B-R user  
matrix.  
Specifies a freely defined B-G user  
matrix.  
Menu List  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PAINT  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Multi Matrix  
Makes settings related  
to multi matrix  
Multi Matrix  
On/Off  
Turns the multi matrix correction  
function on or off.  
Area Indication  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the function that  
displays a zebra pattern in the color  
area targeted by multi matrix  
correction.  
correction.  
Multi-matrix correction  
allows specific colors  
to be selected for  
saturation correction in  
a 16-axis hue space.  
Color Detection  
Axis  
Color detection screen  
Detects colors targeted by multi  
matrix correction.  
B/B+/MG–/MG/MG+/  
Specifies a color targeted by multi  
R/R+/YL–/YL/YL+/G–/ matrix correction (16-axis mode)  
G/G+/CY/CY+/B–  
Hue  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the hue of the color  
targeted by multi matrix correction  
for each 16-axis mode.  
Saturation  
V Modulation  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the saturation of the color  
targeted by multi matrix correction  
for each 16-axis mode.  
V Modulation  
On/Off  
Turns V modulation shading on or  
off.  
Makes settings related  
to V modulation  
shading.  
V modulation shading  
corrects vertical  
imbalances in  
sensitivity arising from  
the relationship  
between a lens and  
prism.  
Master V  
Modulation  
R V Modulation  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the master V modulation  
level.  
Specifies the V modulation level of  
R signals.  
G V Modulation  
B V Modulation  
Specifies the V modulation level of  
G signals.  
Specifies the V modulation level of  
B signals.  
Low Key Sat.  
Low Key Saturation On/Off  
Turns low key saturation correction  
on or off.  
Makes settings related  
to low key saturation  
correction.  
You can correct the  
saturation of colors in  
dark parts of the video  
only.  
Level  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the saturation of colors in  
low luminance areas.  
Range  
Low/L Mid/H.Mid/High Specifies the luminance level for  
which low key saturation is enabled.  
Noise Suppress  
Noise Suppress  
On/Off  
Turns noise suppression on or off.  
Makes settings related  
to noise suppression  
(noise compression).  
You can effectively  
suppress noise  
components while  
preserving fine edge  
components in the  
subject.  
Menu List  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE Menu  
Settings in bold are the factory default values.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
White Shading  
Channel Select  
Red/Green/Blue  
Selects the target of white shading  
correction.  
Makes settings related  
to white shading.  
White shading is  
required for each  
different lens to correct  
irregularities arising  
from lens  
characteristics. It  
corrects luminance and  
color irregularities in  
bright areas.  
R/G/B White H Saw –99 to 0 to +99  
R/G/B White H Para –99 to 0 to +99  
R/G/B White V Saw –99 to 0 to +99  
R/G/B White V Para –99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies a SAW white shading  
correction value for the horizontal  
direction.  
Specifies a parabola white shading  
correction value for the horizontal  
direction.  
Specifies a SAW white shading  
correction value for the vertical  
direction.  
Specifies a parabola white shading  
correction value for the vertical  
direction.  
White Saw/Para  
Channel Select  
On/Off  
Turns the white shading SAW and  
parabola correction functions on or  
off.  
Black Shading  
Red/Green/Blue  
Selects the target of black shading  
correction.  
Makes settings related  
to black shading  
correction.  
R/G/B Black H Saw –99 to 0 to +99  
R/G/B Black H Para –99 to 0 to +99  
R/G/B Black V Saw –99 to 0 to +99  
R/G/B Black V Para –99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies a SAW black shading  
correction value for the horizontal  
direction.  
Specifies a parabola black shading  
correction value for the horizontal  
direction.  
Specifies a SAW black shading  
correction value for the vertical  
direction.  
Specifies a parabola black shading  
correction value for the vertical  
direction.  
Black Saw/Para  
On/Off  
Turns the black shading SAW and  
parabola correction functions on or  
off.  
Master Black  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the master black level.  
Specifies a temporary master gain  
value.  
Master Gain (TMP) –6dB/–3dB/0dB/3dB/  
6dB/9dB/12dB/18dB/  
24dB/30dB/36dB/42dB  
Battery  
Makes settings related  
to batteries.  
Info Before End  
5%/10%/15%...95%/  
100%  
Specifies a threshold value that  
triggers a “Battery Near End”  
warning when a BP-GL65/GL95  
battery pack is used.  
Info End  
0%/1%/2%/3%/4%/5% Specifies a threshold value that  
triggers a “Battery End” warning  
when a BP-GL65/GL95 battery  
pack is used.  
Menu List  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Battery  
Makes settings related  
to batteries.  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Sony Before End  
11.5V to 17V (0.1V step) Specifies a threshold value that  
triggers a “Battery Near End”  
warning when a BP-L60S/L80S  
battery pack is used.  
Sony End  
11.0V to 11.5V (0.1V  
step)  
Specifies a threshold value that  
triggers a “Battery End” warning  
when a BP-L60S/L80S battery pack  
is used.  
Other Before End  
Other End  
11.5V to 11.8V to 17.0V Specifies a threshold value that  
(0.1V step)  
triggers a “Battery Near End”  
warning when a non-Sony battery  
pack is used.  
11.0V to 14.0V (0.1V  
step)  
Specifies a threshold value that  
triggers a “Battery End” warning  
when a non-Sony battery pack is  
used.  
DC In Before End  
11.5V to 11.8V to 17.0V Specifies a threshold value that  
(0.1V step)  
triggers a “Battery Near End”  
warning when an external power  
source is connected to the DC IN  
connector.  
DC In End  
11.0V to 14.0V (0.1V  
step)  
Specifies a threshold value that  
triggers a “Battery End” warning  
when an external power source is  
connected to the DC IN connector.  
Detected Battery  
Type Detection  
Info/Sony/Other/DC IN Displays the results of automatic  
battery pack type detection.  
Auto/Other  
Auto: Detect the battery type  
automatically.  
Other: Fix battery type detection as  
“Other”.  
Segment No.10  
Segment No.9  
Segment No.8  
Segment No.7  
Segment No.6  
Segment No.5  
Segment No.4  
Segment No.3  
Segment No.2  
Segment No.1  
11.0V to 17.0V (0.1V  
step)  
Specify voltage threshold values  
that cause remaining capacity  
segments to go off in the display of  
remaining battery capacity (see  
page 32). (The segments go off  
below the specified value.)  
These values are used when the  
battery type has been found to be  
“Other”.  
11.0V to 16.0V to 17.0V  
(0.1V step)  
11.0V to 15.0V to 17.0V  
(0.1V step)  
11.0V to 14.0V to 17.0V  
(0.1V step)  
11.0V to 13.5V to 17.0V  
(0.1V step)  
11.0V to 13.0V to 17.0V  
(0.1V step)  
11.0V to 12.5V to 17.0V  
(0.1V step)  
11.0V to 12.0V to 17.0V  
(0.1V step)  
11.0V to 11.5V to 17.0V  
(0.1V step)  
11.0V to 17.0V (0.1V  
step)  
Menu List  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Audio  
Makes settings related  
to audio.  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Front MIC Select  
Mono/Stereo  
Selects whether the front  
microphone is monaural (Mono) or  
stereo (Stereo).  
Audio CH3/4 Mode Ch1/2 / Switch  
Selects the input signals for the  
AUDIO IN CH-3/CH-4 connectors.  
Ch1/2: The same signals as the  
AUDIO IN CH-1/ CH-2  
connectors.  
Switch: The signals selected with  
the AUDIO IN CH3/CH4  
switches.  
Rear XLR Auto  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the XLR connection  
automatic detection (for the AUDIO  
IN CH-1/CH-2 connectors on the  
rear panel).  
Front MIC CH1 Ref –70dB/–60dB/–50dB/  
–40dB/–30dB/–20dB  
Selects the reference level for  
channel 1 of the front microphone.  
Selects the reference level for  
channel 2 of the front microphone.  
Selects the reference input level  
when the setting of the AUDIO IN  
CH1 switch is MIC.  
Front MIC CH2 Ref –70dB/–60dB/–50dB/  
–40dB/–30dB/–20dB  
Rear MIC CH1 Ref –70dB/–60dB/–50dB/  
–40dB/–30dB/–20dB  
Rear MIC CH2 Ref –70dB/–60dB/–50dB/  
Selects the reference input level  
when the setting of the AUDIO IN  
CH2 switch is MIC.  
–40dB/–30dB/–20dB  
Line Input Ref  
+4dB/0dB/–3dB/EBUL Selects the reference input level  
when the AUDIO IN CH1 and  
AUDIO IN CH2 switches are set to  
LINE.  
Min Alarm Volume Off/Set  
Selects the volume when the  
ALARM knob is turned all the way  
down.  
Off: Almost inaudible  
Set: Fairly audible  
Speaker Attenuate  
Off/3dB/6dB/9dB/12dB Selects the volume from the monitor  
speakers (does not affect earphone  
volume).  
Headphone Out  
Reference Level  
Reference Out  
Mono/Stereo  
Selects whether the earphones are  
monaural (Mono) or stereo (Stereo).  
Selects the output level of the 1 kHz  
test signal.  
–20dB/–18dB/–16dB/  
–12dB/EBUL  
0dB/+4dB/–3dB/EBUL Specifies the output level with  
respect to the reference input level.  
CH1&2 AGC Mode Mono/Stereo  
For automatic adjustment of the  
input level of analog audio signals  
recorded on channels 1 and 2,  
specifies whether to make the  
adjustments separately for each  
channel (Mono) or in stereo mode  
(Stereo).  
Menu List  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Audio  
Makes settings related  
to audio.  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
CH3&4 AGC Mode Mono/Stereo  
For automatic adjustment of the  
input level of analog audio signals  
recorded on channels 3 and 4,  
specifies whether to make the  
adjustments separately for each  
channel (Mono) or in stereo mode  
(Stereo).  
AGC Spec  
–6dB/–9dB/–12dB/  
–15dB/–17dB  
Off/–6dB/–9dB/–12dB/ For manual audio level adjustments,  
Selects the AGC saturation level.  
Limiter Mode  
–15dB/–17dB  
selects the saturation level for the  
limiter applied to loud input signals.  
Select Off if you do not wish to use  
the limiter.  
Output Limiter  
On/Off  
Turns the audio output limiter on or  
off.  
CH1 Wind Filter  
CH2 Wind Filter  
CH3 Wind Filter  
CH4 Wind Filter  
Audio SG (1KHz)  
On/Off  
Turns the channel 1 wind filter on or  
off.  
On/Off  
Turns the channel 2 wind filter on or  
off.  
On/Off  
Turns the channel 3 wind filter on or  
off.  
On/Off  
Turns the channel 4 wind filter on or  
off.  
On/Off/Auto  
Selects whether to output (On) or  
not output (Off) a 1 kHz test signal  
in color bar mode.  
Auto: Output a test signal only  
when the AUDIO SELECT  
CH1 switch is set to AUTO.  
MIC CH1 Level  
Side1/Front/Front+Side1 For recording input audio from the  
front microphone on channel 1,  
selects the knob that adjusts the  
audio level.  
Side1: The LEVEL knob (left) on  
the side panel  
Front: The MIC LEVEL control on  
the front panel  
Front+Side1: Adjust with both the  
LEVEL knob (left) and the  
MIC LEVEL control.  
MIC CH2 Level  
Side2/Front/Front+Side2 For recording input audio from the  
front microphone on channel 2,  
selects the knob that adjusts the  
audio level.  
Side2: The LEVEL knob (right) on  
the side panel  
Front: The MIC LEVEL control on  
the front panel  
Front+Side2: Adjust with both the  
LEVEL knob (right) and the  
MIC LEVEL control.  
Menu List  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Audio  
Makes settings related  
to audio.  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Rear1/WRR Level  
Side1/Front/Front+Side1 Selects the knob that adjusts the  
audio levels of a wireless  
microphone and a device connected  
to the AUDIO IN CH-1 connector  
on the rear panel.  
Side1: The LEVEL knob (left) on  
the side panel  
Front: The MIC LEVEL control on  
the front panel  
Front+Side1: Adjust with both the  
LEVEL knob (left) and the  
MIC LEVEL control.  
Rear2/WRR Level  
Side2/Front/Front+Side2 Selects the knob that adjusts the  
audio levels of a wireless  
microphone and a device connected  
to the AUDIO IN CH-2 connector  
on the rear panel.  
Side2: The LEVEL knob (right) on  
the side panel  
Front: The MIC LEVEL control on  
the front panel  
Front+Side2: Adjust with both the  
LEVEL knob (right) and the  
MIC LEVEL control.  
Audio CH3 Level  
Side3/Front/Front+Side3 Selects the knob that adjusts the  
level of audio recorded on channel  
3.  
Side3: The LEVEL knob on side  
panel  
Front: The MIC LEVEL control on  
the front panel  
Front+Side3: Adjust with both the  
LEVEL knob and the MIC  
LEVEL control.  
Audio CH4 Level  
Side4/Front/Front+Side4 Selects the knob that adjusts the  
level of audio recorded on channel  
4.  
Side4: The LEVEL knob on side  
panel  
Front: The MIC LEVEL control on  
the front panel  
Front+Side4: Adjust with both the  
LEVEL knob and the MIC  
LEVEL control.  
Menu List  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
WRR Setting  
Makes settings related  
to the wireless tuner.  
WRR Valid CH Sel All/CH1  
Selects whether to enable channels 1  
and 2 of the wireless receiver (All)  
or channel 1 only (CH1).  
WRR CH Select  
TX1/TX2  
Specifies the target channel for other  
sub-items.  
TX1: Channel 1  
TX2: Channel 2  
WRR Delay Comp On/Off  
Enables (On) or disables (Off) delay  
compensation for wireless audio  
input. (When On is selected, the  
audio in all E-E output is delayed by  
about 8 ms.)  
TX  
---  
Displays the name of the transmitter  
whose signals are being received on  
the channel selected by WRR CH  
SELECT.  
TX Audio Peak  
TX Input Level  
---/Peak  
---/Mic/Line  
Displays whether the AF level of the  
transmitter whose signals are being  
received on the channel selected by  
WRR CH SELECT are over peak.  
Displays whether the input level of  
the transmitter whose signals are  
being received on the channel  
selected by WRR CH SELECT is  
set to microphone (Mic) or line  
(Line).  
TX ATT Level  
---  
Sets the ATT level of the transmitter  
whose signals are being received on  
the channel selected by WRR CH  
SELECT. (The setting range varies  
depending on the transmitter.)  
Sets the low cut filter frequency of  
the transmitter whose signals are  
being received on the channel  
selected by WRR CH SELECT.  
(The setting range varies depending  
on the transmitter.)  
TX LCF Frequency ---  
TX System Delay  
Auto/0.0ms to 8.0ms  
Specifies the amount of audio delay.  
Auto: Automatically adjusts the  
amount of delay so that the  
delay in the audio received  
from the wireless transmitter is  
zero.  
0.0ms to 8.0ms: Sets the amount of  
anticipated wireless system  
delay, for cases in which  
several wireless systems are  
being used over a devices such  
as an audio mixer.  
Menu List  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Timecode  
Makes settings related  
to timecode.  
TC Out  
Auto/Generator  
Selects the source for timecode  
output.  
Auto: During recording, output  
values generated by the  
timecode generator, and during  
playback output values  
obtained by the timecode  
reader.  
Generator: Output values  
generated by the timecode  
generator during both recording  
and playback.  
DF/NDF  
DF/NDF  
When the Country setting is other  
than [PAL Area], selects drop-frame  
mode (DF) or non-drop-frame mode  
(NDF).  
LTC UBIT  
Fix/Time  
Specifies the data recorded in LTC  
user bits.  
Fix: Record user-specified data.  
Time: Record the current time.  
Select the method used to reset the  
counter value displayed on the  
viewfinder screen.  
Counter Display  
Counter/Duration  
Counter: Continue to increment  
until the RESET button is  
pressed.  
Duration: Reset each time that  
recording is started.  
Essence Mark  
Ret Shot Mark 1  
Ret Shot Mark 2  
On/Off  
Specify whether to input Shot  
Mark1 marks using the RET button  
on the lens.  
Makes settings related  
to shot marks and clip  
index picture  
On/Off  
Specify whether to input Shot  
Mark2 marks using the RET button  
on the lens.  
thumbnails.  
Index Pic Pos  
Find Mode  
0sec to 10sec (in 1 sec  
steps)  
Specifies which frame to use as the  
clip thumbnail image  
Clip/Rec Start  
Specify the frame to be cued up  
when the PREV or NEXT button is  
pressed.  
Rec Start: The next frame or the  
previous frame where a Rec  
Start essence mark is set.  
Clip: Pressing the NEXT button  
moves to the start frame of the  
next clip. Pressing the PREV  
button moves to the start frame  
of the current clip. (Pressing the  
PREV button at the start frame  
of the current clip moves to the  
start frame of the previous  
clip.)  
Menu List  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Camera Config  
Rec Tally Blink  
On/Off  
Turns warning flashes by the  
TALLY indicator on or off. The  
warnings alert you an almost  
exhausted battery pack or low  
remaining media capacity.  
Selects the recording review time.  
Clip: Review all of the most  
recently recorded clip.  
Makes settings related  
to various camcorder  
operations.  
Rec Review  
3sec/10sec/Clip  
HD SDI Remote I/F Off/Chara/G-Tally/  
Selects whether to use the function  
that enables recording control from  
this camcorder of an external device  
connected to the HD/SD SDI OUT  
connector (HDSDI output). When  
the function is used, also selects the  
indication that shows whether the  
external device is recording.  
Off: Do not use the remote  
recording control function.  
Chara: Indicate by the external  
device control indication on the  
viewfinder screen.  
R-Tally  
G-Tally: Indicate by the green tally  
indicator in the HDVF series  
viewfinder or green tally  
indicator on the screen of the  
CBK-VF01 viewfinder.  
R-Tally: Indicate by the recording/  
red tally indicators in the  
HDVF series viewfinder or the  
special recording mode/  
operation status indication on  
the screen of the CBK-VF01  
viewfinder.  
Color Bars Select  
User Menu Only  
ARIB/100%/75%/  
SMPTE  
Selects the color bar type.  
On/Off  
Selects whether to display the  
USER menu only (On) or display  
the menu list (Off) when the  
camcorder enters the menu mode.  
Selects whether to share (On) or not  
share (Off) settings between times  
when a remote control unit is  
connected and times when the  
camcorder is used locally.  
RM Common  
Memory  
On/Off  
Note  
When a remote control unit is  
connected, this setting is disabled.  
Menu List  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Camera Config  
RM Rec Start  
RM/CAM/PARA  
For times when a remote control  
unit is connected, selects whether  
recording start/stop buttons are  
enabled on the camcorder or the  
remote control unit.  
Makes settings related  
to various camcorder  
operations.  
RM: Remote control unit  
CAM: Camcorder  
PARA: Both  
Preset White  
Color Temp<P>  
1500K to 3200K to  
50000K  
Specifies the white balance preset  
value.  
Makes settings related  
to white balance preset  
values.  
Color Temp  
Balance<P>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies finer color temperature  
settings, for use when satisfactory  
video cannot be obtained with Color  
Temp<P>.  
R Gain <P>  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
On/Off  
Specifies the R gain preset value.  
Specifies the B gain preset value.  
Turns on and off execution of the  
AWB (auto white balance) function  
when the WHITE BAL switch is set  
to PRST.  
B Gain <P>  
AWB Enable <P>  
White Filter  
Makes settings related  
to filters.  
ND Filter  
C.Temp  
On/Off  
Turns the function that assigns  
electrical CC filters to ND filters on  
or off.  
ND FLT  
C.Temp<1>  
3200K/4300K/5600K/  
6300K  
Selects the color temperature for  
when electrical CC filters are  
assigned to ND filters.  
ND FLT  
C.Temp<2-4>  
3200K/4300K/5600K/  
6300K  
Selects the color temperature for  
when electrical CC filters are  
assigned to ND filters.  
Electrical  
CC<A>  
3200K/4300K/5600K/  
6300K  
Selects the color temperature for  
when the electrical CC filter  
switching function is assigned to an  
assignable switch.  
Electrical  
CC<B>  
3200K/4300K/5600K/  
6300K  
Selects the color temperature for  
when the electrical CC filter  
switching function is assigned to an  
assignable switch.  
Electrical  
CC<C>  
3200K/4300K/5600K/  
6300K/-----  
Selects the color temperature for  
when the electrical CC filter  
switching function is assigned to an  
assignable switch.  
Select “----” if you do not want to  
use C.  
Electrical  
CC<D>  
3200K/4300K/5600K/  
6300K/-----  
Selects the color temperature for  
when the electrical CC filter  
switching function is assigned to an  
assignable switch.  
Select “----” if you do not want to  
use D.  
Menu List  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
DCC Adjust  
DCC Function Select DCC/Fix  
Enables or disables automatic knee  
point adjustment when the  
OUTPUT/DCC switch is set to  
CAM, DCC: ON.  
Makes settings related  
to DCC (dynamic  
contrast control).  
DCC: Automatically adjust the  
knee point according to the  
luminance of the subject.  
Fix: Set the knee point to a fixed  
value.  
DCC D Range  
400%/450%/500%/  
550%/600%  
Specifies the dynamic range when  
the OUTPUT/DCC switch is set to  
CAM, DCC: ON.  
DCC Point  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Adjusts the DCC minimum knee  
point.  
DCC Gain  
Specifies gain with respect to the  
DCC detected value.  
DCC Delay Time  
Specifies the DCC control speed  
(speed of reaction to changes in the  
video).  
DCC Peak Filter  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Adjusts response sensitivity with  
respect to peaks in DCC detected  
values.  
Menu List  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Auto Iris2  
Makes settings related  
to auto iris.  
Iris Window  
1/2/3/4/5/6/Var  
Selects the type of iris detection  
window.  
Var: Variable  
Iris Window Ind  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the function that  
displays a frame marker for the auto  
iris detection window.  
Iris Level  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Adjusts the level of the auto iris  
target value.  
Iris APL Ratio  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Adjusts the mix ratio of auto iris  
detection peak value and average  
value (available when OPERATION  
>TLCS >Mode is set to [Standard]).  
Adjusts the width of the detection  
window when the setting of Iris  
Window is VAR.  
Iris Var Width  
Iris Var Height  
Iris Var H Position  
Iris Var V Position  
Iris Speed  
40 to 500 to 999  
70 to 500 to 999  
–479 to 0 to +479  
–464 to 0 to +464  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Adjusts the height of the detection  
window when the setting of Iris  
Window is VAR.  
Specifies the horizontal position of  
the detection window when the  
setting of Iris Window is VAR.  
Specifies the vertical position of the  
detection window when the setting  
of Iris Window is VAR.  
Specifies the control speed (speed of  
reaction to changes in the video).  
(Larger values specify quicker  
reaction times.)  
Clip High Light  
On/Off  
Turns on or off the function that  
disregards highlights and forces a  
flatter reaction to high luminance.  
Genlock  
Makes settings related  
to genlock.  
Genlock  
On/Off  
Turns the genlock function on or off.  
Specifies the H phase of HD output  
when genlock is enabled.  
H Phase(HD)  
–999 to 0 to +999  
H Phase(SD)  
Reference  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Specifies the H phase of SD output  
when genlock is enabled.  
Internal/Genlock  
Displays the type of reference signal  
used by the camcorder.  
Menu List  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
ND Comp  
ND Offset Adjust  
On/Off  
ND filter color compensation  
function.  
Makes settings related  
to ND filter color  
compensation.  
Clear ND Offset  
Execute/Cancel  
Clears ND filter color compensation  
values (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
Although the  
differences are very  
slight, each of the built-  
in ND filters has  
different color  
characteristics. When  
you switch between ND  
filters, the white  
balance may be  
disturbed. You can  
correct for these slight  
color differences  
automatically by  
registering  
compensation values  
for each filter.  
Lens  
Executes auto flange  
back adjustment.  
Auto FB Adjust  
Execute/Cancel  
Executes auto flange back  
adjustment, only for supported  
lenses (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
Auto Shading  
Executes auto black  
shading compensation.  
Auto Black Shading Execute/Cancel  
Reset Black Shading Execute/Cancel  
Executes auto shading  
compensation (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
Clears black shading compensation  
values (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
Master Gain (TMP) –6dB/–3dB/0dB/3dB/  
6dB/9dB/12dB/18dB/  
Specifies a temporary master gain  
value. (The value is the same as the  
24dB/30dB/36dB/42dB value selected with the GAIN  
switch.)  
APR  
APR(SLS)  
APR Preset  
Execute/Cancel  
Suppresses white flecks in SLS  
mode by executing the automatic  
pixel noise reduction function  
(execute by selecting Execute).  
Deletes white flecks data that was  
added by execution of the APR and  
automatic black balance adjustment  
functions (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
Execute/Cancel  
Trigger Mode  
i.LINK Trigger  
Mode  
Internal/Both/External  
Select Internal when recording start  
and stop operations target SxS  
memory cards only. Select External  
when they target only devices  
connected to the i.LINK (HDV/DV)  
or HD/SD SDI OUT connectors.  
Select Both when they target both  
memory cards and external devices.  
Makes settings related  
to triggers for starting  
and stopping recording.  
Menu List  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
b)  
Network Setting  
Makes settings for  
network connection.  
DHCP  
Enable/Disable  
Selects whether to acquire the IP  
address automatically from a DHCP  
server (Enable) or not (Disable).  
When DHCP is set to [Disable], sets  
the IP address.  
IP Address  
0.0.0.0 to  
Notes  
255.255.255.255  
(192.168.1.10)  
0.0.0.0 to  
• The CBK-WA01  
Wi-Fi Adapter is  
required.  
Subnet Mask  
Default Gateway  
User Name  
Password  
When DHCP is set to [Disable], sets  
the subnet mask.  
255.255.255.255  
• This item is  
0.0.0.0 to  
255.255.255.255  
admin  
When DHCP is set to [Disable], sets  
the default gateway.  
disabled (displayed  
in grey) during  
recording and play.  
Sets a desired user name in 1 to 31  
alphanumeric characters.  
For details on  
network connection,  
refer to the  
Supplement supplied  
in the CD-ROM  
(labeledManualsfor  
Solid-State Memory  
Camcorder”).  
pmw-500 (model name) Sets a password (model name) in 0  
to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
Set  
Execute/Cancel  
Confirms the settings in Network  
Settings (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
MAC Address  
Displays the MAC address.  
Resets the settings in Network  
Settings to the preset values  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
When Wi-Fi is set to [Enable], scan  
the available network connection.  
Sets the network connection name  
of up to 32 characters.  
Net Config Reset  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
b)  
Wi-Fi Setting  
Scan Networks  
SSID  
Makes settings for  
Wi-Fi connection.  
Network connection  
name  
Notes  
Network Type  
Infra/Adhoc  
Selects the connection mode.  
Infra: Infrastructure mode  
Adhoc: Ad hoc mode  
• The CBK-WA01  
Wi-Fi Adapter is  
required.  
Ch  
1 to 11  
When Network Type is set to  
[Adhoc], set the wireless channel.  
Selects the network authentication.  
OPEN: Open system authentication  
SHARED: Shared key  
• This item is  
disabled (displayed  
in grey) during  
recording and play.  
Authentication  
Open/Shared/WPA/  
WPA2  
For details on Wi-Fi  
connection, refer to  
the Supplement  
supplied in the CD-  
ROM (labeled  
authentication  
WPA: WPA (Wi-Fi Protected  
Access) authentication  
WPA2: WPA2 (Wi-Fi Protected  
Access 2) authentication  
“Manuals for Solid-  
State Memory  
Camcorder”).  
Menu List  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
b)  
Wi-Fi Setting  
Makes settings for  
Wi-Fi connection.  
Encryption  
Disable/WEP/TKIP/AES Selects whether to apply data  
encryption and the type of data  
encryption.  
Disable: Do not apply data  
encryption.  
Notes  
• The CBK-WA01  
Wi-Fi Adapter is  
required.  
WEP: Apply WEP (Wired  
Equivalent Privacy) when  
Authentication is set to [Open]  
or [Shared]  
• This item is  
disabled (displayed  
in grey) during  
recording and play.  
TKIP: Apply TKIP (Temporal Key  
Integrity Protocol) when  
Authentication is set to [WPA]  
or [WPA2]  
AES: Apply AES (Advanced  
Encryption Standard) when  
Authentication is set to [WPA]  
or [WPA2]  
For details on Wi-Fi  
connection, refer to  
the Supplement  
supplied in the CD-  
ROM (labeled  
WEP Key Index  
Input Select  
1/2/3/4  
When Encryption is [WEP], selects  
the key index.  
“Manuals for Solid-  
State Memory  
Camcorder”).  
When Encryption is set to Selects the input format depending  
[WEP]: ASCII5,  
ASCII13, HEX10,  
HEX26  
on the network key (or security key).  
ASCII5: Five characters ASCII  
format  
When Encryption is set to ASCII13: 13 characters ASCII  
[TKIP] or [AES]: format  
ASCII8-63, HEX64 HEX10: 10 hexadecimal digits  
HEX26: 26 hexadecimal digits  
ASCII8-63: 8 to 63 characters  
ASCII 8-bit format  
HEX64: 64 hexadecimal digits  
(characters)  
Key  
Set  
Sets the network key (or security  
key).  
Enables settings for Wi-Fi Setting  
when Wi-Fi is set to [Enable]  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Wi-Fi Status  
xxxxx  
Connecting  
Displays “Connecting” while  
connection is being attempted.  
Displays black squares to show the  
connection status by the number of  
squares when the camcorder is  
connected to a computer or a LAN.  
Wireless Mode  
Wi-Fi  
802.11b/802.11g/802.11n Displays an IEEE802.11 standard.  
Enable/Disable  
Selects whether to enable or disable  
Wi-Fi connection.  
Menu List  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MAINTENANCE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Date/Time  
12H/24H  
Settings  
Description  
Clock Set  
Sets the internal clock.  
Sets the current date and time.  
Selects the 12-hour format (12H) or  
the 24-hour format (24H) for  
display of times.  
12H/24H  
Date Mode  
Language  
YYMMDD/MMDDYY/ Selects the display format for dates.  
DDMMYY  
YYMMDD: Year, Month, Day  
MMDDYY: Month, Day, Year  
DDMMYY: Day, Month Year  
Selects the language for messages  
from English or Chinese.  
Language  
Selects the language for  
messages.  
English/Chinese  
Hours Meter  
Hours(Sys)  
Hours(Reset)  
Reset  
Displays the cumulative hours of  
use (cannot be reset).  
Makes settings related  
to the digital hours  
meter.  
Displays the hours of use (can be  
reset).  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Resets Hours(Reset) to 0.  
(Execute by selecting Execute.)  
Displays the software version of the  
camcorder (Vx.xx).  
Version  
Displays the version of  
the camcorder, and  
Version  
a)  
CBK-HD02  
Version Up  
Displays the software version of the  
CBK-HD02 (Vx.xx).  
updates the camcorder.  
Updates the camcorder (execute by  
selecting Execute).  
Note  
This cannot be selected unless an SxS  
memory card is inserted.  
a) When the optional CBK-HD02 is installed  
b) When the optional CBK-UPG01 is installed  
Menu List  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FILE Menu  
Settings in bold are the factory default values.  
FILE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
User  
Makes settings for  
operating user files.  
User Load SxS  
Execute/Cancel  
Loads a user file from an SxS  
memory card (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
When Load Customize Data is set  
to [Off]: Replace the current  
USER menu settings with  
settings stored in the loaded use  
file (with the original menu  
configuration unchanged).  
When Load Customize Data is set  
to [On]: Replace the current  
USER menu configuration and  
settings with those stored in the  
loaded use file.  
When User Load White is set to  
[Off]: Load a user file  
excluding white balance data.  
User Load White is set to [On]:  
Load a user file including white  
balance data.  
User Save SxS  
Execute/Cancel  
Stores the current USER menu  
configuration and settings including  
the white balance data to an SxS  
memory card as a user file (execute  
by selecting [Execute]).  
User Load USB (in UDF mode only)  
User Save USB (in UDF mode only)  
Loads a user file from a USB flash  
drive (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Stores the current USER menu  
configuration and settings including  
the white balance data to a USB  
flash drive as a user file (execute by  
selecting [Execute]).  
File ID  
Assigns a name to a file. Names can  
be up to 16 characters in length.  
Returns the current USER menu  
settings to the preset values (execute  
by selecting [Execute]).  
Recall User Preset  
Store User Preset  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Stores the USER menu as a user file  
in which all menu settings are reset  
to the preset values (execute by  
selecting [Execute]).  
Clear User Preset  
Execute/Cancel  
Returns the current USER menu  
settings to the factory default  
settings (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Menu List  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
FILE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Load Customize  
Data  
Settings  
Description  
User  
Makes settings for  
operating user files.  
Off/On  
Selects whether to load both menu  
configuration and settings (On) or  
load only menu settings (Off) white  
balance data when loading a user  
file.  
User  
Load White Data  
Display Mode  
All Load(SxS)  
All Save(SxS)  
Off/On  
Selects whether to load (On) or not  
load (Off) white balance data when  
loading a user file.  
Makes settings for  
operating user files.  
All  
Makes settings related  
to ALL file operations.  
Date&Time/Model  
Name  
Selects the items to be displayed in  
the list box that appears when a file  
is saved or loaded.  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Loads an ALL file from an SxS  
memory card (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
Stores an ALL file to an SxS  
memory card (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
All Load(USB)  
(in UDF mode only)  
Loads an ALL file from a USB flash  
drive (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
All Save(USB)  
(in UDF mode only)  
Stores an ALL file to a USB flash  
drive (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
File ID  
Assigns a name to a file. Names can  
be up to 16 characters in length.  
Returns all items to their preset  
values (execute by selecting  
Execute).  
All Preset  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Store All Preset  
Stores the current settings of all  
items as the preset values (execute  
by selecting [Execute]).  
Clear All Preset  
3Sec Clr Preset  
Execute/Cancel  
Clears the preset values of all items  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Turns on or off the function that  
clears each preset value when the  
MENU CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE  
switch is pushed up and held for  
three seconds on the CANCEL/  
PRST side.  
On/Off  
Network Data  
Off/On  
Selects whether to load (On) or not  
load (Off) network settings when  
loading an ALL file.  
Menu List  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FILE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
s1  
Settings  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Standard  
Description  
Scene  
Makes settings related  
to scene file operations.  
File number and file ID  
s2  
File number and file ID  
s3  
File number and file ID  
s4  
File number and file ID  
s5  
File number and file ID  
sStandard  
Display Mode  
Standard settings  
Date&Time/Model  
Name  
Selects the items to be displayed in  
the list box that appears when a file  
is saved or loaded.  
Scene Recall Mem  
Scene Store Mem  
Scene Recall SxS  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Loads a file from internal memory  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Stores a file in internal memory  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Loads a file from an SxS memory  
card (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Scene Store SxS  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Stores a file to an SxS memory card  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Loads a file from a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Stores a file to a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Assigns a name to a file. Names can  
be up to 16 characters in length.  
Scene Recall USB  
(in UDF mode only)  
Scene Store USB  
(in UDF mode only)  
File ID  
Reference  
Reference Store  
Execute/Cancel  
Stores the current settings of  
reference file items in the reference  
file that is maintained in internal  
memory (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Makes settings related  
to reference file  
operations.  
Reference Clear  
Refer Load(SxS)  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Clear the reference file (execute by  
selecting [Execute]).  
Load a reference file from an SxS  
memory card (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Refer Save(SxS)  
Execute/Cancel  
Store a reference file to an SxS  
memory card (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Refer Load(USB)  
(in UDF mode only)  
Refer Store(USB)  
(in UDF mode only)  
File ID  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Loads a file from a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Stores a file to a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Assigns a name to a file. Names can  
be up to 16 characters in length.  
Selects whether to load (On) or not  
load (Off) white balance data when  
Scene >Scene Recall or Scene  
>Standard is executed.  
Scene White Data  
On/Off  
Menu List  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FILE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Lens  
Display Mode  
Date&Time/Model  
Name  
Selects the items to be displayed in  
the list box that appears when a file  
is saved or loaded.  
Makes settings related  
to lens file operations.  
Lens Recall Mem  
Lens Store Mem  
Lens Recall SxS  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Loads a file from internal memory  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Stores a file in internal memory  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Loads a file from an SxS memory  
card (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Lens Store SxS  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Execute/Cancel  
Stores a file to an SxS memory card  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Loads a file from a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Stores a file to a USB flash drive  
(execute by selecting [Execute]).  
Assigns a name to the most recently  
loaded file. Names can be up to 16  
characters in length.  
Lens Recall USB  
(in UDF mode only)  
Lens Store USB  
(in UDF mode only)  
File ID  
Source  
Displays the number of the selected  
file.  
Lens No Offset  
Lens Auto Recall  
Execute/Cancel  
Clears a file (execute by selecting  
[Execute]).  
Off/On/Serial Number  
When the installed lens supports  
serial communication, specifies  
whether to automatically load that  
reference file.  
Off: Do not use this function.  
On: Load the reference for the  
model name and reflect the  
contents of the file.  
Serial Number: For lenses that  
support serial number  
communication, load the lens  
file that corresponds to the  
serial number and model name,  
and reflect the contents of that  
file. For lenses that do not  
support serial number  
communication, load the  
reference for the model name  
(in the same way as when On is  
selected).  
Serial Number  
Lens ID  
Displays the serial number of the  
installed lens (only for lenses that  
support serial communication).  
Displays the model name of the  
installed lens (only for lenses that  
support serial communication).  
Menu List  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
FILE  
Menu items  
Sub-item  
Settings  
Description  
Lens  
L Manufacturer  
Displays the name of the  
manufacturer of the installed lens  
(only for lenses that support serial  
communication).  
Makes settings related  
to lens file operations.  
M V Modulation  
Lens Center H  
Lens Center V  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–40 to 0 to 40  
–40 to 0 to 40  
Sets a vertical SAW shading  
compensation value in the lens file.  
Sets a center marker horizontal  
position in the lens file.  
Sets a center marker vertical  
position in the lens file.  
Lens R Flare  
Lens G Flare  
Lens B Flare  
Lens W-R Offset  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Sets a R flare level in the lens file.  
Sets a G flare level in the lens file.  
Sets a B flare level in the lens file.  
Sets a R white balance  
compensation value in the lens file.  
Sets a B white balance  
compensation value in the lens file.  
Selects the white shading  
compensation target.  
Lens W-B Offset  
Shading Ch Sel  
L R/G/B H Saw  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Red/Green/Blue  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Sets a horizontal SAW white  
shading compensation value in the  
lens file.  
L R/G/B H Para  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Sets a horizontal parabola white  
shading compensation value in the  
lens file.  
L R/G/B V Saw  
L R/G/B V Para  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Sets a vertical SAW white shading  
compensation value in the lens file.  
Sets a vertical parabola white  
shading compensation value in the  
lens file.  
–99 to 0 to +99  
Menu List  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Assigning Functions to Assignable Switches  
Using the Assignable SW item of the OPERATION menu, you can assign user-specified functions to the  
ASSIGN. 0 to 3 switches, the ASSIGNABLE 4 and 5 switches, the COLOR TEMP. button, and the RET  
button on the lens.  
The following tables lists the functions that are assigned when the camcorder is shipped from the factory.  
Switch or button  
ASSIGN. 0 switch  
ASSIGN. 1 switch  
ASSIGN. 2 switch  
ASSIGN. 3 switch  
ASSIGNABLE 4 switch  
ASSIGNABLE 5 switch  
RET button  
Function  
Assignable SW setting  
No assignment  
No assignment  
No assignment  
No assignment  
No assignment  
No assignment  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
During recording or playback: Write a shot mark. Lens RET  
In the other states: Conduct a recording review  
(if playback is allowed).  
COLOR TEMP. button  
Adjust the white balance with the preset white  
balance value of 5600K.  
Color Temp SW 5600K  
Functions That Can Be Assigned to the ASSIGN. 0 Switch  
Assignable switch setting Function  
State when camcorder  
is next powered on  
Off  
No assignment  
Marker  
ATW Hold  
Turn the display of all markers on or off.  
Setting retained  
Hold the white balance setting in the ATW (auto-tracking —  
white balance) mode  
Picture Cache  
Freeze Mix  
Focus Mag  
Zebra  
Turn the picture cache function on or off.  
Execute the freeze mix function.  
Turn the focus magnification function on or off.  
Turn zebra display on or off.  
Write Shot Mark1.  
Setting retained  
Setting not retained  
Setting not retained  
Shot Mark1  
Shot Mark2  
OK Mark  
Write Shot Mark2.  
Add or delete an OK mark.  
Clip Flag OK  
Add/clear an OK mark to/from the clip being recorded or Setting not retained  
played.  
Clip Flag NG  
Add/clear an NG mark to/from the clip being recorded or Setting not retained  
played.  
Clip Flag Keep  
Add/clear a KP mark to/from the clip being recorded or Setting not retained  
played.  
Assigning Functions to Assignable Switches  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Functions That Can Be Assigned to the ASSIGN. 2 Switch  
Note  
Immediately after you assign a function to the ASSIGN. 2 switch or you switch the recording format, the setting of the  
switch at that point may not match the camcorder’s internal state. After assigning a function, switch the ASSIGN. 2  
switch or power the camcorder off and on again.  
Assignable switch setting Function  
Off  
No assignment  
Front Mic  
Marker  
Switch between stereo and monaural when a stereo microphone is connected.  
Turn the display of all markers on or off.  
Turn the picture cache function on or off.  
Turn zebra display on or off.  
a)  
Picture Cache  
Zebra  
Clip Continuous Rec  
Digital Extender  
Turn the Clip Continuous Rec mode on or off.  
Turn the screen magnification function on or off when the optional CBK-HD02  
SDI/COMPOSITE Input and 50 Pin Interface is installed.  
Rec Source  
Switch the signals to be recorded between the camera picture and external input  
when the optional CBK-HD02 SDI/COMPOSITE Input and 50 Pin Interface is  
installed. (if the unit is currently conducting recording or play, the switch takes  
effect after the recording or playback ends.)  
Note  
a) When Picture Cache is assigned, OPERATION >Rec  
Function in the setup menu is disabled (displayed in  
grey) to keep the setting unchanged.  
Functions That Can Be Assigned to the ASSIGN. 1 and 3 Switches, the  
ASSIGNABLE 4 and 5 Switches, and the COLOR TEMP. Button  
Assignable switch setting Function  
State when camcorder  
is next powered on  
Off  
No assignment  
Front Mic  
Switch between stereo (On) and monaural (Off) when a Setting retained  
stereo microphone is connected.  
Marker  
Turn the display of all markers on or off.  
Delete the most recently recorded clip.  
Setting retained  
Last Clip Delete  
ATW  
Turn ATW (auto tracing white balance) mode on or off. Setting not retained  
ATW Hold  
EZ Mode  
Hold the white balance setting in the ATW mode.  
Execute EZ mode according to the setting of  
OPERATION >TLCS.  
Setting retained  
Turbo Gain  
Execute Turbo Gain according to the setting of  
OPERATION >Gain Switch >Gain Turbo.  
Setting not retained  
Rec Review  
Rec  
Conduct a recording review.  
Start or stop recording.  
Picture Cache  
Freeze Mix  
Spotlight  
Turn the picture cache function on or off.  
Execute the freeze mix function.  
Setting retained  
Setting not retained  
Setting retained  
Turn the spotlight function in auto iris mode on or off.  
Assigning Functions to Assignable Switches  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
156  
         
Assignable switch setting Function  
State when camcorder  
is next powered on  
Backlight  
Turn the backlight function in auto iris mode on or off. Setting retained  
EVF Mode  
Switch the viewfinder screen between B&W (On) and  
color (Off).  
Setting retained  
BRT Disp  
Histogram  
Lens Info  
Turn the display of the brightness level on or off.  
Turn the histogram display on or off.  
Setting retained  
Setting retained  
Setting retained  
Switch the depth of field indication between off,  
displayed in meters, and displayed in feet.  
Zoom Tele/Wide  
When a lens that supports serial communication is  
installed, assign the Zoom Tele function to  
ASSIGNABLE 4, and assign the Zoom Wide function to  
ASSIGNABLE 5 (displayed only when <4> and <5> are  
set).  
Zoom Wide/Tele  
When a lens that supports serial communication is  
installed, assign the Zoom Wide function to  
ASSIGNABLE 4, and assign the Zoom Tele function to  
ASSIGNABLE 5 (displayed only when <4> and <5> are  
set).  
Manual Focus Assist  
Focus Mag  
Zebra  
Turn the manual focus assist function on or off.  
Turn the focus magnification function on or off.  
Turn zebra display on or off.  
Setting retained  
Setting not retained  
Setting not retained  
Lens RET  
Display return video signals when the optional CBK-  
HD02 is installed and a camera extension unit is  
connected.  
When a camera extension unit is not connected, function  
as follows.  
During recording or playback: Write a shot mark.  
In the other states: Conduct a recording review  
(if playback is allowed).  
Return Video  
Display return video signals when the optional CBK-  
HD02 is installed and a camera extension unit is  
connected.  
Shot Mark1  
Shot Mark2  
OK Mark  
Write Shot Mark1.  
Write Shot Mark2.  
Add or delete an OK mark.  
Clip Flag OK  
Add/Clear an OK mark to/from the clip being recorded Setting not retained  
or played.  
Clip Flag NG  
Add/Clear an NG mark to/from the clip being recorded Setting not retained  
or played.  
Clip Flag Keep  
Add/Clear a KP mark to/from the clip being recorded or Setting not retained  
played.  
Color Temp SW 3200K  
Color Temp SW 4300K  
Color Temp SW 5600K  
Color Temp SW 6300K  
Adjust the white balance with a 3200K preset value.  
Adjust the white balance with a 4300K preset value.  
Adjust the white balance with a 5600K preset value.  
Adjust the white balance with a 6300K preset value.  
Setting retained  
Setting retained  
Setting retained  
Setting retained  
Assigning Functions to Assignable Switches  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
157  
Assignable switch setting Function  
Electrical CC Function that switches the electrical CC filter (3200K/  
State when camcorder  
is next powered on  
Setting retained  
4300K/5600K/6300K) applied to white balance  
adjustment values.  
Each press of the switch or button switches in the order  
3200Kt4300Kt5600Kt6300K.  
These can also be applied from a menu (apply with  
Electrical CC<A><B><C><D>).  
Note  
This function is not available when Maintenance >White  
Filter >ND Filter C.Temp in the setup menu is set to On.  
If you set ND Filter C.Temp to On after assigning the  
function, the assignable switch ceases to function.  
CC5600K  
Apply a 5600K electrical CC filter to white balance  
adjustment values.  
Setting retained  
Clip Continuous Rec  
Digital Extender  
Turn the Clip Continuous Rec mode on or off.  
Setting not retained  
Setting not retained  
Turn the screen magnification function on or off when  
the optional CBK-HD02 SDI/COMPOSITE Input and 50  
Pin Interface is installed.  
Assigning Functions to Assignable Switches  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
158  
 
Functions That Can Be Assigned to the RET Button on the Lens  
Assignable switch setting Function  
State when camcorder  
is next powered on  
Off  
No assignment  
Lens RET  
Display return video signals when the optional CBK-  
HD02 is installed and a camera extension unit is  
connected.  
When a camera extension unit is not connected, function  
as follows.  
During recording or playback: Write a shot mark.  
In the other states: Conduct a recording review (if  
playback is allowed).  
Return Video  
Display return video signals when the optional CBK-  
HD02 is installed and a camera extension unit is  
connected.  
Rec Review  
Shot Mark1  
Shot Mark2  
Clip Flag OK  
Execute recording review.  
Write Shot Mark1.  
Write Shot Mark2.  
Add/Clear an OK mark to/from the clip being recorded or Setting not retained  
played.  
Clip Flag NG  
Add/Clear an NG mark to/from the clip being recorded or Setting not retained  
played.  
Clip Flag Keep  
Add/Clear a KP mark to/from the clip being recorded or Setting not retained  
played.  
OK Mark  
Add or delete an OK mark.  
Focus Mag  
Turn the focus magnification function on or off.  
Setting not retained  
Assigning Functions to Assignable Switches  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
159  
 
Chapter7 Saving and Loading User Setting Data  
files in the camcorder’s internal memory and  
up to 64 lens files on an SxS memory card or  
a USB flash drive (in UDF mode).  
Saving and Loading  
Settings  
The first settings stored in a file are called  
“preset” values.  
Even after loading files to set up the camcorder,  
and overwriting original files with new settings,  
You can save setup menu settings in the  
you can still recover preset values and reset files  
camcorder’s internal memory and on SxS  
to their initial states (see page 162).  
memory cards or USB flash drives (in UDF  
mode). This allows you to quickly recall an  
appropriate set of menu settings for the current  
Saving Setting Data  
situation.  
Setting data is saved in the following categories.  
User files: User files save customized USER  
This section explains how to save setting data in  
an ALL file.  
Before starting, insert a writable SxS memory  
menu setting items and setting data. You can  
save up to 64 user files on SxS memory cards  
card into a memory card slot.  
and on USB flash drives (in UDF mode).  
information about menu operations.  
You can set up the USER menu to a  
customized state by reading one of these files  
into the unit’s memory.  
1
Select FILE >All in the setup menu.  
ALL files: ALL files save the setting data of all  
menus. You can save up to 64 ALL files on  
an SxS memory card or a USB flash drive (in  
UDF mode).  
To assign a name to the data before saving  
it  
Assign a name before proceeding to step 2.  
Note  
Device specific data (shading, output levels, and  
other data that requires adjustment for the specific  
device) is not saved.  
2
Select All Save(SxS) >Execute.  
An ALL file list box appears.  
File numbers where “No File” is displayed  
are empty file numbers. File numbers with a  
file name or a date and time are the number  
of files that already contain data.  
Scene files: Scene file save adjustments to  
PAINT menu items for the purpose of  
shooting a particular scene. You can save up  
to five scene files in the camcorder’s internal  
memory and up to 64 scene files on an SxS  
memory card or a USB flash drive (in UDF  
mode).  
3
4
5
Turn the MENU knob to select the  
desired file number.  
Reference files: Reference files save the  
reference values that are set when you  
execute FILE >Scene > Standard in the setup  
menu. You can save one reference file in the  
camcorder’s internal memory and one on an  
SxS memory card or a USB flash drive (in  
UDF mode).  
Lens files: Lens files save the setting data used to  
compensate for lens characteristics, such as  
flare, white shading, white balance and  
center markers. You can save up to 32 lens  
Press the MENU knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
To execute the save, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob.  
To cancel the save, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
If you choose to execute the save, the  
ACCESS lamp lights (in blue on the right-  
Saving and Loading Settings  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
side panel and in orange in the card slot  
section). A completion message appears and  
the ACCESS lamp goes out when the data  
has been saved.  
Loading Setting Data  
Note  
When you load a file from an SxS memory card or a USB  
flash drive (in UDF mode), the data saved in the  
camcorder’s internal memory is overwritten.  
If an error message appears  
One of the following error messages may appear  
during execution of the save, or as soon as you  
select [Execute]. In this case, the file is not saved  
to the SxS memory card.  
information about menu operations.  
1
2
Select FILE >All in the setup menu.  
Error message Problem  
NG:Cannot Save No recordable Insert  
What to do  
Select All Load(SxS) >Execute.  
A list box of ALL files appears.  
File numbers where “No File” is displayed  
are empty file numbers. File numbers with a  
file name or a date and time are the number  
of files that already contain data.  
media is  
recordable  
media.  
inserted.  
NG:Media Full The media is  
full.  
Use media with  
free capacity  
remaining.  
When using a USB flash drive (in UDF mode)  
Connect a formatted USB flash drive (see  
page 73) to the external device connector.  
Select All Save(USB) >Execute in step 2.  
3
4
5
Turn the MENU knob to select the  
desired file number.  
Press the MENU knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
To assign names to files  
Assigning a name before you save data in an ALL  
file can make it easier to distinguish your files.  
The following characters can be used in file  
names.  
Alphanumeric characters (a–z, A–Z, 0–9) and  
special characters ( ! # $ % & ' ( ) * + , - . / : ; < =  
> ? @ [ \ ] ~)  
To execute the load, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob.  
To cancel the load, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
If you choose to execute the load, the  
ACCESS lamp lights (in blue on the right-  
side panel and in orange in the card slot  
section). The ACCESS lamp goes out and a  
completion message appears when the data  
has been loaded.  
1
2
Select FILE >All >File ID in the setup  
menu.  
Turn the MENU knob to select a  
character, and then press the MENU  
knob.  
If an error message appears  
One of the following error messages may appear  
during execution of the load, or as soon as you  
select [Execute]. In this case, the file is not loaded  
from the SxS memory card.  
3
4
Repeat step 3.  
Error message Problem  
NG:No Data • There is no  
What to do  
Insert the  
readable media media that  
When you have finished entering  
characters, press the MENU knob to  
move the cursor to “SET”, and then  
press the MENU knob.  
• The specified  
file does not  
exist on the  
media  
contains the  
file you want.  
The specified name is displayed.  
When you save the file (see page 160), the  
data will be saved under this name.  
When using a USB flash drive (in UDF mode)  
Connect a formatted USB flash drive (see  
page 73) to the external device connector.  
Select All Load(USB) >Execute in step 2.  
Saving and Loading Settings  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Resetting a File after Changing Its  
Contents  
Saving and Loading  
Scene Files  
information about menu operations.  
1
2
Select FILE >All in the setup menu.  
Scene files allow you to save the following types  
of data.  
• Values set in the PAINT menu  
• Shutter speeds set in standard mode or ECS  
mode  
Select [All Preset], and then press the  
MENU knob.  
3
To execute the reset, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob.  
To cancel the reset, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
• White balance data  
The data that is saved and loaded depends on the  
setting of FILE >Reference >Scene White Data  
in the setup menu.  
If you choose to execute the reset, all settings  
in the ALL file are reset to preset values.  
Saving Scene Files  
To save a scene file to an SxS memory card, insert  
the card into a memory card slot and then proceed  
as follows.  
information about menu operations.  
1
Select FILE >Scene in the setup menu.  
To assign a name to the data before saving  
it  
Assign a name before proceeding to step 2.  
2
Select Scene Store Mem >Excute (if you  
want to save the data in the camcorder’s  
internal memory), or select Scene Store  
SxS >Execute (if you want to save the  
data on an SxS memory card).  
3
4
Press the MENU knob.  
A list box of scene files appears.  
File numbers where “No File” is displayed  
are empty file numbers  
Select the file number under which you  
want to save the data, and then press the  
MENU knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
Saving and Loading Scene Files  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
162  
         
When the data has been loaded, a completion  
message appears and the ACCESS lamp goes  
out.  
5
To execute the save, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob.  
To cancel the save, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
If you selected Scene Store SxS >Execute in  
step 2, the ACCESS lamp lights (in blue on  
the right-side panel and in orange in the card  
slot section) when you execute the save.  
When the data has been saved, a completion  
message appears and the ACCESS lamp goes  
out.  
When using a USB flash drive (in UDF mode)  
Connect a formatted USB flash drive (see  
page 73) to the external device connector.  
Select Scene Recall USB >Execute in step 2.  
When using a USB flash drive (in UDF mode)  
Connect a formatted USB flash drive (see  
page 73) to the external device connector.  
Select Scene Store USB >Execute in step 2.  
Loading Scene Files  
To load a scene file from an SxS memory card,  
insert the SxS memory card into a memory card  
slot, and then proceed as follows.  
information about menu operations.  
1
2
Select FILE >Scene in the setup menu.  
Select Scene Recall Mem >Execute (if  
you want to load the file from the  
camcorder’s internal memory), and  
select Scene Recall SxS >Execute (if you  
want to load the file from an SxS  
memory card).  
3
Press the MENU knob.  
A list box of scene files appears. File  
numbers where “No File” is displayed are  
empty file numbers.  
4
5
Select the desired file number, and then  
press the MENU knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
To execute the load, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob.  
To cancel the load, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
If you selected Scene Recall SxS >Execute in  
step 2, the ACCESS lamp lights (in blue on  
the right-side panel and in orange in the card  
slot section) when you execute the load.  
Saving and Loading Scene Files  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
SxS >Execute (if you want to save the  
data on an SxS memory card).  
Saving and Loading  
Lens Files  
3
4
5
Press the MENU knob.  
If you select [Execute], a list box of lens file  
number appears. File numbers where “No  
File” is displayed are empty file numbers.  
Select the file number under which you  
want to save the data, and then press the  
MENU knob.  
Setting Lens File Data  
Use FILE >Lens (see page 153) in the setup menu  
to set the data in lens files.  
You can set the following data and save it as a  
lens file.  
A confirmation message appears.  
To execute the save, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob.  
To cancel the save, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
If you selected Lens Store SxS >Execute in  
step 2, the ACCESS lamp lights (in blue on  
the right-side panel and in orange in the card  
slot section) when you execute the save.  
When the data has been saved, a completion  
message appears and the ACCESS lamp goes  
out.  
Setting data  
Sub-items  
V modulation shading  
compensation values  
Center marker position  
M V Modulation  
Lens Center H  
Lens Center V  
Lens R Flare  
Flare level  
Lens G Flare  
Lens B Flare  
White balance  
compensation value  
White shading  
Lens W-R Offset  
Lens W-B Offset  
L R/G/B H Saw  
L R/G/B H Para  
L R/G/B V Saw  
L R/G/B V Para  
When using a USB flash drive (in UDF mode)  
Connect a formatted USB flash drive (see  
page 73) to the external device connector.  
Select Lens Store USB >Execute in step 2.  
compensation value  
information about menu operations.  
Loading Lens Files  
To load a lens file from an SxS memory card,  
insert the SxS memory card into a memory card  
slot, and then proceed as follows.  
Saving Lens Files  
To save a lens file to an SxS memory card, insert  
the card into a memory card slot and then proceed  
as follows.  
information about menu operations.  
information about menu operations.  
1
2
Select FILE >Lens in the setup menu.  
Select Lens Recall Mem >Execute (if  
you want to load the file from the  
camcorder’s internal memory), and  
select Lens Recall SxS >Execute (if you  
want to load the file from an SxS  
memory card).  
1
Select FILE >Lens in the setup menu.  
To assign a name to the data before saving  
it  
Assign a name before proceeding to step 2.  
3
Press the MENU knob.  
If you select [Execute], a list box of lens files  
appears. File numbers where “No File” is  
displayed are empty file numbers.  
2
Select Lens Store Mem >Execute (if you  
want to save the data in the camcorder’s  
internal memory), and select Lens Store  
Saving and Loading Lens Files  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
164  
             
4
5
Select the desired file number, and then  
press the MENU knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
Saving and Loading  
User Files  
To execute the load, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob.  
To cancel the load, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
If you selected Lens Recall SxS >Execute in  
step 2, the ACCESS lamp lights (in blue on  
the right-side panel and in orange in the card  
slot section) when you execute the load.  
When the specified lens file has been loaded,  
a completion message appears and the  
ACCESS lamp goes out.  
You can save the customized USER menu  
configuration and settings along with white  
balance data as user files.  
Saving User Files  
To save a user file to an SxS memory card, insert  
the card into a memory card slot and then proceed  
as follows.  
When using a USB flash drive (in UDF mode)  
Connect a formatted USB flash drive (see  
page 73) to the external device connector.  
Select Lens Recall USB >Execute in step 2.  
information about menu operations.  
1
Select FILE >User in the setup menu.  
Loading Lens Files Automatically  
To assign a name to the data before saving  
it  
When you are using a lens that support serial  
communication, you can set up the camcorder by  
automatically loading the lens file that  
corresponds to the lens settings (Lens Auto Recall  
function).  
To use the Lens Auto Recall function, set FILE  
>Lens >Lens Auto Recall in the setup menu to  
one of the following.  
Assign a name before proceeding to step 2.  
2
Select User Save SxS >Execute.  
A user file list box appears.  
File numbers where “No File” is displayed  
are empty file numbers. File numbers with a  
file name or a date and time are the number  
of files that already contain data.  
On: Load the lens file that corresponds to the  
model name.  
Off: Do not use the Lens Auto Recall function.  
Serial Number: Load the lens file that  
corresponds to the model name and serial  
number (when the lens supports  
communication of the serial number).  
If the lens does not support communication of the  
serial number, both settings load the lens file that  
corresponds to the model name.  
3
4
5
Turn the MENU knob to select the  
desired file number.  
Press the MENU knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
To execute the save, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob. To  
cancel the save, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
If you choose to execute the save, the  
ACCESS lamp lights (in blue on the right-  
side panel and in orange in the card slot  
section). A completion message appears and  
the ACCESS lamp goes out when the data  
has been saved.  
Saving and Loading User Files  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Saving the USER menu as a user file in  
which all menu settings are reset to the  
preset values  
cancel the load, select [Cancel], and  
then press the MENU knob.  
If you choose to execute the load, the  
ACCESS lamp lights (in blue on the right-  
side panel and in orange in the card slot  
section). The ACCESS lamp goes out and a  
completion message appears when the data  
has been loaded.  
Select Store User Preset >Execute in step 2.  
When using a USB flash drive (in UDF  
mode)  
Connect a formatted USB flash drive (see  
page 73) to the external device connector.  
Select User Save USB >Execute in step 2.  
The ACCESS lamp does not light while the  
save is being executed in step 5.  
When using a USB flash drive (in UDF mode)  
Connect a formatted USB flash drive (see  
page 73) to the external device connector.  
Select User Load USB >Execute in step 2.  
The ACCESS lamp does not light while the save  
is being executed in step 5.  
Loading Setting Data  
Note  
When you load a file from an SxS memory card or a USB  
flash drive (in UDF mode) , the data saved in the  
camcorder’s internal memory is overwritten.  
Depending on the settings of Use Load  
Customize Data and User Load White under  
FILE >User in the setup menu  
When Load Customize Data is set to [Off]:  
Only USER menu settings are loaded.  
When Load Customize Data is set to [On]:  
USER menu configuration and settings are  
loaded.  
When User Load White is set to [Off]: White  
balance data is not loaded.  
When User Load White is set to [On]: White  
balance data is loaded.  
information about menu operations.  
1
2
Select FILE >User in the setup menu.  
Select User Load SxS >Execute.  
A list box of user files appears.  
File numbers where “No File” is displayed  
are empty file numbers. File numbers with a  
file name or a date and time are the number  
of files that already contain data.  
3
4
5
Turn the MENU knob to select the  
desired file number.  
Press the MENU knob.  
A confirmation message appears.  
To execute the load, select [Execute],  
and then press the MENU knob. To  
Saving and Loading User Files  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
166  
 
Chapter8  
Connecting External Devices  
You can connect an RM-B150/B750 Remote Control Unit and operate this camcorder. For connection and  
operation of the RM-B150/B750, refer to the Supplement supplied in the CD-ROM (labeled “Manuals for  
Solid-State Memory Camcorder”).  
Connecting External Monitors  
Select the output signal and use an appropriate cable for the monitor to be connected.  
BNC cable (not supplied)  
BNC cable (not supplied)  
Regardless of whether the signal is HD or SD, the  
same status information and menus can be  
displayed on the external monitor as those on the  
following restrictions:  
viewfinder screen.  
Note  
SD signals down-converted for output have the  
Images of 50P/50i/25P are output as PAL signals, those  
of 59.94P/59.94i/29.97P are output as NTSC signals, and  
those of 23.98P are output as 2-3 pulled-down NTSC  
signals.  
Connecting External Monitors  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
For connection, use a BNC cable (not supplied).  
HD/SD SDI OUT connector (BNC)  
The HD/SD SDI OUT connector can be used to  
connect a device that supports SDI. The device  
type can be a monitor, switcher, or VTR or other  
recording device.  
The output from this connector can be turned on  
and off with OPERATION >Input/Output >SDI  
Output in the setup menu (see page 114).  
For connection, use a BNC cable (not supplied).  
i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector  
In FAT mode, i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector  
supports HDV and DV input/output. However,  
DV streams cannot be recorded on this  
camcorder.  
This connector can be used to connect a device  
that supports i.LINK (HDV). The device type can  
be a monitor, read/write device such as VTR or  
HDD, or computer.  
VIDEO OUT connector  
To input/output HDV signals  
The VIDEO OUT connector can be used to  
connect a device that supports analog composite  
signal. The device type can be a monitor or VTR  
or other recording device.  
The output signal varies as shown in the  
following table depending on the setting of  
OPERATION >Output&i.LINK in the setup  
menu.  
HDV input/output is supported when the video  
format is an HDV compatible format (SP 1440/  
59.94i, SP 1440/50i, or SP 1440/23.98P), Input/  
Output >Output&i.LINK in the OPERATION  
menu is set to [HD&HDV] or [SD&HDV], and  
Input/Output >i.LINK I/O is set to [Enable].  
When the video format is SP 1440/23.98P, a  
59.94i HDV signal subjected to 2-3 pulldown  
processing is output.  
Setting  
HD&HDV (in FAT HD-Y analog signal which  
mode) has the same video format  
Output signal  
To input/output DV signals  
DV input/output is supported under either of the  
following conditions.  
HD (in UDF mode) with the signal output from  
the HD/SD SDI OUT  
• Input/Output >i.LINK I/O in the OPERATION  
menu is set to [Enable] on SD mode.  
• On HD mode, the video format is other than DV  
incompatible formats (HQ 1920/23.98P, HQ  
1440/23.98P, and HQ 1280/23.98P), Input/  
Output >Output&i.LINK is set to [SD&DV],  
and Input/Output >i.LINK I/O is set to  
[Enable].  
connector.  
SD&HDV or  
SD&DV (in FAT  
mode)  
Composite signal which has  
the same video format with  
the signal output from the  
SD (in UDF mode) HD/SD SDI OUT connector.  
When OPERATION  
>Format >HD/SD in the  
setup menu is [SD], the  
output composite signal is  
the same as the NTSC or  
PAL encoded signal that is  
output from the HD/SD SDI  
a)  
OUT connector  
.
a) Use OPERATION >Format >Country (see page 113)  
in the setup menu to switch between NTSC and PAL.  
To input the VIDEO OUT connector output  
signal to an external analog composite device, it  
may be necessary to change the input signal  
setting of that external device to be matched with  
the analog composite signal setting for the  
VIDEO OUT connector.  
To input camcorder output audio to an external  
device such as a monitor or VTR or other  
recording device, connect the audio output of the  
AUDIO OUT connector to the audio input of that  
external device.  
Connecting External Monitors  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
With a Macintosh computer  
An icon is displayed on the menu bar.  
Operating Clips with a  
Computer  
USB Connection with a Computer  
Preparations  
The clips recorded on SxS memory cards with  
this camcorder can be controlled on a computer or  
edited using the optional nonlinear editing  
software.  
When you connect the camcorder to a computer  
using a USB cable (not supplied), the memory  
card in the slot is acknowledged as an extended  
drive by the computer.  
For these purposes, the clips on an SxS memory  
card can be operated by directly loading the card  
in a computer or by connecting the camcorder or  
the optional SBAC-US10 SxS Memory Card  
USB Reader/Writer to the computer, using an  
USB cable as shown below.  
When two memory cards are mounted in this  
camcorder, they are acknowledged as two  
independent extended drives by the computer.  
Using the ExpressCard Slot of a  
Computer  
USB cable  
(not supplied)  
If the computer is equipped with an ExpressCard/  
34 or ExpressCard/54 slot, you can directly insert  
the SxS memory card containing clips recorded  
with this camcorder and access to the files.  
For the operating requirements for the computer, see  
Note  
The SxS Device Driver Software and SxS UDF driver  
software on the CD-ROM supplied with the camcorder  
must be installed on your computer. Before installation,  
be sure to read the enclosed SxS Device Driver Software  
End-User License Agreement.  
Notes  
• When connecting the USB cable to the computer, be  
careful to check the form and direction of the USB  
connector.  
• The camcorder does not work on the bus power from  
the computer.  
For information on installation of the driver  
software, refer to the ReadMe on the supplied CD-  
ROM.  
For support information for the driver software, visit  
the following URL:  
http://www.sony.net/SxS-Support/  
To start USB connection  
Note  
When a computer is connected to the PC connector of the  
camcorder and at the same time an optional PHU-120R  
Professional Harddisk Unit (powered from a battery) is  
connected to the computer, battery exhaustion on the  
PHU-120R (indicated by a Battery End warning)  
disables the following.  
To the ExpressCard slot  
SxS memory card  
Computer with SxS  
Device Driver  
Software installed  
• To guard the PHU-120R against access from the  
computer  
• To disconnect the PHU-120R’s cable from the  
memory card slot or plug again the cable into the slot  
With a Windows computer  
Check that a Removable Disk appears in My  
Computer. This indicates normal status.  
Operating Clips with a Computer  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
• To turn on the tally indicator on the viewfinder screen  
to warn the operator  
The message “Connect USB Now?” appears  
again.  
Note  
When you connect a computer to the PC  
connector with a USB cable (not supplied), the  
message “Connect USB Now?” is displayed to  
prompt you to confirm that you wish to enable the  
USB connection.  
If you connect the camcorder to the computer using an  
i.LINK cable, you cannot use the computer to operate  
files stored in a recording media loaded in the memory  
card slot of this camcorder.  
If you select “Cancel” or push the MENU  
CANCEL/PRST/ESCAPE down to the ESCAPE  
side or if you disconnect the USB cable, the  
message “Connect USB Now?” disappears.  
To remove an SxS memory card  
Windows  
1. Click on the icon of “Safely Remove  
Hardware” on the task bar of the computer.  
2. Select “Safely remove SxS Memory Card -  
Drive(X:)” from the displayed menu.  
3. Check that the Safe To Remove Hardware  
If you select “Execute” and press the MENU  
knob, the USB connection is enabled and this  
camcorder is recognized as an extension drive.  
You can carry out the same operations by using  
the arrow buttons (J, j, K, k) (see page 22).  
message appears then remove the card.  
Macintosh  
Drag the SxS memory card icon on the desktop to  
Trash.  
If the SxS memory card icon is located on Finder,  
click on the eject icon on its side.  
To use the application software  
To copy clips to the local disk of a computer, the  
supplied application software must be used.  
Install the application software on the supplied  
CD-ROM to your computer.  
Although the data regarding recorded materials  
are stored over multiple files and folders, you can  
easily handle the clips without considering such  
data and directory structure by using the supplied  
application software.  
If the USB connection is enabled during  
recording/playback operation, the operation is  
stopped and the message “USB Connecting”  
appears on the viewfinder screen.  
At this time, the output signal from the VIDEO  
OUT connector, and HD/SD SDI OUT connector  
changes to a black signal.  
Notes  
Note  
• The camcorder cannot be operated for recording,  
playback, and so on while the message “USB  
Connecting” is displayed.  
If you operate, e.g. copy the clips on the SxS memory  
card by using the Explorer (Windows) or Finder  
(Macintosh), the subsidiary data contained by the clips  
may not be maintained. To avoid such a problem, use the  
application software.  
• When the computer accesses the media loaded in the  
camcorder, do not try to carry out the following  
operations.  
- Operating the camcorder (turning the power on/off,  
switching the operation mode, etc.)  
- Removing or loading a media from an active slot  
(being accessed from the computer)  
For installation and operations, refer to the User’s  
Guide contained in the CD-ROM.  
For support information on the application software,  
visit on the cover page of the supplied CD-ROM.  
- Removing or connecting the USB cable  
Disabling the USB connection  
To use a nonlinear editing system  
For a nonlinear editing system, optional editing  
software that corresponds to the recording  
formats used with this camcorder is required.  
To disable the USB connection, follow the same  
procedure as that for removing a device from the  
computer.  
To enable the USB connection again, first  
disconnect the USB cable and then reconnect it.  
Operating Clips with a Computer  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Store the clips to be edited on the HDD of your  
computer in advance, using the supplied  
application software.  
Some editing software may not operate properly.  
Be sure to confirm before use that it conforms to  
the recording formats used with this camcorder.  
Connecting an External  
Device (i.LINK  
Connection)  
FAT  
You can record the same images as those  
recorded on the memory card in this camcorder  
on an external device connected to the i.LINK  
(HDV/DV) connector, or record the playback  
picture of the external device on the memory card  
in the camcorder.  
When you connect the camcorder to a non-linear  
editing system that supports HDV format, you  
can edit the images recorded on the memory card  
in the camcorder.  
Notes  
• i.LINK connection is available only in FAT mode.  
• Use the i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector only for one-to-  
one i.LINK connection.  
• When you change a setting which affects output  
signals from the i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector, such as  
HD/SD, HD System Line, System Frequency, and Rec  
Format under OPERATION >Format in the setup  
menu or i.LINK I/O and Down Converter under  
OPERATION >Input/Output in the setup menu,  
disconnect the i.LINK cable and change the setting.  
Changing such a setting with the i.LINK cable  
connected may cause improper operation of the  
connected i.LINK device.  
• The external signal input via the i.LINK connection  
that can be recorded on the camcorder is HDV streams  
only. You cannot record DV streams via the i.LINK  
connection.  
Recording the Camera Picture on  
an External Device  
The picture being shot with this camcorder is  
output as an HDV or DV stream via the i.LINK  
(HDV/DV) connector. It can be recorded on a  
connected HDV or DVCAM recorder in  
synchronization with a recording start/stop  
operation on this camcorder.  
1
Perform the preparatory settings of the  
camcorder.  
Connecting an External Device (i.LINK Connection)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
171  
           
• Set OPERATION >Input/Output >Output  
& i.LINK in the setup menu (see  
page 114) to “HD & HDV” or “SD &  
HDV”.  
HD & HDV or SD & HDV: To output an  
HDV stream in HD mode when the  
video format is set to an HDV  
Nonlinear Editing  
You can transfer an HDV stream to a nonlinear  
editing system connected via the i.LINK (HDV/  
DV) connector.  
Notes  
compatible format (SP 1440/59.94i,  
SP 1440/50i, or SP 1440/23.94P)  
SD & DV: To output a DV stream  
• Set OPERATION >Input/Output >i.LINK  
I/O in the setup menu to [Enable].  
• Set MAINTENANCE >Trigger Mode  
>i.LINK Trigger Mode in the setup menu  
(see page 146) to [Both] or [External].  
Both: To perform recording both on the  
memory card in this camcorder and on  
the external device  
• The i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector of this camcorder is  
a 6-pin connector. Check the number of pins of the  
i.LINK connector on your computer and use an  
appropriate i.LINK cable.  
• In searching pictures of this camcorder on the  
computer, it may take some time until the display is  
reflected on the computer.  
• If the playback clip is short or the playback starting  
point is near the end of the clip, the i.LINK signal may  
be interrupted between the clip and the next clip. When  
you try to capture such a signal using the nonlinear  
editing system, a malfunction may occur, depending  
on the nonlinear editing software in use.  
• If you specify a search speed other than 4, 15, or 24  
times normal with the nonlinear editing system, no  
i.LINK signal is fed out. In such a case, the picture on  
the LCD monitor may stay frozen.  
External: To perform recording only on  
the external device  
2
3
Set the external device to recording  
standby status.  
• High-speed playback picture may not be displayed on  
the computer screen, depending on the nonlinear  
editing software in use.  
For operations of the external device, refer to  
the operation manual of that device.  
Start recording.  
The external device starts recording in  
Setting on this camcorder  
Set OPERATION >Input/Output >i.LINK I/O in  
synchronization.  
the setup menu to [Enable].  
For operations of the nonlinear editing software,  
refer to the operation manual of the software.  
The status of the external device is displayed in  
the i.LINK status indication area (see page 33) on  
the viewfinder screen.  
Recording External Input Signals  
Indication  
Status of the external device  
STBY  
zREC  
STBY  
zREC  
In HDV recording standby  
HDV  
HDV  
DV  
The HDV stream input from a device connected  
via the i.LINK (HDV/DV) connector can be  
recorded on an SxS memory card in this  
camcorder.  
The timecodes superimposed on the i.LINK input  
are recorded regardless of the settings of the  
camcorder.  
In HDV recording  
In DV recording standby  
In DV recording  
DV  
Notes  
• Operation may be different depending on the type of  
external device.  
Note  
DV stream cannot be recorded.  
• When you execute the operation to make a recording  
on the recording media loaded in the camcorder while  
HDV signals are output from the i.LINK (HDV/DV)  
connector, HDV signal output stops for about one  
second before the recording starts, and then it resumes.  
• While you can record shot marks on the memory card  
during recording, they are not added to the pictures  
recorded on the external device.  
1
Set the external signal to a format that  
can be recorded on the camcorder.  
Select an HDV compatible format (SP 1440/  
59.94i, SP 1440/50i, or SP 1440/23.94P) for  
the video format.  
Connecting an External Device (i.LINK Connection)  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2
Make the following settings with  
OPERATION >Input/Output in the  
setup menu (see page 114).  
• Set Output&i.LINK to [HD&HDV] or  
[SD&HDV].  
Configuring a Shooting  
and Recording System  
• Set i.LINK I/O to [Enable].  
• Set Source Select to [i.LINK].  
The input video is displayed on the  
viewfinder screen or the monitor connected  
to the VIDEO OUT connector.  
Audio signals are output through the built-in  
speakers, the headphones connected to the  
EARPHONE connector, and the speakers of  
the monitor connected to the VIDEO OUT  
connector.  
If you install the optional CBK-HD02 on this  
camcorder, you can attach the XDCA-55 HD  
Camera Adaptor and connect the XDCU-50 HD  
Camera Extension Unit.  
This allows you to configure a shooting and  
recording system consisting of multiple  
camcorders with camera extension units  
connected to a remote control unit.  
For more information about the XDCA-55 and  
XDCU-50, refer to their respective operation  
manuals.  
3
Notes  
Start the recording.  
• An error is generated in the following cases. In such a  
case, cancel Recording mode.  
- The video format of input signal does not match that  
specified on the camcorder.  
Note  
When using the camcorder in this system, do not connect  
a video light to the camcorder.  
- A copy-protected stream is being fed in.  
• If the input to the camcorder becomes no signal during  
recording, the TALLY indicators, the tally indicator on  
the front of the viewfinder, and the REC indication  
(zREC) on the viewfinder screen flash, indicating that  
no signal is being recorded on the SxS memory card.  
When an input signal is resumed, recording is  
restarted, incrementing the clip number on the memory  
card.  
Configuring a Shooting and Recording System  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter9 Maintenance  
Testing the Camcorder  
Maintenance  
Check the functions of the camcorder before  
setting out for a shooting session, preferably by  
recording and playing back video and audio  
signals.  
Cleaning the Viewfinder  
Use a dust blower to clean the CRT screen and  
mirror inside the viewfinder barrel.  
Clean the lens and protecting filter with a  
commercially available lens cleaner.  
Caution  
Never use organic solvents such as thinners.  
Disassembling the eyepiece for cleaning  
(example: HDVF-20A)  
1 Viewfinder barrel  
2 Eyecup holder  
3 Protecting filter  
4 Packing ring  
5 Eyecup  
1
2
Detach the eyepiece from the viewfinder  
barrel.  
For the detaching procedure, see “Detaching  
Remove the eyecup from the eyecup  
holder.  
Testing the Camcorder / Maintenance  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
3
4
Remove the protecting filter, together  
with the packing ring, from inside the  
eyecup holder.  
Note about the Battery Terminal  
The battery terminal of this unit (the connector for  
battery packs and AC adaptors) is a consumable  
part.  
Power may not be supplied to the unit properly if  
the pins of the battery terminal are bent or  
deformed by shock or vibrations, or if they  
become corroded due to prolonged outdoor use.  
Periodic inspections are recommended to keep  
the unit working properly and to prolong its  
usable lifetime.  
Detach the protecting filter from the  
packing ring.  
Fog-proof filter  
Depending on the temperature and humidity, the  
protecting filter may mist because of vapor or  
your breath. To ensure that the viewfinder is  
always clear, replace the protecting filter with a  
fog-proof filter (service part number: 1-547-341-  
11).  
Contact a Sony service or sales representative for  
more information about inspections.  
Fitting the fog-proof filter  
Replace the protecting filter on the packing ring  
with the fog-proof filter.  
Be sure to correctly assemble the fog-proof filter,  
the packing ring, and the eyecup so that the  
reassembled eyepiece is waterproof.  
Note  
When cleaning the fog-proof filter, wipe it very gently  
with a soft cloth to avoid damaging the anti-fogging  
coating.  
Maintenance  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operation Warnings  
If a problem occurs when the camcorder is powered or is being operated, a warning is issued by various  
visible and audible indicators. These visible and audible indicators are:  
• Error/warning message (“A” in the “Layout of the table of warning messages” below)  
• WARNING indicator (“B”), warning sound from the speaker and earphones (“C”), tally/REC indication  
(“D”), and battery remaining indicator (“E”).  
A warning message, and the REC indication appear on the viewfinder screen.  
The volume of the warning sound can be adjusted with the ALARM knob. Set the ALARM knob to the  
minimum position to suppress the sound.  
Layout of the table of warning messages  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
B
C
D
E
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
• The operation of the WARNING indicator, the tally/REC indication, and the battery indicator is  
represented by graphic symbols as follows.  
: Continuous  
: 1 flash/s  
: 4 flashes/s  
• The warning sounds are represented by graphic symbols as follows.  
: Continuous beep  
: 1 beep/s  
Error Indication  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
Error (The camcorder Recording stops.  
is abnormal.)  
Turn off the power and confirm whether an error  
occurs on the connected devices, the cables, and  
the media or not. (If power cannot be turned off  
by setting the POWER switch to OFF, remove the  
battery pack or the AC power source.)  
If the problem continues after the camcorder is  
restarted, contact your Sony service  
representative.  
Operation Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
176  
       
Warning Indication  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
Free space on the SxS Recording continues.  
memory card has  
Replace it with another at the earliest opportunity.  
become insufficient.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
No space is left on the Recording stops.  
SxS memory card.  
Recording, clip  
Replace it with another.  
copying and clip  
division cannot be  
performed.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The battery power will Recording continues.  
be exhausted soon.  
Charge the battery pack at the earliest  
opportunity.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The battery pack is  
exhausted. Recording  
cannot be performed.  
Recording stops.  
Connect a power source via the DC IN connector  
or stop operation to charge the battery pack.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The internal  
Recording continues.  
Suspend operation, turn off the power, and wait  
until the temperature falls.  
temperature has risen  
above a safe operation  
limit.  
Operation Warnings  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The DC IN voltage has Recording continues.  
become low (stage 1).  
Check the power supply.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The DC IN voltage is Recording stops.  
too low (stage 2).  
Connect other power source.  
Recording cannot be  
performed.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
An error was detected Recording stops.  
with the battery pack.  
Replace the battery pack with a normal one.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The remaining power Recording continues.  
of the backup battery  
Refer to a Sony service representative to replace  
the battery with a new one.  
is insufficient.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
A partitioned memory Recording continues.  
card or one that  
This card cannot be used with this camcorder.  
Remove it and load a compatible card.  
contains recorded clips  
exceeding the number  
permitted with this  
camcorder is loaded.  
Operation Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
178  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The maximum number Recording stops.  
of clips for a single  
memory card is  
Replace it with another card.  
reached. No more clip  
can be recorded on the  
card.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
An error occurred with Recording stops.  
the memory card. The  
card requires  
Remove the card, load it again, and restore it.  
restoration.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
Recording cannot be Recording stops.  
done, as the memory  
card is defective.  
As playback may be possible, it is recommended  
to replace it with another card after copying the  
clips, as required.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
Neither recording nor Recording stops.  
playback can be done,  
as the memory card is  
defective.  
It cannot be operated with this camcorder.  
Replace it with another card.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
A card of a different  
file system was  
inserted.  
Recording stops.  
It cannot be used with this camcorder. Replace it  
with another card.  
Operation Warnings  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The external signal  
input via the i.LINK  
connection cannot be  
recorded, as the Video  
Format setting is  
Recording stops.  
Change settings of OPERATION >Format in the  
setup menu to match it to that of the external  
signal.  
different from the  
signal format of the  
external input signal.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The external signal  
input via the i.LINK  
connection cannot be  
recorded, as the stream  
is copy-protected.  
Recording stops.  
Check the input signal.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The external signal  
input via the i.LINK  
connection cannot be  
recorded, as it is a DV  
stream.  
Recording stops.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
An error occurred in  
reading data from the  
memory card, and  
playback cannot be  
continued.  
Recording stops.  
If this frequently occurs, change the memory card  
after copying the clips, as required.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
Recording cannot be Recording stops.  
done, as an error  
If this frequently occurs, change the memory  
card.  
occurred with the  
memory card.  
Operation Warnings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
180  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The battery power of  
the connected HDD  
will be exhausted  
soon.  
Change the battery at the earliest opportunity.  
Recording continues.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The battery of the  
Recording stops.  
Stop operation to change the battery.  
connected HDD is  
exhausted. Recording  
cannot be performed.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
There is not enough  
Recording continues  
Replace the card in slot A with another one.  
capacity for copying. (disallowing copy).  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The card has already Recording continues  
Replace the card in slot A with another one.  
ten clips having the  
same name as that you  
tried to duplicate.  
(disallowing copy).  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
There is not enough  
Recording continues  
capacity for dividing a (disallowing divide).  
clip.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
Will switch to other  
slot soon.  
Recording continues.  
Make sure that a memory card is loaded in the  
other slot.  
Operation Warnings  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
There is no clip to be Recording continues.  
displayed.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
There is no clip with Recording continues.  
the OK mark.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The card has already Recording continues  
clips having the same (disallowing copy).  
name as that you tried  
Replace the card in slot A with another one.  
to duplicate.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The memory card  
comes to the end of its  
service life.  
Recording stops.  
Make a backup copy and replace the card with  
another one as soon as possible. Recording/  
playback may not be performed properly if you  
continue to use the card.  
For details, refer to the Operating Instructions of  
the memory card.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The inserted memory  
card contains clips  
recorded in a format  
that is not supported  
by this camcorder.  
The card in slot A cannot be used with this  
camcorder.  
Operation Warnings  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
The fan does not rotate  
when started.  
Avoid use under high temperature conditions.  
Power the camcorder off and contact a Sony  
service representative.  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
Restoration is required Recording continues.  
because the media was  
removed while the  
Insert again the media which was removed and  
restore it (see page 72).  
camcorder was in  
recording standby  
mode of Clip  
Continuous Rec (see  
WARNING indicator Warning sound  
Tally/REC  
Battery remaining  
Problem  
Operation in the recorder Action to take  
module  
Power to the external Recording continues.  
device connector was  
removed because  
Power the camcorder off and remove the Wi-Fi  
adapter or USB flash drive that is connected to  
the external device connector.  
overcurrent was  
detected on the  
connector. (Other  
operations are not  
affected.)  
1) (B) for the card in slot B  
2) B for a HDD connected to slot B  
Operation Warnings  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix  
Use and storage locations  
Important Notes on  
Store in a level, ventilated place. Avoid using or  
storing the camcorder in the following places.  
• In excessive heat or cold (operating temperature  
range: –5°C to +40°C (23°F to 104°F))  
• Remember that in summer in warm climates the  
temperature inside a car with the windows  
closed can easily exceed 50°C (122°F).  
• In damp or dusty locations  
• Locations where the camcorder may be exposed  
to rain  
• Locations subject to violent vibration  
• Near strong magnetic fields  
Operation  
Use and storage  
Do not subject the camcorder to severe shocks  
• The internal mechanism may be damaged or the  
body warped.  
• If an accessory mounted on the accessory shoe  
is subjected to severe shock, the accessory shoe  
may be damaged. In such a case, stop using it  
and contact your dealer or a Sony service  
representative.  
• Close to radio or TV transmitters producing  
strong electromagnetic fields.  
• In direct sunlight or close to heaters for  
extended periods  
Do not cover the camcorder while operating  
Putting a cloth, for example, over the camcorder  
can cause excessive internal heat build-up.  
To prevent electromagnetic interference from  
portable communications devices  
The use of portable telephones and other  
communications devices near this camcorder can  
result in malfunctions and interference with audio  
and video signals.  
It is recommended that the portable  
communications devices near this camcorder be  
powered off.  
After use  
Always turn off the POWER switch.  
Before storing the camcorder for a long period  
Remove the battery pack.  
Shipping  
• Remove the media before transporting the  
camcorder.  
Fitting the zoom lens  
• If sending the camcorder by truck, ship, air or  
other transportation service, pack it in the  
shipping carton of the camcorder.  
It is important to fit the lens correctly, as  
otherwise damage may result. Be sure to refer to  
Care of the camcorder  
Remove dust and dirt from the surfaces of the  
lenses or optical filters using a blower.  
Viewfinder  
Do not leave the camcorder with the eyepiece  
pointing directly at the sun.  
The eyepiece lens can concentrate the sun’s rays  
and melt the interior of the viewfinder.  
If the body of the camcorder is dirty, clean it with  
a soft, dry cloth. In extreme cases, use a cloth  
steeped in a little neutral detergent, then wipe dry.  
Do not use organic solvents such as alcohol or  
thinners, as these may cause discoloration or  
other damage to the finish of the camcorder.  
About the LCD panels  
In the event of operating problems  
The LCD panel fitted to this camcorder is  
manufactured with high precision technology,  
giving a functioning pixel ratio of at least 99.99%.  
Thus a very small proportion of pixels maybe  
If you should experience problems with the  
camcorder, contact a Sony service representative.  
Important Notes on Operation  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
“stuck”, either always off (black), always on (red,  
green, or blue), or flashing. In addition, over a  
long period of use, because of the physical  
characteristics of the liquid crystal display, such  
“stuck” pixels may appear spontaneously. These  
problems are not a malfunction. Note that any  
such problems have no effect on recorded data.  
Phenomena specific to CCD image  
sensors  
The following phenomena that may appear in  
images are specific to CCD (Charge Coupled  
Device) image sensors. They do not indicate  
malfunctions.  
1 Monitor screen  
2 Vertical tails shown on the image  
3 Bright object (e.g. strong spotlight,  
strong reflected light, flashlight, the sun)  
Aliasing  
White flecks  
When fine patterns, stripes, or lines are shot, they  
may appear jagged or flicker.  
Although the CCD image sensors are produced  
with high-precision technologies, fine white  
flecks may be generated on the screen in rare  
cases, caused by cosmic rays, etc.  
Fragmentation  
This is related to the principle of CCD image  
sensors and is not a malfunction.  
If pictures cannot be recorded/reproduced  
properly, try formatting the recording medium.  
While repeating picture recording/playback with  
a certain recording medium for an extended  
period, files in the medium may be fragmented,  
disabling proper recording/storage. In such a  
case, make a backup of clips in the medium then  
perform formatting of the medium using  
OPERATION >Format Media (see page 113) in  
the setup menu.  
The white flecks especially tend to be seen in the  
following cases:  
• When operating at a high environmental  
temperature  
• When you have raised the master gain  
(sensitivity)  
In SLS mode, white flecks are more prominent  
when you set the shutter speed (number of  
frames) to higher values.  
The problem may be alleviated by executing the  
APR (automatic pixel noise reduction) function  
with MAINTENANCE >APR in the setup menu  
(see page 146). Pixel noise is reduced to some  
extent by automatic black balance adjustment  
(see page 54), but the detection capabilities of  
that function are limited. For the most effective  
correction, execute the APR function.  
Vertical smear  
When an extremely bright object, such as a strong  
spotlight or flashlight, is being shot, vertical tails  
may be produced on the screen, or the image may  
be distorted.  
Important Notes on Operation  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exchanging the Battery  
of the Internal Clock  
Specifications  
The camcorder’s internal clock is powered by a  
lithium battery. If the message “BackUp Battery  
End” appears in the viewfinder, this battery must  
be exchanged. Contact a Sony service  
representative.  
General  
Power requirements  
12 V DC (11 V to 17.0 V)  
Power consumption  
Approx. 27 W (main unit only, during recording  
with the LCD monitor lit)  
Notes  
• Do not use a video light with power  
consumption of over 50 W.  
• When connecting a device to the DC OUT  
connector, use one with current  
consumption of 0.5 A or more.  
Operating temperature  
–5ºC to +40ºC (23ºF to 104ºF)  
Storage temperature  
–20ºC to +60ºC (–4ºF to 140ºF)  
Recording/playback formats  
UDF mode  
• HD422  
Video codec: MPEG-2 422P@HL  
Video rate: 50 Mbps/CBR  
Video samples: 1920 × 1080, 1280 × 720  
Proxy video: MPEG-4  
Audio: LPCM 4CH, 24 bits, 48 kHz  
Proxy audio: A-law  
• HD420  
Video codec: MPEG-2 MP@HL(1440)  
Video rate: 35 Mbps/VBR  
Video samples: 1440 × 1080  
Proxy video: MPEG-4  
Audio: LPCM 4CH, 16 bits, 48 kHz  
Proxy audio: A-law  
Video codec: MPEG-2 MP@HL  
Video rate: 35 Mbps/VBR  
Video samples: 1280 × 720  
Proxy video: MPEG-4  
Audio: LPCM 4CH, 16 bits, 48 kHz  
Proxy audio: A-law  
Exchanging the Battery of the Internal Clock / Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
186  
         
Recording/playback time  
• IMX  
Video codec: MPEG-2 422P@ML Intra  
With one SBP-16  
Video rate: 50 Mbps  
FAT mode HQ: About 50 minutes  
Video samples: 720 × 486 (NTSC)/576 (PAL)  
Proxy video: MPEG-4  
SP: About 70 minutes  
DVCAM: About 65 minutes  
UDF mode HD422 50/IMX50: About  
30 minutes  
Audio: LPCM 4CH, 24/16 bits, 48 kHz  
Proxy audio: A-law  
HD420 HQ: About 45 minutes  
DVCAM: About 55 minutes  
With one SBP-32/SBS-32G1A  
FAT mode HQ: About 100 minutes  
SP: About 140 minutes  
• DVCAM  
Video rate: 25 Mbps  
Video samples: 720 × 480 (NTSC)/576 (PAL)  
Proxy video: MPEG-4  
Audio: LPCM 4CH, 16 bits, 48 kHz  
Proxy audio: A-law  
DVCAM: About 130 minutes  
UDF mode HD422 50/IMX50: About  
60 minutes  
FAT mode  
HD420 HQ: About 90 minutes  
DVCAM: About 110 minutes  
With one SBS-64G1A  
• HD420  
Video codec: MPEG-2 MP@HL  
FAT mode HQ: About 200 minutes  
SP: About 280 minutes  
Video rate: 35 Mbps/VBR  
Video samples: 1920 × 1080, 1280 × 720  
Audio: LPCM 4CH, 16 bits, 48 kHz  
DVCAM: About 260 minutes  
UDF mode HD422 50/IMX50: About  
120 minutes  
Video codec: MPEG-2 MP@HL(1440)  
Video rate: 35 Mbps/VBR  
HD420 HQ: About  
180 minutes  
Video samples: 1440 × 1080  
DVCAM: About 220 minutes  
Audio: LPCM 4CH, 16 bits, 48 kHz  
Note  
Video codec: MPEG-2 MP@H14  
Video rate: 25 Mbps/CBR  
The actual recording/playback time may differ  
slightly from the values shown here, depending  
on usage conditions, memory characteristics,  
etc.  
Video samples: 1440 × 1080  
Audio: LPCM 4CH, 16 bits, 48 kHz  
Continuous operation time  
With the BP-GL95  
Approx. 180 min.  
Mass  
• DVCAM  
Video rate: 25 Mbps  
Video samples: 720 × 480 (NTSC)/576 (PAL)  
Audio: LPCM 2CH, 16 bits, 48 kHz  
Main body only: 3.4 kg (7 lb 7.9 oz)  
Dimensions  
Supplied accessories  
Camera Block  
Pickup device  
2/3-type, CCD image sensor  
Effective picture elements:  
1920 (H) × 1080 (V)  
Format  
3-chip RGB  
Specifications  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Optical system  
F1.4 prism system  
ND filters  
1: Clear  
2: 1/4ND  
Frequency response  
20 Hz to 20 kHz (within 3 dB)  
Dynamic range  
90 dB (typical)  
Distortion  
0.08% max. (with input level 40 dBu)  
3: 1  
4: 1  
/
16ND  
64ND  
/
Built-in speaker  
Sensitivity  
F11 (System frequency: 59.94i)  
Monaural  
Output: 300 mW  
F12 (System frequency: 50i)  
(2000lx, 89.9% reflection, 3200K)  
Display  
Minimum illumination  
0.016 lx (F1.4, +42 dB, 16-frame accumulation)  
Video S/N  
LCD monitor  
Screen size  
54 dB (Noise Suppress Off)  
59 dB (Noise Suppress On)  
8.8 cm diagonal (3.5-inch)  
Horizontal resolution  
1000TV lines or more  
Modulation  
45% or more (27.5 MHz, at screen center)  
Black level  
Aspect ratio  
16:9  
Picture elements  
640 (H) × 3 × 480 (V) Sequence delta  
Transmission system  
Hybrid (semi-transmissive) type  
3 1% (when Black in the setup menu is set to  
[ 0])  
Gain  
Media Block  
–6, –3, 0, 3, 6, 9, 12, 18, 24, 30, 36, 42 dB, AGC  
Shutter speed  
59.94i/P, 50i/P: 1  
29.97P: 1 40 to 1  
2000 sec.  
33 to 1  
2000 sec.  
32 to 1  
2000 sec.  
Card slots  
/
60 to 1  
/2000 sec.  
Type: Express Card34  
/
/
Number of slots: 2  
25P: 1  
/
/
Connector: Conforms to PCMCIA Express Card  
Standard  
23.94P: 1  
/
/
Slow shutter  
Writing rate  
50 Mbps or more  
Reading rate  
2 to 8, 16 frames  
Dynamic range  
600%  
460% (1080/29.97P, 1080/25P, 1080/23.98P)  
Smear  
50 Mbps or more  
–135 dB  
Inputs/Outputs  
Input/Output connectors  
Audio Block  
Signal inputs  
GENLOCK IN: BNC type  
1.0 Vp-p, 75 Ω, unbalanced  
TC IN: BNC type  
Sampling frequency  
48 kHz  
Quantization  
16 bits/24 bits  
Headroom  
0.5 V to 18 Vp-p, 10 kΩ  
AUDIO IN CH-1/CH-2: XLR type, 3-pin,  
female  
20 dB (the factory default setting)  
(20, 18, 16, 12 dB), EBU  
(With automatic detection and switching  
function)  
MIC: –70 to –20 dBu  
Specifications  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
188  
       
LINE: +4, 0, –3 dBu  
OPERATION MANUAL  
Japanese version (1)  
MIC IN: XLR type, 5-pin, female  
–70 to –20 dBu  
English version (1)  
CD-ROM  
WRR CH1/CH2  
- Utility Software for XDCAM (application  
software, device driver software) (1)  
- Manuals for Solid-State Memory Camcorder  
(PDF OPERATION MANUAL and  
SUPPLEMENT) (1)  
D-sub 15-pin  
WRR analog: –40 dBu  
WRR digital: –40 dbFS  
HD/SD SDI  
When an option is installed  
4-channel audio  
Signal outputs  
Recommended Additional  
Equipment  
VIDEO OUT: BNC type, switching between SD  
analog composite and HD-Y  
HD/SD SDI OUT 1/2: BNC type  
0.8 Vp-p, unbalanced (switching between  
HD and SD)  
Option key  
SD Record and Playback Key  
CBK-MD01  
Complied to SMPTE292M/259M  
4-channel audio (CH1 to CH4)  
AUDIO OUT: XLR type, 5-pin, male  
+4, 0, –3 dBu (balanced)  
TC OUT: BNC type  
Hardware Upgrade Key  
CBK-UPG01  
Power supply and related equipment  
AC Adaptor  
1.0 Vp-p, 75 Ω  
AC-DN10/DN2B  
Battery Pack  
EARPHONE (stereo minijack)  
8 Ω, 5 mW  
BP-L80S/L60S  
Battery Charger  
BC-M150/L500/L70  
Others  
DC IN: XLR type, 4-pin, male  
11 to 17 V DC  
DC OUT: 4-pin  
Lens, Viewfinder and Related Equipment  
11 to 17 V DC, maximum rated current:  
0.5 A  
Lens  
2/3-type bayonet mount lenses only  
LENS: 12-pin  
Supplying power to the lens  
11 to 17 V DC, maximum rated current:  
1.0 A  
Viewfinder  
HDVF series viewfinder: HDVF-200/20A/  
C35W/C950W/C730W  
REMOTE: 8-pin  
CBK-VF01  
LIGHT: 2-pin  
Viewfinder Rotation Bracket  
USB: 4-pin (type A), 4-pin (type B)  
BKW-401  
i.LINK (HDV/DV): 6-pin, complies with  
IEEE1394  
Equipment for remote control  
VF: 26-pin, rectangular, 20-pin round  
For wireless receiver: D-sub 15-pin  
Remote Control Unit  
RM-B150/B750  
RCP-1000/1500/1530  
SDI/COMPOSITE Input and 50 Pin Interface  
CBK-HD02  
Supplied Accessories  
HD Camera Adaptor  
Shoulder strap (1)  
XDCA-55 (when an optional CBK-HD02 is  
installed)  
Cold shoe kit (1 set)  
Lens mount cap (1)  
HD Camera Extension Unit  
Flange back adjustment chart  
XDCU-50  
Specifications  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MPEG TS Adaptor  
HDCA-702 (when an optional CBK-HD02 is  
Dimensions  
installed)  
Wi-Fi Adapter  
CBK-WA01 (when an optional CBK-UPG01  
is installed)  
Media  
SxS Memory Card  
SxS PRO SBP-16 (16 GB)  
SxS PRO SBP-32 (32 GB)  
SxS-1 SBS-32G1A (32 GB)  
SxS-1 SBS-64G1A (64 GB)  
Professional Harddisk Unit  
(in mm (inches))  
PHU-120R (in FAT mode)  
Media Adaptor  
MEAD-MS01 (for “Memory Stick PRO-HG  
Duo HX” series)  
Design and specifications are subject to change  
without notice.  
MEAD-SD01 (for SDHC card)  
Mobile Storage Unit  
PXU-MS240  
Notes  
Always make a test recording, and verify that it was  
recorded successfully.  
Audio equipment  
Microphone  
SONY WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR DAMAGES  
OF ANY KIND INCLUDING, BUT NOT  
LIMITED TO, COMPENSATION OR  
ECM-678/674/673/680S  
Microphone Holder  
CAC-12  
REIMBURSEMENT ON ACCOUNT OF  
FAILURE OF THIS UNIT OR ITS RECORDING  
MEDIA, EXTERNAL STORAGE SYSTEMS OR  
ANY OTHER MEDIA OR STORAGE SYSTEMS  
TO RECORD CONTENT OF ANY TYPE.  
Always verify that the unit is operating properly  
before use. SONY WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR  
DAMAGES OF ANY KIND INCLUDING, BUT  
NOT LIMITED TO, COMPENSATION OR  
REIMBURSEMENT ON ACCOUNT OF THE  
LOSS OF PRESENT OR PROSPECTIVE  
PROFITS DUE TO FAILURE OF THIS UNIT,  
EITHER DURING THE WARRANTY PERIOD  
OR AFTER EXPIRATION OF THE  
Wireless Microphone  
DWR-S01D  
WRR-855S/860C/861/862  
Other peripheral devices  
Tripod adaptor  
VCT-14/U14  
Video Light  
UC-D200A (PROTECH)  
Ultralight (Anton Bauer)  
Pad  
CBK-SP01 Soft Type Shoulder Pad  
WARRANTY, OR FOR ANY OTHER REASON  
WHATSOEVER.  
Equipment for maintenance and easier handling  
Hard Carrying Case  
LC-H300  
Soft Carrying Case  
LC-DS300SFT  
Maintenance Manual  
Specifications  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chart of Optional Components and Accessories  
HD monitor/SD monitor  
ECM-680S/678/  
674/673  
Microphone  
XDCAM HD series recorder  
PDW-F1600/HD1500, PDW-F75  
CAC-12  
Microphone Holder  
HDCAM series recorder  
HDW-2000 series recorder, HDW-S280  
CBK-VF01  
Viewfinder  
WRR-855S UHF Synthesized Tuner Unit  
DWR-S01D Digital Wireless Receiver  
HDVF-200/20A/  
C35W/C950W/  
C730W Viewfinder  
SBP-16/32  
SBS-32G1A/64G1A  
SxS Memory Card  
MEAD-MS01, MEAD-SD01 Media Adaptor  
CBK-MD01 SD Record and Playback Key  
CBK-HD02 SDI/COMPOSITE Input and 50 Pin Interface  
PXU-MS240 Mobile Storage Unit  
PMW-500  
PHU-120R  
Professional Harddisk Unit  
RM-B150/B750  
RCP-730/750/751/  
920/921  
MSU-900/950/700  
Remote Control Unit  
CBK-UPG01 Hardware Upgrade Key + CBK-WA01  
Wi-Fi Adapter  
CBK-HD02 SDI/COMPOSITE Input and  
50 Pin Interface + HDCA-702 MPEG TS  
Adapter  
VCT-14/U14  
Tripod Adaptor  
CBK-HD02 SDI/COMPOSITE Input and  
50 Pin Interface + XDCA-55 HD Camera  
Adaptor  
Tripod  
XDCU-50 HD Camera Extension Unit  
LC-DS300SFT a)  
Soft Carrying  
Case  
BP-GL95/GL65/L80S/  
L60S  
Battery Pack  
BC-L70 Battery  
Charger  
BC-M150Battery  
Charger  
LC-H300  
Hard Carrying Case  
BC-L500 Battery  
Charger  
AC-DN10/DN2B  
AC Adaptor  
a) The carrying case is large enough to hold the camcorder with lens and microphone mounted. However,  
remove them if they protrude more than 25 cm (9 7  
/8 inches) from the front of the main unit.  
Chart of Optional Components and Accessories  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
About data transfer speed of i.LINK  
About i.LINK  
i.LINK defines a maximum data transfer speed of  
1)  
approximately 100, 200 and 400 Mbps that are  
described as S100, S200 and S400 respectively.  
For i.LINK devices, a maximum data transfer  
speed that the device supports is identified on  
“Specifications” page of the Operating  
Instructions supplied with the device or near its  
i.LINK connector.  
This section explains the specifications and  
features of i.LINK.  
1) When connecting with the device that support  
different data transfer speed, the actual data transfer  
speed may be different from those described on the  
i.LINK connectors.  
What is i.LINK?  
i.LINK is a digital serial interface designed to  
integrate devices equipped with i.LINK  
connectors. i.LINK allows your device to:  
• Perform two-way transmission and reception of  
data such as digital audio and digital video  
signals.  
What is Mbps?  
Mega bits per second. A measure of the rate at  
which data is transmitted per second. In case of  
100 Mbps, 100 Mega bits of data can be  
transmitted per second.  
• Control other i.LINK devices.  
• Easily connect multiple devices with a single  
i.LINK cable.  
Your i.LINK device is capable of connecting to a  
wide range of digital AV devices for data transfer  
and other operations.  
Other advantages include the following feature.  
When connected to multiple i.LINK devices,  
your i.LINK device can perform data transfer and  
other operations not only  
i.LINK operation with your camcorder  
For details on operation when other equipment  
with i.LINK (HDV or DV) connector is  
connected, see page 171.  
For details on connection with i.LINK cable and  
necessary software, refer to the Operating  
Instructions supplied with the connected device.  
with the directly connected devices but also with  
any of the devices that are connected to those  
devices. Therefore, you do not need to be  
concerned with device connection order.  
However, depending on the features and  
specifications of the connected devices, you may  
need to use certain functions differently, and you  
may not be able to transfer data or perform certain  
operations.  
About the required i.LINK cable  
Use the Sony 6-pin-to-4-pin or 6-pin-to-6-pin  
i.LINK cable to connect the i.LINK devices.  
i.LINK and are trademarks.  
i.LINK, a nickname for IEEE 1394 proposed by  
Sony, is a trademark supported by many  
companies worldwide.  
IEEE 1394 is an international standard defined by  
IEEE, the Institute of Electrical and Electronics  
Engineers, Inc.  
Note  
The camcorder can be connected to one device with the  
i.LINK cable (DV cable). When you connect with an  
HDV or DV device that has two or more i.LINK  
connectors, refer to the  
Operating Instructions supplied with the connected  
device.  
About i.LINK  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MPEG-4 Visual Patent  
Portfolio License  
MPEG-2 Video Patent  
Portfolio License  
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE  
MPEG-4 VISUAL PATENT PORTFOLIO  
LICENSE FOR THE PERSONAL AND NON-  
COMMERCIAL USE OF A CONSUMER FOR  
ANY USE OF THIS PRODUCT OTHER THAN  
CONSUMER PERSONAL USE IN ANY  
MANNER THAT COMPLIES WITH THE  
MPEG-2 STANDARD FOR ENCODING  
VIDEO INFORMATION FOR PACKAGED  
MEDIA IS EXPRESSLY PROHIBITED  
WITHOUT A LICENSE UNDER  
APPLICABLE PATENTS IN THE MPEG-2  
PATENT PORTFOLIO, WHICH LICENSE IS  
AVAILABLE FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C., 250  
STEELE STREET, SUITE 300, DENVER,  
COLORADO 80206.  
(i) ENCODING VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE  
WITH THE MPEG-4 VISUAL STANDARD  
(“MPEG-4 VIDEO”)  
AND/OR  
(ii) DECODING MPEG-4 VIDEO THAT WAS  
ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN  
A PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL  
ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM  
A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED BY MPEG  
LA TO PROVIDE MPEG-4 VIDEO.  
“PACKAGED MEDIA” means any storage  
media storing MPEG-2 video information such as  
DVD movie which are sold/distributed to general  
consumers. Disc replicators or sellers of the  
PACKAGED MEDIA need to obtain licenses for  
their own business from MPEG LA. Please  
contact MPEG LA for any further information.  
MPEG LA. L.L.C., 250 STEELE STREET,  
SUITE 300, DENVER, COLORADO 80206  
http://www.mpegla.com  
NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE  
IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE.  
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION INCLUDING  
THAT RELATING TO PROMOTIONAL,  
INTERNAL AND COMMERCIAL USES AND  
LICENSING MAY BE OBTAINED FROM  
MPEG LA, LLC. SEE HTTP://  
WWW.MPEGLA.COM  
MPEG LA is offering licenses for (i)  
manufacturing/sales of any storage media storing  
MPEG-4 Visual video information (ii)  
About Bitmap Fonts  
distribution/broadcasting of MPEG-4 Visual  
video information in any manner (such as online  
video distribution service, internet broadcasting,  
TV broadcasting). Other usage of this product  
may be required to obtain license from MPEGLA.  
Please contact MPEG LA for any further  
information. MPEG LA, L.L.C., 250 STEELE  
STREET, SUITE 300, DENVER, COLORADO  
80206, http://www.mpegla.com  
This product uses RICOH Bitmap Fonts  
produced and sold by Ricoh Company, Ltd.  
MPEG-4 Visual Patent Portfolio License / MPEG-2 Video Patent Portfolio License / About Bitmap Fonts  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
193  
     
About OpenSSL  
Because it uses the OpenSSL Toolkit, this product uses software developed by the OpenSSL Project  
(http://www.openssl.org/).  
OpenSSL License  
---------------  
/* ====================================================================  
* Copyright (c) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.  
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without  
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions  
* are met:  
*
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright  
*
*
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright  
*
*
*
*
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in  
the documentation and/or other materials provided with the  
distribution.  
* 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this  
*
*
*
*
software must display the following acknowledgment:  
"This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project  
for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)"  
* 4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to  
*
*
*
*
endorse or promote products derived from this software without  
prior written permission. For written permission, please contact  
* 5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL"  
*
*
*
nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without prior written  
permission of the OpenSSL Project.  
* 6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following  
*
*
*
*
acknowledgment:  
"This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project  
for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)"  
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY  
* EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE  
* IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR  
* PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR  
* ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,  
About OpenSSL  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
* SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT  
* NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;  
* LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)  
* HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT,  
* STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)  
* ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED  
* OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
* ====================================================================  
*
* This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young  
* ([email protected]). This product includes software written by Tim  
* Hudson ([email protected]).  
*
*/  
Original SSLeay License  
-----------------------  
/* Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected])  
* All rights reserved.  
*
* This package is an SSL implementation written  
* by Eric Young ([email protected]).  
* The implementation was written so as to conform with Netscapes SSL.  
*
* This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as  
* the following conditions are aheared to. The following conditions  
* apply to all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA,  
* lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation  
* included with this distribution is covered by the same copyright terms  
* except that the holder is Tim Hudson ([email protected]).  
*
* Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such any Copyright notices in  
* the code are not to be removed.  
* If this package is used in a product, Eric Young should be given attribution  
* as the author of the parts of the library used.  
* This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or  
* in documentation (online or textual) provided with the package.  
*
* Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without  
* modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions  
* are met:  
* 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright  
*
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
* 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright  
*
*
notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the  
documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
* 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software  
*
*
*
*
must display the following acknowledgement:  
"This product includes cryptographic software written by  
Eric Young ([email protected])"  
The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the rouines from the library  
About OpenSSL  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
195  
*
being used are not cryptographic related :-).  
* 4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from  
*
*
*
the apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement:  
"This product includes software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected])"  
* THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG ``AS IS'' AND  
* ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE  
*
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE  
* ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE  
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
*
* DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS  
* OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)  
*
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT  
* LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY  
* OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF  
* SUCH DAMAGE.  
*
* The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or  
* derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be  
* copied and put under another distribution licence  
* [including the GNU Public Licence.]  
*/  
About OpenSSL  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
C
Clip(s)  
Symbols  
A
Arrow buttons (K, k, J, j) 22  
AUDIO IN CH1/CH2/CH3/CH4  
switches 23  
Audio level  
D
B
Battery  
E
Index  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Expand thumbnail screen  
Iris  
L
F
Lens  
Focus  
Lens file(s)  
G
M
Media  
H
I
Index  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
N
S
Scene file(s)  
O
Search  
with the essence mark thumbnail screen  
95  
P
Power source voltage/battery remaining  
capacity 32  
Shot mark(s)  
R
Shutter  
Index  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
U
User setting data  
V
T
Thumbnail(s)  
W
Index  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Z
Zoom  
Index  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The material contained in this manual consists of  
information that is the property of Sony  
Corporation and is intended solely for use by the  
purchasers of the equipment described in this  
manual.  
Sony Corporation expressly prohibits the  
duplication of any portion of this manual or the  
use thereof for any purpose other than the  
operation or maintenance of the equipment  
described in this manual without the express  
written permission of Sony Corporation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Sherwood Stereo Receiver R 956 User Manual
Soleus Air Air Conditioner SG TTW 12ESE User Manual
Sony Digital Camera SNC Z20P User Manual
Sony Digital Photo Frame 4 155 700 17 1 User Manual
Sony Ericsson Cell Phone W710i User Manual
StarTechcom Fan FAN939775HP User Manual
StarTechcom Network Card PCISATA4R1 User Manual
Stiga Lawn Mower 13 2715 16 User Manual
Sungale Tablet ID1018WTA User Manual
Superior Indoor Fireplace VF4000 CHN 2 User Manual